28 March 2024
For
immediate release
ARBUTHNOT BANKING GROUP
("Arbuthnot", "the Group" or "ABG")
Audited
Final Results for the year to 31 December 2023
Strategic plan progress
delivers strong, profitable growth
Arbuthnot Banking Group today
announces its audited results for the year ended 31 December
2023.
Arbuthnot Banking Group PLC is the
holding company for Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Limited ("Arbuthnot
Latham").
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
· Profit Before Tax of £47.1m (2022: £20.0m), an increase of
135%
· Operating income increased to £178.9m (2022:
£137.4m)
· Average net margin of 5.7% (2022: 5.1%)
· Earnings per share increased by 103% to 222.8p (2022:
109.6p)
· Final dividend declared increased by 2p to 27p (2022:
25p)
· Total dividend per share for the year of 46p (2022: 42p), an
increase of 10%
· Net
assets of £252.4m (2022: £212.0m)
· Year-end net assets per share of 1547p (2022:
1411p)
· CET1
ratio of 13.0% (2022: 11.6%) and total capital ratio of 15.2%
(2022: 14.0%), well above the Group's minimum
requirements
· Substantial surplus liquidity at the year-end of £962m above
the regulatory minimum (2022: £535m)
OPERATIONAL HIGHLIGHTS
· Customer deposits increased 21% to £3.8bn (2022: £3.1bn)
driven by the success of the Group's relationship-based approach
across both Private & Commercial Banking
· Customer loans increased 6% to £2.3bn (2022: £2.2bn)* as the
Group tightened its credit appetite during the year
· Funds under management and administration increased 29% to
£1.71bn (2022: £1.33bn)
· Successful £12m placing completed in May 2023
· Tier
2 debt instrument renewed and increased from £25m to £26m at more
favourable rates and is due to draw down in June 2024
· Secured a new office located at 20 Finsbury Circus with space
for growth
Commenting on the results, Sir
Henry Angest, Chairman and Chief Executive of Arbuthnot, said:
"Arbuthnot delivered an exceptional performance in 2023, enabled by
the continued delivery of the Group's "Future State 2" strategic
plan, focused on diversification, first-rate client service and
helped by rising interest rates. We are confident that the
continued delivery of our strategic plan will enable Arbuthnot to
prosper through the softening monetary environment we anticipate in
the year ahead."
Note:
* This balance includes both Customer loans and assets
available for lease.
The Directors of the Company
accept responsibility for the contents of this
announcement.
ENQUIRIES:
|
|
|
|
Arbuthnot Banking Group
|
0207 012 2400
|
Sir Henry Angest, Chairman and
Chief Executive
|
|
Andrew Salmon, Group Chief
Operating Officer
|
|
James Cobb, Group Finance
Director
|
|
|
|
Grant Thornton UK LLP (Nominated
Adviser and AQSE Corporate Adviser)
|
0207 383 5100
|
Colin Aaronson
|
|
Samantha Harrison
|
|
Ciara Donnelly
|
|
|
|
Shore Capital (Broker)
|
0207 408 4090
|
Daniel Bush
|
|
David Coaten
|
|
Tom Knibbs
|
|
|
|
H/Advisors (Financial
PR)
|
0207 379 5151
|
Sam Cartwright
|
|
The 2023 Annual Report and Notice
of Meeting will be available on the Arbuthnot Banking Group website
http://www.arbuthnotgroup.com on or before 16 April 2024. Copies
will then be available from the Company Secretary, Arbuthnot
Banking Group PLC, Arbuthnot House, 7 Wilson Street, London, EC2M
2SN, when practicable.
Consolidated statement of comprehensive
income
|
|
|
Year
ended 31 December
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
Note
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Income from banking
activities
|
|
|
|
|
Interest income
|
8
|
|
231,836
|
120,013
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
(95,217)
|
(20,932)
|
Net interest income
|
|
|
136,619
|
99,081
|
Fee and commission
income
|
9
|
|
23,170
|
21,586
|
Fee and commission
expense
|
|
|
(768)
|
(537)
|
Net fee and commission income
|
|
|
22,402
|
21,049
|
Operating income from banking activities
|
|
|
159,021
|
120,130
|
Income from leasing
activities
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue
|
10
|
|
100,952
|
99,367
|
Cost of goods sold
|
10
|
|
(81,074)
|
(82,109)
|
Gross profit from leasing activities
|
10
|
|
19,878
|
17,258
|
Total group operating income
|
|
|
178,899
|
137,388
|
Net impairment loss on financial
assets
|
11
|
|
(3,191)
|
(5,503)
|
Loss on sale of commercial
property held as inventory
|
|
|
-
|
(4,590)
|
Other income
|
12
|
|
2,522
|
1,627
|
Operating expenses
|
13
|
|
(131,113)
|
(108,913)
|
Profit before tax
|
|
|
47,117
|
20,009
|
Income tax expense
|
14
|
|
(11,738)
|
(3,551)
|
Profit after tax
|
|
|
35,379
|
16,458
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other comprehensive income
|
|
|
|
|
Items that will not be
reclassified to profit or loss
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in fair value of equity
investments at fair value through other comprehensive
income
|
|
|
412
|
627
|
Tax on other comprehensive
income
|
|
|
(91)
|
(128)
|
Other comprehensive income for the period, net of
tax
|
|
|
321
|
499
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
|
|
35,700
|
16,957
|
|
|
|
|
|
Earnings per share for profit attributable to the equity
holders of the Company during the year
|
(expressed in pence per
share):
|
|
|
|
|
Basic earnings per share
|
16
|
|
222.8
|
109.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
Diluted earnings per share
|
16
|
|
222.8
|
109.6
|
Consolidated statement of financial
position
|
|
|
At 31
December
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
Note
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
17
|
|
826,559
|
732,729
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
18
|
|
79,381
|
115,787
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
19
|
|
942,437
|
439,753
|
Assets classified as held for
sale
|
20
|
|
3,281
|
3,279
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
21
|
|
4,214
|
6,322
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
23
|
|
2,064,217
|
2,036,077
|
Other assets
|
25
|
|
57,150
|
52,185
|
Financial investments
|
26
|
|
3,942
|
3,404
|
Deferred tax asset
|
27
|
|
-
|
2,425
|
Intangible assets
|
28
|
|
29,587
|
32,549
|
Property, plant and
equipment
|
29
|
|
274,306
|
175,273
|
Right-of-use assets
|
30
|
|
52,816
|
7,714
|
Investment property
|
31
|
|
5,950
|
6,550
|
Total assets
|
|
|
4,343,840
|
3,614,047
|
EQUITY AND LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Equity attributable to owners of the parent
|
|
|
|
|
Share capital
|
38
|
|
167
|
154
|
Share premium
|
38
|
|
11,606
|
-
|
Retained earnings
|
39
|
|
240,606
|
212,037
|
Other reserves
|
39
|
|
61
|
(213)
|
Total equity
|
|
|
252,440
|
211,978
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
32
|
|
193,410
|
236,027
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
21
|
|
1,032
|
135
|
Deposits from customers
|
33
|
|
3,759,567
|
3,092,549
|
Current tax liability
|
|
|
294
|
1,748
|
Other liabilities
|
34
|
|
40,700
|
26,144
|
Deferred tax liability
|
27
|
|
4,910
|
-
|
Lease liabilities
|
35
|
|
53,761
|
7,872
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
36
|
|
37,726
|
37,594
|
Total liabilities
|
|
|
4,091,400
|
3,402,069
|
Total equity and liabilities
|
|
|
4,343,840
|
3,614,047
|
|
Chairman's statement
Arbuthnot Banking Group ("ABG" or
"The Group") is pleased to report a profit before tax of £47.1m.
This represents a continued trend of improved financial performance
compared to the prior years and an increase of 135% over 2022 which
was £20.0m.
While the Group has been
developing its business in accordance with the "Future State 2"
strategic plan, the financial results have also benefited from the
continued upward movement in the Bank of England ("BOE") base rate
which increased from 3.5% to 5.25% in 2023. The impact of this has
been two-fold.
Firstly, the significant surplus
liquidity balances that the Bank holds at the BOE have earned more
income in line with the higher rates. Secondly, the lending
balances that are linked to the base rate have repriced
immediately, while the cost of deposits has naturally lagged
behind, despite the Bank quickly adjusting its rates in favour of
depositors. This is due to the fact that fixed rate deposits have
to reach their maturity in order to be able to take advantage of
the higher rates. Typically, it takes 12 months for the lag to
completely catch up with current pricing levels. Clearly, the
reverse will be the case in a falling rate environment.
We have begun a strategy of
locking in higher rates by offering more fixed rate lending
products and also switching some of our surplus liquidity into high
quality fixed income assets such as Gilts with a short maturity
date. This, we hope, will soften the impact of any rate reductions
in the near future.
Highlights
My long-held belief that has been
borne out in the strategy of the Group over the years is that of
diversification and I was pleased to see this evidenced during the
year.
The Bank continued its strong
growth, especially in its ability to attract new deposits. This has
been particularly apparent within the Commercial Banking division,
where the fact that customers enjoy private banking levels of
service seems to resonate well in this market, where the larger
banks have left companies underserved.
Deposit balances ended the year at
£3.8bn, an increase of 21%. During the year we opened up
relationships in new sectors such as the construction and computer
gaming industries. This gave us the ability to allow
non-relationship deposits to mature, without us needing to compete
on price to retain the balances.
Elsewhere in the Group, our asset
finance business, Renaissance Asset Finance ("RAF"), delivered a
strong increase in its customer balances which grew from £134m to
close the year at £199m, an increase of 49% with both of its
business sectors, "flow" and "block discounting", seeing good
levels of new loan originations. Continuing the theme of
diversification RAF has added "wholesale financing" to its product
set and this will come online in 2024.
Asset Alliance, our vehicle
leasing business, also delivered outstanding growth with its assets
available for lease growing to £327m from £189m in the prior year,
an increase of 73%. This growth was enabled not only by the
improvements in the supply chain for new trucks, but also the fact
that it now has access to the Group's funding resources. This
allowed it to complete the purchase of a £50m portfolio of buses
used in the Transport for London network. Asset Alliance now has an
8% market share of buses used in London.
Finally, I would like to highlight
the performance of our Wealth Management division that grew its
Funds Under Management and Administration by 29% to close at
£1.7bn, exhibiting strong investment performance against peers,
despite uncertain markets across the globe.
20 Finsbury Circus
As previously announced, we are
all looking forward to the next phase of the Group's future; in
2023 we celebrated our 190th anniversary given that Arbuthnot
Latham was founded in 1833. Our confidence in the future is
demonstrated by the fact that we have secured an impressive new
head office located at 20 Finsbury Circus, situated in the heart of
the city not far from our current location.
The new building offers us 45%
more space to grow and will allow us to bring our London operations
together under one roof. This should provide more collaboration and
allow the next generation of Arbuthnot Bankers to develop and
perhaps even set an example for more workers in the City to return
to working more frequently in such a vibrant global financial
centre, that is the City of London.
Capital Raise
The continuing theme for
regulators of the increasing requirement for banks to hold more
capital, coupled with the current market opportunities that are
presenting themselves to the Group, led us to decide to push ahead
with a capital raise via a conditional placing.
Initially we intended to raise
£10m but we were pleasantly surprised to find that demand for the
publicly available allocation was heavily oversubscribed, so the
issue was increased to £12m to satisfy some of this excess demand.
This capital raise was completed on 5 May.
Later in the year we were also
pleased to agree the early refinancing of the Tier 2 debt
instrument that we had previously issued to P Capital Partners, a
Swedish debt fund, in 2019. We appreciate their confidence in both
our business and management team, which resulted in the extension
of this loan for another 10 years at a lower margin than before. We
hope this relationship can continue into the future beyond even
this new issue.
Regulation
As we have become accustomed in
recent years, the pace of regulatory change has not slowed and
there are a number of significant issues in consultation for which
we need to be prepared.
Basel 3.1 is likely to become
applicable to the Group in 2026. This is later than the generally
applicable date as we will be a late adopter, given that we have
applied to become part of the new Small Domestic Deposit Takers
("SDDT") regime which is the evolution of "Strong and
Simple".
We are waiting for the capital
rules for such to be revealed in the second quarter of this year.
While many of the rules have been sign-posted, we continue to hold
out hope that the capital buffer regime will be altered to address
the unintended consequences of the counter cyclical buffer. It is
clear from evidence during COVID that no bank will utilise this
buffer in its current form in down turns for fear of the speed at
which it is brought back. This means about 20% of the industry's
capital has been sterilised and is unproductive. A change in status
of this buffer could provide economic growth without creating undue
risk in the banking sector.
I never doubted the need for
strong regulation to promote safety and soundness of the banking
industry and I believe confidence in the sector continues to grow.
It is my hope that this confidence will empower regulators to
permit the development of a diverse set of banks with different
business models, which is likely to create less inherent risk in
the industry.
Board Changes and Personnel
During the year I was pleased to
welcome Jayne Almond, Angela Knight, and Lord Sassoon to the Board.
We are delighted to attract such notable directors to our company.
They bring with them a wealth of knowledge and experience gained
through their respective careers. I look forward to receiving their
advice and counsel on how we can further develop the
Group.
As always, the continued success
of the Group reflects the hard work and commitment of our members
of staff, who are our greatest asset. On behalf of the Board, I
extend our thanks to all of them for their contribution in 2023.
Finally, I would like to thank my fellow directors on both Boards
for their help and advice during the year.
Dividend
In 2022 we increased the
trajectory of growth in the dividend, and given the continued
positive outlook for the Group, this is maintained.
The Board therefore are
recommending a final dividend of 27p per share. This is an increase
of 2p compared to the final dividend of 2022. The final dividend,
if approved at the 2024 AGM, will be paid on 31 May 2024 to
shareholders on the register at the close of business on 19 April
2024.
Together with the interim dividend
of 19p per share, this gives a total dividend for the year of 46p
per share, which compares to the total dividend of 42p per share
paid in 2022.
Outlook
The interest rate environment
appears to have reached the top of the current cycle and many
analysts are now predicting reductions in the future. Whilst this
will have an impact on the profitability of the Group; in the long
run, the opportunities for Arbuthnot to grow and prosper continue
to be undiminished. Therefore, we remain focused on delivering on
our strategic plan.
Strategic Report - Business Review
|
|
|
|
Group Key Metrics
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Operating income
|
|
£178.9m
|
£137.4m
|
Other income
|
|
£2.5m
|
£1.6m
|
Operating expenses
|
|
£131.1m
|
£108.9m
|
Profit before tax
|
|
£47.1m
|
£20.0m
|
Customer
loans1
|
|
£2.3bn
|
£2.2bn
|
Customer deposits
|
|
£3.8bn
|
£3.1bn
|
Total assets
|
|
£4.3bn
|
£3.6bn
|
|
|
|
|
Key Performance Indicators
|
|
|
|
Funds under management and
administration
|
£1.7bn
|
£1.3bn
|
Average net margin
2
|
|
5.7%
|
5.1%
|
Loan to deposit ratio
3
|
|
62.0%
|
71.4%
|
|
|
|
|
1 This balance includes both
customer loans and assets available for lease.
|
2 Average net margin: Gross
interest income yield less average interest rate on customer
deposits
|
3 Loan to deposit ratio:
Customer loans divided by customer deposits (prior year restated to
include assets available for lease)
|
The Bank of England Base Rate
(BBR) continued to rise throughout 2023 starting the year at 3.50%
and finishing at a 15-year high of 5.25% with a rise of 1.75% in
the year. Although it seems that inflation has stabilised and in
response the Bank of England has steadied its base rate, the effect
of the higher interest rate environment and the rate of increase
has significantly contributed to the Group's income. As a
consequence of the rate rises the Bank has passed on the increases
to its depositors, however two factors have reduced the cost to the
Bank. Firstly, the rate of the Bank's fixed term deposits lag
behind the base rate rises, with balances placed at lower rates in
previous periods yet to mature. Secondly, high levels of call
balances were held for much of the year. However, towards the end
of the year, the Bank saw increased activity of depositors
switching balances to higher yielding term products, based on the
expectation that interest rates have peaked. These factors will
increase the cost of deposits going forward, while the rate of
increase in BBR compared to that of deposit pricing has contributed
significantly to an increased net interest income for
2023.
As signalled in the prior year's
Annual Report, the current economic environment has resulted in
economy-wide headwinds for borrowers. However, the non-performing
loan book has reduced to its lowest level in over three years with
credit metrics showing no signs of material stress. The average
loan to value ("LTV") against the loan book remains low at 47.8%
(2022: 52.5%), giving significant levels of security to withstand
and minimise the effect of any potential falls in the property
markets.
Despite higher inflation and
interest rates, the prospect of further increases in interest rates
and inflation has receded. Consequently, the outlook for economic
conditions has improved over the last twelve months, notably with
the outlook for residential property values expected to fall 6.4%
compared to 11.6% the prior year and commercial property values
expected to fall 4.9% compared to 21.2% the prior year. These
factors have resulted in a release of £0.2m from the expected
credit loss provision.
Counteracting the benefit from the
base rate increases, inflation has produced upward pressure on the
cost base. Notably salary costs have increased due to not only
growth in headcount but also increases in annual pay awards, as the
cost-of-living crisis started to interact with full employment and
the competition for talent intensified.
The Bank finished the year with
total deposits of £3.8bn compared to £3.1bn for the prior year and
continued to pursue its strategy of funding the specialist lending
divisions with cheaper yet sticky balances from relationship driven
deposit account clients. Whilst the Bank experienced upward
pressure on rates, it did not compete for deposits on the
non-relationship aggregator platforms.
Lending balances (including lease
assets) finished the year at £2.3bn, compared to £2.2bn in the
previous year. However, as mentioned in the previous year's Annual
Report and Accounts, the Bank tightened its credit appetite and
reduced LTVs for new lending below its historic guidance of 60%
which has reduced lending volumes. However, the increased levels of
profitability, mean the Bank is well positioned to retain financial
resources for future opportunities that are expected to arise given
the market dislocation.
In April 2023, the Group carried
out a successful capital raise of £12m with demand heavily
oversubscribed against the original target of £10m. The capital
raise has allowed the Group to maintain growth momentum, whilst
continuing to pursue its strategic objectives.
Included on the balance sheet is
the Right of Use Asset for the Group's new London Office at 20
Finsbury Circus. The building is approximately 75,000 square feet,
which equates to an increase of 45% compared to the current office
space. Given the robust position in which the Group finds itself
and its predicted future growth prospects, it has secured a new
long-term solution for its office premises. The planned fit-out,
due to be completed in the third quarter of 2024, will provide both
high specification working space and also new client meeting and
entertainment suites, which will help to deepen the relationship
banking offering that is proving successful in both our Private and
Commercial banking businesses. The increased footprint and
depreciation of the fit-out costs will increase the annual
expenditure on premises by approximately £5.0m on a steady state
basis. During 2024 the Group will also incur the additional cost of
running both premises until the lease on our current office ends in
October 2024.
As in prior years, the Group's
profit excludes the profit on the sale of trucks generated by Asset
Alliance of £4.3m (2022: £6.5m), following the acquisition
accounting in 2021. At the year end the uplift on the portfolio of
assets from the acquisition has been fully realised through sales,
meaning any gains or losses for future disposals will be recognised
in the income statement as and when they are sold.
Banking
The Banking business continued to
deliver growth in client acquisition, for both lending and deposit
products, leveraging off the underlying relationship management
franchise whilst supporting the strategic aims of the wider group.
The Bank continued to focus on existing segments across Private
& Commercial Banking, as well as entering new emerging segments
with long term growth opportunities such as Technology and E-games
where the Bank's capability and relationship management focus fits
well with the needs of the market.
Deposits finished the year at
£3.8bn, equating to growth in excess of 23% compared to £3.1bn the
previous year end, generating liquidity to be deployed across the
Group. This was despite a number of non-relationship deposits that
were exited during the year.
Given the higher interest rate
environment, there was a trend with clients being more proactive in
managing deposits transferring to time from current and call
products for improved returns. Despite this, strong client
acquisition in the year continued to contribute to growth in
current balances. It is expected that the competitive environment
for low-cost deposits will increase, however, the Bank's client
service led model is well placed against potential headwinds albeit
at a lower growth rate than the current year.
The cost of deposits has increased
steadily throughout the year, as the effect of increases in
interest rates lag behind as fixed rate deposits are repriced when
they mature, ultimately narrowing the Bank's net interest margin.
Deposit pricing stabilised towards the latter part of the year,
however, the full year effect of the increased pricing will cause
downward pressure on the 2024 financial result. The Bank's
relationship banking model combined with competitive pricing
supports the strategy to grow relationship deposits rather than
rely on more expensive best buy table deposit rates. Over the long
term, this will provide material value to the Group in a normalised
interest rate environment.
The loan book was £1.4bn at the
year-end (2022: £1.5bn). Despite the inherent credit risk in the
current environment, the book continued to perform robustly,
supported by the Bank's conservative credit appetite, which was
tightened over a year ago in the wake of economic uncertainty. The
pressure of a higher interest rate environment on clients has
resulted in reduced debt levels that businesses can raise and
sustain, however there has been a trend of clients opting to pay
down debt from surplus liquidity in order to mitigate the effect of
higher interest rates. The Bank will continue to operate its long
held principle of operating a conservative credit appetite, and
deploying capital only where disciplined risk and return hurdles
are met.
Wealth Management
Funds Under Management and
Administration increased by 29% during 2023, to £1.7bn (2022:
£1.3bn), with gross inflows of £437m, representing 33% of balances
at the start of the year. The year's backdrop of rising interest
rates negatively impacted outflows as clients elected to pay down
debt secured against investments and accelerate gifts to children
when acquiring property to mitigate the need to take out more
costly mortgages, resulting in gross outflows of £165m for the
period.
Wealth Planning issued advice on
£151m of new assets, a similar value compared with 2022,
representing approximately 64% of discretionary asset inflows. A
total of 139 clients were onboarded during 2023, broadly consistent
with the prior year.
The business made good progress
against a key strategic objective, to stream-line the investment
suitability process which is expected to improve client outcomes
and generate internal process efficiencies.
Mortgage Portfolios
Balances for the Banks's acquired
mortgage portfolio was £123.7m at the year-end (2022: £149.0m). The
portfolio continues to perform in line with
expectations.
Arbuthnot Commercial Asset Based Lending
("ACABL")
ACABL reported a profit of £8.5m
(2022: £5.2m), an increase of 63% compared to the prior year which
was largely generated through higher client volume generating
increased interest charges and service fees.
ACABL completed 17 new
transactions in 2023 (2022: 30) with £73.1m of facilities
written.
Despite the increase in
profitability, at the year-end, the business reported drawn
balances of £239.8m with a further £115m available for drawdown
(2022: £268.8m with further £91.8m available for drawdown) equating
to a fall of 11% year on year. The fall was driven by a combination
of lower origination due to the macro-economic environment, along
with expected attrition, as the business entered its sixth year and
some of the original client's facilities reached maturity. This was
compounded by some clients holding higher levels of undrawn
availability than historically seen.
Inflationary pressures, a higher
interest rate environment and ongoing supply chain challenges
resulted in a significant reduction in the number of event-driven
transactions in the marketplace in addition to fewer Private Equity
backed buy-outs, with the latter being traditionally the mainstay
of new business. The business also wrote fewer refinancing deals
given the market challenges and cautious risk appetite with
extensions favouring existing lenders.
As expected in the context of the
current macro-economic environment, the business observed a higher
number of watchlist clients compared to previous periods. However,
the business model of lending against high-quality realisable
assets along with a low ratio of clients to client manager resulted
in no incurred losses for the year. The expected credit loss rate
on the book remains low at 9.8bps.
The average deal size increased
from £5.1m to £5.8m with a total client base of 104 at year-end.
(2022: 102). Facility limits of £536m (2022: £523m) remained
relatively flat, with clients continuing to operate in a broad
range of sectors, underlining the spread and diverse nature of the
portfolio.
In line with the reported strong
growth in profits, the business processed £2.3bn of invoices during
the year, an increase of 15% on the prior year.
Renaissance Asset Finance ("RAF")
RAF reported a profit before tax
of £1.6m (2022: £0.2m) with a loan book of £198.8m equating to an
increase of 49% compared to the prior year end balance of
£133.8m.
The average margin achieved on new
business grew strongly in the higher interest rate environment
along with the volume of new deals written being at the highest
level seen in RAF since the business was acquired in
2017.
The new Block Discounting business
launched in late 2021 began to mature with strong growth in the
latter part of the year, delivering a positive contribution to the
profitability of the business.
The increase in forbearance cases
and problem accounts seen during the pandemic period has now been
worked through, with a majority of positive outcomes and whilst the
economic environment has caused some client strain, particularly in
sectors such as construction, the loan book performance remains
well within tolerance levels.
RAF does provide finance via
brokers to enable our borrowers to purchase motor vehicles.
However, the business does not have regulatory permissions to carry
out regulated lending, so this is carried out on an unregulated
basis.
Arbuthnot Specialist Finance ("ASFL")
The ASFL loan book reduced from
£14.9m as at 31 December 2022 to £3.1m at the year end.
ASFL was closed for new business
early in 2023, with the book being run-down for the remainder of
2023. Repayments are currently ahead of schedule.
Asset Alliance Group ("AAG")
AAG reported a loss before tax of
£3.2m (2022: £2.1m loss). As at 31 December 2023 the business had
assets available for lease and finance leases totalling £326.8m
(2022: £189.1m), with strong growth in new lending equating to an
increase of 73% over the year.
Strategic diversification into new
lending channels particularly in the Bus & Coach sector,
including a dedicated Bus Rental Division launched towards the end
of 2023, contributed to the portfolio's growth.
During the year the supply of new
commercial vehicles gradually returned to a degree of normality,
albeit the cost per unit remains significantly higher than
pre-COVID levels and is unlikely to reduce in the foreseeable
future. New vehicle leases were subdued in the first half of the
year, with a recovery in the latter part of the year.
The market for the disposal of
previously leased vehicles was lower than historically seen,
particularly in the second half of 2023. This was not entirely
unexpected given the increased supply of used assets into the
market the previous year and the increased supply of new assets in
2023. Whilst demand for used assets slowed, encouragingly margins
remained in line with previous years.
During the year the remaining fair
value adjustment of £6.8m at the start of the year, recognised at
acquisition of the business, was fully realised following the sale
of assets; along with the remaining residual value provision of
£2.5m. Future gains or losses from asset disposals will be
recognised in the income statement as and when they are
sold.
Owned Properties
The Bank retains four assets in
its property portfolio of which one is overseas.
As a result of higher interest
rates, property investment yields have also risen. However, the
effect of inflationary increases in rental income delayed until
scheduled rent reviews, has resulted in property values being
marked down. £2.6m of impairments have been charged to the income
statement for the Group's property portfolio.
Operations
The Bank has continued to drive
positive momentum in the acquisition of clients from its target
markets. Net growth in new clients has been strong with over 1,200
new banking clients onboarded in 2023, of which 62% were
non-personal clients. This growth has seen operational aspects of
the business continue to increase, with over 1 million inbound and
outbound payments processed in 2023, a growth of 12% on the
previous year. 98% of outbound payments were originated online,
underpinning the need for continued investment in the Bank's
digital strategy.
During 2023, the Bank achieved a
97% increase in the volume of fixed term deposits as clients took
advantage of the increase in interest rates to lock in a guaranteed
low risk return on their money by moving from instant access
accounts and placing their money into longer term fixed rate
deposits.
Work continued on meeting the
regulatory requirements under Statement (SS) 1/21: Impact
Tolerances for Important Business Services, with a focus on further
embedding continuity plans and enhancing technology resilience, as
well as further investment in the Bank's Investment Management
Operations, focusing on increasing automation and streamlining of
processes which supported an increase in trading of 9% with the
total value of trades up 38% to nearly £2bn.
In 2023, the Bank continued to
invest in systems and infrastructure, initiating the final phase of
its migration to the cloud along with developing a digital roadmap
aimed at improving the customer experience and organisational
efficiency over the coming years. Additionally, work commenced in
2023 on a significant transformation project to upgrade the Bank's
online and mobile banking offering.
Sustainability
The business has made a commitment
to reduce its environmental impact and to improve its environmental
performance as an integral part of its business
strategy.
Strategic Report - Financial Review
Arbuthnot Banking Group adopts a
pragmatic approach to risk taking and seeks to maximise long term
revenues and returns. Given its relative size, it is nimble
and able to remain entrepreneurial and capable of taking advantage
of favourable market opportunities when they arise.
The Group provides a range of
financial services to clients and customers in its chosen markets
of Banking, Wealth Management, Asset Finance, Asset Based Lending,
Specialist Lending and Commercial Vehicle Finance. The Group's
revenues are derived from a combination of net interest income from
lending, deposit taking and treasury activities, fees for services
provided and commission earned on the sale of financial products.
The Group also earns rental income on its properties and holds
financial investments for income.
Highlights
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
136,619
|
99,081
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
22,398
|
21,049
|
Operating income from banking
activities
|
159,017
|
120,130
|
|
|
|
Revenue
|
100,952
|
99,367
|
Cost of goods sold
|
(81,074)
|
(82,109)
|
Operating income from leasing
activities
|
19,878
|
17,258
|
|
|
|
Total group operating
income
|
178,895
|
137,388
|
Other income
|
2,526
|
1,627
|
Loss on sale of commercial
property held as inventory
|
-
|
(4,590)
|
Operating expenses
|
(131,113)
|
(108,913)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances to customers
|
(3,191)
|
(5,503)
|
Profit before tax
|
47,117
|
20,009
|
Income tax expense
|
(11,738)
|
(3,551)
|
Profit after tax
|
35,379
|
16,458
|
|
|
|
Basic earnings per share
(pence)
|
222.8
|
109.6
|
The Group has reported a profit
before tax of £47.1m (2022: £20.0m). The underlying profit before
tax was £51.4m (2022: £31.1m).
Total operating income earned by
the Group was £178.9m compared to £137.4m for the prior year. The
higher interest rate environment has significantly contributed to
the Group's income. This was as a result of significant excess
liquidity held at the BOE, together with lending linked to the BOE
base rate that has repriced immediately, while fixed rate deposits
naturally lag behind as these are only repriced on maturity. With
the general consensus in the market that rates are expected to
fall, the Group has shifted its focus to longer term fixed rate
lending products and also started to invest some of the excess
liquidity into high quality and short dated fixed income assets,
such as gilts. This will hopefully soften the impact as interest
rates start to come down in the near future. The average net margin
on client lending was 5.7% (2022: 5.1%). Also included in operating
income is revenue from AAG leased assets of £19.9m (2022:
£17.3m).
The Group's operating expenses
increased to £131.1m compared to £108.9m for the prior year. Higher
staff costs (£8.2m), further investment in information technology
(£6.7m higher than in 2022), a combined impairment of £2.6m on the
remaining investment property, property held for sale and held as
inventory, and the general expansion of all businesses contributed
to the increase.
|
|
|
|
There are a number of specific
items which are included in the result for the year that should be
noted. These are detailed and compared to the equivalent adjusted
amount for the prior year in the tables below.
|
Underlying profit/(loss)
reconciliation
|
Arbuthnot Latham & Co.
|
Group
Centre
|
Arbuthnot Banking Group
|
31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Profit before tax and group
recharges
|
62,688
|
(15,573)
|
47,115
|
Profits realised on sale of trucks
previously included in bargain purchase
|
4,267
|
-
|
4,267
|
Underlying profit
|
66,955
|
(15,573)
|
51,382
|
|
|
|
|
Underlying basic earnings per
share (pence)
|
|
|
244.6
|
Underlying profit
reconciliation
|
Arbuthnot Latham & Co.
|
Group
Centre
|
Arbuthnot Banking Group
|
31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Profit before tax and group
recharges
|
32,865
|
(12,856)
|
20,009
|
Profits realised on sale of trucks
previously included in bargain purchase
|
6,479
|
-
|
6,479
|
Loss on sale of King Street
Property
|
4,590
|
-
|
4,590
|
Underlying profit
|
43,934
|
(12,856)
|
31,078
|
|
|
|
|
Underlying basic earnings per
share (pence)
|
|
|
169.2
|
In 2021, the Group acquired Asset
Alliance Group Holdings Limited. The business was acquired at a
discount to its fair value resulting in a bargain purchase of
£8.6m. Included in the fair value adjustments at acquisition was an
uplift to the valuation of lease assets, together with a residual
value provision. The remaining fair value uplift of £6.8m at the
beginning of the year, has been realised through sales of vehicles
in the year (2022: £6.9m realised). Similarly, the remaining
residual value provision at the beginning of the year of £2.5m was
released (2022: £0.4m released). In future years, no adjustment
will therefore be required.
|
|
|
Balance Sheet Strength
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Balance
Sheet
|
£000
|
£000
|
Assets
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
2,064,217
|
2,036,077
|
Assets available for
lease
|
267,591
|
171,738
|
Liquid assets
|
1,848,377
|
1,288,269
|
Other assets
|
163,655
|
117,963
|
Total assets
|
4,343,840
|
3,614,047
|
|
|
|
Liabilities
|
|
|
Customer deposits
|
3,759,567
|
3,092,549
|
Other liabilities
|
331,833
|
309,520
|
Total liabilities
|
4,091,400
|
3,402,069
|
Equity
|
252,440
|
211,978
|
Total equity and
liabilities
|
4,343,840
|
3,614,047
|
Total assets increased by £0.7bn
to £4.3bn (2022: £3.6bn). Loans and advances to customers together
with assets available for lease increased by 6% from the prior
year. Customer deposits increased by 22% in the year and
contributed to the 44% increase in liquid assets.
The net assets of the Group now
stand at £15.47 per share (2022: £14.11).
Capital Raise
An intended £10m capital raise
through a conditional placing was significantly oversubscribed and
resulted in £12m (£11.6m after costs) of extra capital. The capital
raise was completed on 5 May.
Later in the year the Tier 2 debt
instrument from P Capital Partners was refinanced early and
extended for a further 10 years at a lower margin than before. The
facility was also increased from £25m to £26m and is due to draw
down in 2024.
Segmental Analysis
The segmental analysis is shown in
more detail in Note 45. The Group is organised into nine operating
segments as disclosed below:
1) Banking - Includes Private and
Commercial Banking. Private Banking - Provides traditional private
banking services. Commercial Banking -
Provides bespoke commercial banking services and tailored secured
lending against property investments and other assets.
2) Wealth Management - Financial
planning and investment management services.
3) Mortgage Portfolios - Acquired
mortgage portfolios.
4) RAF - Specialist asset finance
lender mainly in high value cars but also business
assets.
5) ACABL - Provides finance
secured on either invoices, assets or stock of the
borrower.
6) ASFL - Provides short term
secured lending solutions to professional and entrepreneurial
property investors. This segment is being wound down.
7) AAG - Provides vehicle finance
and related services, predominantly in the truck & trailer and
bus & coach markets.
8) All Other Divisions - All other
smaller divisions and central costs in Arbuthnot Latham & Co.,
Ltd (Investment property and Central costs)
9) Group Centre - ABG Group
management.
The analysis presented below, and
in the business review, is before any consolidation adjustments to
reverse the impact of the intergroup operating activities and also
intergroup recharges and is a fair reflection of the way the
Directors manage the Group.
|
|
|
Banking
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
114,131
|
64,565
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
2,613
|
2,803
|
Operating income
|
116,744
|
67,368
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(15,318)
|
(14,795)
|
Operating expenses - indirect
costs
|
(36,755)
|
(31,888)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances to customers
|
(1,227)
|
(1,547)
|
Profit before tax
|
63,444
|
19,138
|
Banking reported a profit before
tax of £63.4m (2022: £19.1m). This equated to a more than threefold
increase from the prior year. Net interest income grew by 77%,
while lending remained flat and deposit balances increased by 21%.
The significantly higher net interest income is the result of
successive increases in the BOE Base Rate, with the Bank earning
higher income from both customer loans and excess deposits held
mainly at the Bank of England reserve account. This was partly
offset by higher interest paid on deposit balances.
There was a net impairment charge
of £1.2m compared to £1.5m for the prior year. The lower charge in
the year was as a result of revised economic scenarios applied in
the expected credit loss models due to a more positive future
outlook, most notably a reduction in the expected fall in property
values (both residential and commercial).
Indirectly allocated operating
costs increased by £4.9m, mainly as a result of increased staff
costs in support departments and further investment in information
technology.
Customer loan balances reduced by
£13m to remain flat from the prior year at £1.4bn and customer
deposits increased to £3.8bn (2022: £3.1bn). The average loan to
value was 47.8% (2022: 52.5%).
Wealth Management
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
11,328
|
10,689
|
Operating income
|
11,328
|
10,689
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(10,097)
|
(9,237)
|
Operating expenses - indirect
costs
|
(5,487)
|
(5,553)
|
Loss before tax
|
(4,256)
|
(4,101)
|
Wealth Management reported a loss
of £4.3m (2022: loss of £4.1m). Fee and commission income increased
by £0.6m and was more than offset by a £0.8m increase in costs.
Funds Under Management and Administration increased by £0.4bn to
£1.7bn, with most of the increase in the latter part of the final
quarter.
Mortgage Portfolios
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
4,245
|
5,110
|
Operating income
|
4,245
|
5,110
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(833)
|
(935)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances to customers
|
(821)
|
(415)
|
Profit before tax
|
2,591
|
3,760
|
The Mortgage Portfolios reported a
profit of £2.6m (2022: £3.8m). Net interest income reduced by
£0.9m, as the loan book went down by £24.8m in the
year.
The Santiago mortgage portfolio
performed as expected and the year-end balance was £123.7m (2022:
£148.5m).
|
|
|
RAF
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
8,044
|
5,545
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
34
|
32
|
Operating income
|
8,078
|
5,577
|
Other income
|
170
|
82
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(5,634)
|
(4,697)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances
|
(982)
|
(768)
|
Profit before tax
|
1,632
|
194
|
Renaissance Asset Finance returned
a profit of £1.6m (2022: £0.2m). Interest income increased by £3.7m
from higher balances and higher rates, which was partly offset by
higher funding costs of £1.2m. Operating expenses were £0.9m higher
than in 2022 due to higher staff costs and general expansion of the
business.
Customer loan balances increased
by 49% to £198.8m (2022: £133.8m). The average yield for 2023 was
8.2% (2022: 8.1%).
ACABL
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
8,642
|
6,762
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
6,911
|
5,976
|
Operating income
|
15,553
|
12,738
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(6,777)
|
(5,463)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances to customers
|
(234)
|
(2,082)
|
Profit before tax
|
8,542
|
5,193
|
ACABL recorded a profit before tax
of £8.5m (2022: £5.2m).
Client loan balances were £239.8m
at the end of the year (2022: £268.8m), with issued facilities
increasing to £536m (2022: £523m). Despite a 11% reduction in loan
balances, operating income increased by £2.8m. Higher interest
income of £8.6m was partially offset by higher internal funding
costs of £6.7m, while fee and commission income also increased by
£0.9m. Operating expenses increased by £1.3m, mainly due to an
increase in staff costs.
The prior year impairment charge
included £2m relating to one client that was placed into
administration.
ASFL
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
751
|
713
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
13
|
10
|
Operating income
|
764
|
723
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(1,507)
|
(1,489)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances to customers
|
46
|
(179)
|
Loss before tax
|
(697)
|
(945)
|
ASFL recorded a loss before tax of
£0.7m (2022: loss of £0.9m).
The decision was taken to exit
this market early in 2023.
Customer loan balances closed the
year at £3.1m (2022: £15.0m).
|
|
|
AAG
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest expense
|
(7,864)
|
(4,456)
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
(12)
|
-
|
Revenue
|
100,952
|
99,367
|
Cost of goods sold
|
(81,074)
|
(82,109)
|
Operating income
|
12,002
|
12,802
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(15,093)
|
(14,507)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances to customers
|
(98)
|
(369)
|
Loss before tax
|
(3,189)
|
(2,074)
|
The business generated a loss
before tax of £3.2m (2022: loss of £2.1m for the
period).
As part of the bargain purchase at
acquisition, the carrying value of the truck and trailer fleet was
adjusted by an overall average increase of 15.95% resulting in an
uplift totalling £19.5m. At the same point a provision of £2.9m was
booked relating to residual values, also forming part of the
bargain purchase recognised in 2021. The remaining fair value
uplift of £6.8m at the beginning of the year, has been realised
through sales in the year (2022: £6.9m). Similarly, the remaining
residual value provision at the beginning of the year of £2.5m was
released (2022: £0.4m released). In future years, no adjustment
will therefore be required.
It should be noted that the
current year includes £10.2m internal funding costs compared to
£4.9m in the prior year. While the increasing interest rate
environment in 2023 resulted in higher funding costs, the
adjustment to income earned on lending and assets available for
lease will lag behind, as contracts are only re-priced at the end
of their fixed term.
The supply of new commercial
vehicles gradually returned to a degree of normality, although the
cost per unit remains significantly higher than pre-COVID and is
not expected to reduce in the foreseeable future. New vehicle
leases were subdued but started to recover in the second half of
the year.
The market for the disposal of
second-hand vehicles was lower than historically seen, especially
towards the end of the year. This was expected due to the increased
supply of used assets into the market, as new assets became more
readily available.
In May 2023, AAG acquired a
portfolio of circa 400 buses for £41.3m. All these assets are on
contract to operators within the Transport for London network, and
the portfolio has a range of asset specifications including
electric, hybrid and diesel buses. Following the transaction, AAG
are now one of the main funders of buses within the TfL network,
which leaves them well placed to capitalise on future
opportunities, including the on-going transition to
electric.
Operating expenses increased by
£0.6m from the prior year.
Credit provisions were £0.1m
(2022: £0.4m).
As at 31 December 2023 the
business had a total of £326.8m (2022: £189.1m) of assets available
for lease and finance leases, which is a 73% increase on the prior
year.
|
|
|
Other Divisions
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
13,371
|
23,993
|
Net fee and commission
income
|
1,511
|
1,539
|
Operating income
|
14,882
|
25,532
|
Other income
|
3,191
|
2,385
|
Operating expenses - direct
costs
|
(23,577)
|
(16,074)
|
Impairment losses - loans and
advances to customers
|
125
|
(143)
|
(Loss) / profit before
tax
|
(5,379)
|
11,700
|
The aggregated loss before tax of
other divisions was £5.4m (2022: profit of
£11.7m).
Operating income reduced by £10.7m
to £14.9m (2022: £25.5m), as a result of higher internal funding
costs.
Reported within the other
divisions in other income was rental income on our property
portfolio of £0.7m (2022: £0.5m).
Operating expenses increased
mainly due to higher staff costs, further investment in information
technology and the £2.6m impairment of owned properties (investment
property, property held for sale and held as inventory).
Group Centre
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Summarised Income
Statement
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net interest income
|
(220)
|
(363)
|
Subordinated loan stock
interest
|
(4,481)
|
(2,788)
|
Operating income
|
(4,701)
|
(3,151)
|
Operating expenses
|
(10,877)
|
(9,705)
|
Loss before tax
|
(15,578)
|
(12,856)
|
The Group costs increased to
£15.6m (2022: £12.9m). Subordinated loan interest increased by
£1.7m due to the rising interest rate environment.
The increase in operating expenses
of £1.2m is mainly due to higher staff costs.
Capital
The Group's capital management
policy is focused on optimising shareholder value over the long
term. There is a clear focus on delivering organic growth and
ensuring capital resources are sufficient to support planned levels
of growth. The Board regularly reviews the capital
position.
The Group and the individual
banking operation are authorised by the Prudential Regulation
Authority ("PRA") and regulated by the Financial Conduct Authority
and the Prudential Regulation Authority and are subject to EU
Capital Requirement Regulation (EU No.575/2013) ("CRR") which forms
part of the retained EU legislation (EU legislation which applied
in the UK before 11.00 pm on 31 December 2020 has been retained in
UK law as a form of domestic legislation known as 'retained EU
legislation') and the PRA Rulebook for CRR firms. One of the
requirements for the Group and the individual banking operation is
that capital resources must be in excess of capital requirements at
all times.
In accordance with the parameters
set out in the PRA Rulebook, the Internal Capital Adequacy
Assessment Process ("ICAAP") is embedded in the risk management
framework of the Group. The ICAAP identifies and assesses the risks
to the Group, considers how these risks can be mitigated and
demonstrates that the Group has sufficient resources, after
mitigating actions, to withstand all reasonable
scenarios.
Not all material risks can be
mitigated by capital, but where capital is appropriate the Board
has adopted a "Pillar 1 plus" approach to determine the level of
capital the Group needs to hold. This method takes the Pillar 1
capital requirement for credit, market and operational risk as a
starting point, and then considers whether each of the calculations
delivers a sufficient amount of capital to cover risks to which the
Group is, or could be, exposed. Where the Board considers that the
Pillar 1 calculations do not adequately cover the risks, an
additional Pillar 2A capital requirement is applied. The PRA will
set a Pillar 2A capital requirement in light of the calculations
included within the ICAAP. The Group's Total Capital Requirement,
as issued by the PRA, is the sum of the minimum capital
requirements under the CRR (Pillar 1) and the Pillar 2A
requirement.
The ICAAP document will be updated
at least annually, or more frequently if changes in the business,
strategy, nature or scale of the Group's activities or operational
environment suggest that the current level of capital resources is
no longer adequate. The ICAAP brings together the management
framework (i.e. the policies, procedures, strategies, and systems
that the Group has implemented to identify, manage and mitigate its
risks) and the financial disciplines of business planning and
capital management. The Group's PRA regulated entity is also
the principal trading subsidiary as detailed in Note 44.
The Group's regulatory capital is
divided into two tiers:
• Common equity Tier 1 ("CET1"),
which comprises shareholder funds less regulatory deductions for
intangible assets, including Goodwill and deferred tax assets that
do not arise from temporary differences.
• Tier 2 comprises qualifying
subordinated loans.
Capital ratios are reviewed on a
monthly basis to ensure that external requirements are adhered to.
All regulated trading entities have complied with all of the
externally imposed capital requirements to which they are
subject.
|
2023
|
2022
|
Capital ratios
|
£000
|
£000
|
CET1 Capital
Instruments*
|
252,705
|
212,501
|
Deductions
|
(30,414)
|
(37,126)
|
CET1 Capital after
Deductions
|
222,291
|
175,375
|
Tier 2 Capital
|
37,726
|
37,594
|
Own Funds
|
260,017
|
212,969
|
|
|
|
CET1 Capital Ratio (CET1
Capital/Total Risk Exposure)
|
13.0%
|
11.6%
|
Total Capital Ratio (Own
Funds/Total Risk Exposure)
|
15.2%
|
14.0%
|
* Includes year-end audited
result.
|
|
|
Risks and Uncertainties
The Group regards the monitoring
and controlling of risks and uncertainties as a fundamental part of
the management process. Consequently, senior management are
involved in the development of risk management policies and in
monitoring their application. A detailed description of the
risk management framework and associated policies is set out in
Note 6.
The principal risks inherent in
the Group's business are reputational, macroeconomic and
competitive environment, climate change, strategic, credit, market,
liquidity, operational, cyber, residual value, conduct and,
regulatory and capital.
Reputational
risk
Reputational risk is the risk to
the Group from a failure to meet reasonable stakeholder
expectations as a result of any event, behaviour, action or
inaction by ABG itself, its employees or those with whom it is
associated. This includes the associated risk to earnings, capital
or liquidity.
ABG seeks to ensure that all of
its businesses act consistently with the seven corporate principles
as laid out on page 3 of the Annual Report and Accounts. This is
achieved through a central Risk Management framework and supporting
policies, the application of a three-lines of defence model across
the Group and oversight by various committees. Employees are
supported in training, studies and other ways and encouraged to
live out the cultural values within the Group of integrity, energy
and drive, respect, collaboration and empowerment. In applying the
seven corporate principles, the risk of reputational damage is
minimised as the Group serves its shareholders, customers and
employees with integrity and high ethical
standards.
Macroeconomic and
competitive environment
The Group is exposed to risks that
may arise from the macroeconomic and competitive
environment.
In recent years there have been a
number of global and domestic events which have had significant
implications on the Group's operating environment, namely: Russia's
war in the Ukraine, the Israel-Hamas war in Gaza, Coronavirus and
Brexit. The culmination of these events has led to significant
turmoil in both global and domestic markets. The most
significant economic effect from these events includes record
inflation driven by high fuel costs, leading to sharp and
significant increases in the cost of borrowing. Indicators suggest
that conditions may have stabilised, however geo-political
volatility and uncertainty remains high with the potential to
adversely affect the UK economy, as well as the Group's customers
and assets.
Climate
change
Climate change presents financial
and reputational risks for the banking industry. The Board consider
climate change a material risk as per the Board approved risk
appetite framework which provides a structured approach to risk
taking within agreed boundaries. The assessment is proportional at
present but will develop over time as industry consensus emerges.
The assessment is maintained by the Chief Risk Officer and has been
informed by the ICAAP review and workshops for
employees.
Whilst it is difficult to assess
how climate change will unfold, the Group is continually assessing
various risk exposures. The UK has a legally binding target to cut
its greenhouse gas emissions to "net-zero" by 2050. There is
growing consensus that an orderly transition to a low-carbon
economy will bring substantial adjustments to the global economy
which will have financial implications while bringing risks and
opportunities.
The risk assessment process has
been integrated into existing risk frameworks and will be governed
through the various risk governance structures including review and
recommendations by the Arbuthnot Latham Risk Committee. Arbuthnot
Latham has been assessed against the Task Force on Climate-related
Financial Disclosures' ("TCFD") recommended disclosures and where
appropriate the FCA/PRA guidance as per the Supervisory
Statements.
In accordance with the
requirements of the PRA's Supervisory Statement 'Enhancing banks'
and insurers' approaches to managing the financial risks from
climate change', the Group has allocated responsibility for
identifying and managing the risks from climate change to the
relevant existing Senior Management Function. The Bank is
continuously developing a suitable strategic approach to climate
change and the unique challenges it poses.
The FCA have issued 'Climate
Change and Green Finance: summary of responses and next steps'. In
addition to the modelling of various scenarios and various
governance reviews, the Group will continue to monitor requirements
through the relationship with UK Finance.
Strategic
risk
Strategic risk is the risk that
the Group's ability to achieve its corporate and strategic
objectives may be compromised. This risk is particularly important
to the Group as it continues its growth strategy. However, the
Group seeks to mitigate strategic risk by focusing on a sustainable
business model which is aligned to the Group's business strategy.
Also, the Directors normally meet once a year outside a formal
Board setting to ensure that the Group's strategy is appropriate
for the market and economy.
Credit
risk
Credit risk is the risk that a
counterparty (borrower) will be unable to pay amounts in full when
due. This risk exists in Arbuthnot Latham, which currently has a
loan book of £2.1bn (2022: £2.0bn). The lending portfolio in
Arbuthnot Latham is extended to clients, the majority of which is
secured against cash, property or other high quality assets. Credit
risk is managed through the Credit Committee of Arbuthnot
Latham.
Market
risk
Market risk arises in relation to
movements in interest rates, currencies, property and equity
markets.
Interest rate and currency risk
The Group's treasury function
operates mainly to provide a service to clients and does not take
significant unmatched positions in any market for its own account.
As a result, the Group's exposure to adverse movements in interest
rates and currencies is limited to interest earnings on its free
cash and interest rate re-pricing mismatches. The Group actively
monitors its exposure to future changes in interest rates. However,
at the current time the Group does not hedge the earnings from the
free cash which currently totals £827m. The cost of hedging is
prohibitive. Cash is held at the BOE and with the general consensus
in the market that rates are expected to fall, the Group has
shifted its focus to longer term fixed rate lending products and
also started to invest some of the excess liquidity into high
quality short dated fixed income assets, such as gilts.
Property and equity market risk
The Group is exposed to changes in
the market value of its properties. The current carrying value of
Investment Property is £6.0m, properties held for sale £3.3m, and
properties classified as inventory £14.7m. Any changes in the
market value of the property will be accounted for in the Income
Statement for the Investment Property and could also impact the
carrying value of inventory, which is at the lower of cost and net
realisable value. As a result, it could have a significant impact
on the profit or loss of the Group. The Group is also exposed to
changes in the value of equity investments. The current carrying
value of financial investments is £3.9m. Any changes in the value
of financial investments will be accounted for in Other
Comprehensive Income.
Liquidity
risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that
the Group, although solvent, either does not have sufficient
financial resources to enable it to meet its obligations as they
fall due, or can only secure such resources at an excessive cost.
The Group takes a conservative approach to managing its liquidity
profile. Retail client deposits, together with drawings from the
Bank of England Term Funding Scheme and capital fund the Bank. The
loan to deposit ratio is maintained at a prudent level, and
consequently the Group maintains a high level of liquidity. The
Arbuthnot Latham Board annually approves the Internal Liquidity
Adequacy Assessment Process ("ILAAP"). The Directors model various
stress scenarios and assess the resultant cash flows in order to
evaluate the Group's potential liquidity requirements. The
Directors firmly believe that sufficient liquid assets are held to
enable the Group to meet its liabilities in a stressed
environment.
Operational
risk
Operational risk is the risk that
the Group may be exposed to financial losses from conducting its
business. The Group's exposures to operational risk include its
Information Technology ("IT") and Operations platforms. There are
additional internal controls in these processes that are designed
to protect the Group from these risks. The Group's overall approach
to managing internal control and financial reporting is described
in the Corporate Governance section of the Annual
Report.
In line with guidance issued by
the Regulator, the Bank has continued to focus on ensuring that the
design of systems and operational plans are robust to maintain
operational resilience in the face of unexpected
incidents.
Cyber risk
Cyber risk is an increasing risk
for the Group within its operational processes. It is the risk that
the Group is subject to some form of disruption arising from an
interruption to its IT and data infrastructure. The Group regularly
tests the infrastructure to ensure that it remains robust to a
range of threats and has continuity of business plans in place
including a disaster recovery plan.
Residual value
risk
Residual value risk equals
the difference in the residual value of a leased asset set at lease
inception and the lower salvage value realised upon its disposal or
re-lease at the end of the lease term. The Group is exposed to
residual value risk in its AAG business. Normal residual value risk
is managed through the process set out below, and it should be
noted that the transition to greener technology may further impact
residual values in two ways. Firstly, residual values could
decrease due to assets becoming obsolete; climate related
regulations might change, which could result in legal restrictions
on the use of assets or technological advances could lead to
preferred environmental technologies. Secondly, the lack of
historical information on green vehicles could lead to inaccurate
measurement of residual values at inception of leases.
The AAG business manage Residual
Value setting through its Residual Value Committee that comprises
representatives from its Asset Management, Procurement, Sales and
Leasing divisions and is chaired by the Residual Value Manager.
Assets are valued using either an approved Residual Value matrix or
individually, dependent upon the nature of the asset and current
market conditions. The strategy for Residual Value setting and
oversight of the Residual Value Committee is conducted by the AAG
Residual Risk Committee, which in turn reports into Asset Alliance
Group Holdings Limited board. The Residual Risk Committee, chaired
by the AAG Group Risk Director, includes AAG CEO, AL Group Risk
Director, AAG Managing Director, AAG Finance Director and heads of
Asset Management, Sales and Leasing divisions in AAG.
Conduct
risk
As a financial services provider
the Group faces conduct risk, including selling products to
customers which do not meet their needs, failing to deal with
clients' complaints effectively, not meeting clients' expectations,
and exhibiting behaviours which do not meet market or regulatory
standards.
The Group adopts a low risk
appetite for any unfair customer outcomes. It maintains clear
compliance guidelines and provides ongoing training to all
employees. Periodic spot checks, compliance monitoring and internal
audits are performed to ensure these guidelines are followed. The
Group also has insurance policies in place to provide some cover
for any claims that may arise.
Financial
Crime
The Group is exposed to risk due
to financial crime including money laundering, sanctions evasion,
bribery and corruption, market abuse, tax evasion and fraud.
The Group operates policies and controls which are designed to
ensure that financial crime risks are identified, appropriately
mitigated and managed.
Regulatory and capital
risk
Regulatory and capital risk
includes the risk that the Group will have insufficient capital
resources to support the business and/or does not comply with
regulatory requirements. The Group adopts a conservative approach
to managing its capital. The Board of Arbuthnot Latham approves an
ICAAP annually, which includes the performance of stringent stress
tests to ensure that capital resources are adequate over a three
year horizon. Capital and liquidity ratios are regularly monitored
against the Board's approved risk appetite as part of the risk
management framework.
Regulatory change also exists as a
risk to the Group's business. Notwithstanding the assessments
carried out by the Group to manage regulatory risk, it is not
possible to predict how regulatory and legislative changes may
alter and impact the business. Significant and unforeseen
regulatory changes may reduce the Group's competitive situation and
lower its profitability.
Strategic Report - Non-Financial and Sustainability
Statement
The table below sets out where
stakeholders can find information on non-financial matters, as
required by Sections 414CA and 414CB of the Companies Act 2006,
enabling them to understand the impact of the Group's key policies
and activities.
|
Reporting Requirement
|
Policies and
Standards
|
Information Necessary
to
Understand Impact
of
Activities and
Outcome
of
Policies
|
|
Environmental Matters
|
• Credit Policy
• Managing Financial Risks of Climate Change
Framework
• Environmental Management Policy
|
• Financial Review, page 19
• Stakeholder Engagement and S. 172 (1) Statement, pages 22 and
23
• Sustainability Report, pages 25 to 38
• Corporate Governance Report page 49
|
|
Employees
|
• Agile Working Policy
• Board Diversity Policy
• Dignity at Work Policy
• Equality, Diversity and Inclusion Policy
• Flexible Working Policy
• Health and Safety Policy
• Long Service Awards Policy
• Parental Leave Policy
• Personal Appearance Policy
• Remuneration Policy
• Training & Development Policy
• Whistleblowing Policy
|
• Stakeholder Engagement and S. 172 (1), pages 22 and
23
• Sustainability Report, pages 25 to 31
• Directors Report, page 43
• Corporate Governance Report, page 47
|
|
Social Matters
|
• Complaints Handling Policy
• Fraud Policy
• Tax Strategy
• Vulnerable Clients Policy
|
• Arbuthnot Principles, page 3
• Stakeholder Engagement and S. 172 (1) Statement, pages 22 and
23
• Sustainability Report, pages 25, 26 and 29
|
|
Respect for
Human Rights
|
• Anti-Modern Slavery Policy
• Dignity at Work Policy
• Equality, Diversity and Inclusion Policy
• Personal Data Protection Policy
|
• Stakeholder Engagement and s.172 (1) Statement, pages 23 and
24
• Sustainability Report, pages 25 to 29
|
|
Anti-Corruption
and Anti-Bribery
|
• Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy
• Anti-Money Laundering
Policy
• Client Acceptance policy
• Cyber Strategy
• Group Market Abuse and Insider
Dealing Policy
• Physical Security Policy
|
• Sustainability Report, pages 25 and 29
|
|
Description of Principal Risks and
Impact of Business Activity
|
|
• Strategic Report, pages 18 to 20
|
|
Description of the Business
Model
|
|
• Business Overview
|
|
Non-Financial Key Performance
Indicators
|
|
• Sustainability Report, pages 25 and 26
|
|
Strategic Report - Stakeholder Engagement and s.172
Report
Stakeholder Engagement and S. 172 (1)
Statement
This section of the Strategic
Report describes how the Directors have had regard to the matters
set out in section 172 (1) (a) to (f) of the Companies Act 2006
when making decisions. It forms the Directors' statement required
by ABG as a large-sized company under section 414CZA of the
Act.
The Directors have acted in a way
that they considered, in good faith, to be most likely to promote
the success of the Company for the benefit of its members as a
whole, and in doing so had regard, amongst other matters,
to:
•
the likely consequences of any decision in the long
term;
•
the interests of the Company's employees;
•
the need to foster the Company's business relationships with
suppliers, customers and others;
•
the impact of the Company's operations on the community and the
environment;
•
the desirability of the Company maintaining a reputation for high
standards of business conduct; and
•
the need to act fairly as between members of the
Company.
The Arbuthnot Principles and
Values set out on page 3 explain the Board's approach to its
stakeholders. Details of how the Directors had regard to the
interests of its key stakeholders during the year are set out
below, in the Group Directors Report on page 44 and in the
Corporate Governance Report on page 49.
The Board has regard to the
interests of all its key stakeholders in its decision making since
the Directors are conscious that their decisions and actions have
an impact on them. The stakeholders we consider in this regard are
our shareholders, employees, customers, suppliers, regulators and
the environment in which we operate.
Likely consequences of any decision in the long
term
The Directors make their decisions
to ensure that long-term prospects are not sacrificed for short
term gain, reflecting the values and support of Sir Henry Angest,
Chairman and Chief Executive and majority shareholder, which have
proved successful in creating and maintaining value for all
shareholders for over 40 years. This was demonstrated in the year
by a number of Board decisions.
In March 2023, the Board gave
approval for management to agree terms for a lease on new office
premises at 20 Finsbury Circus in the City of London. The decision
was made, taking a long-term view, because the building offers a
more flexible and modern working environment which should retain
and attract talented staff, and enhance the client and staff
experience. It would allow the Group to progress with its future
growth plans in one location. It will assist the Group in achieving
its ESG targets and all London staff will be housed in one
location. The Board regarded its decision as a significant step
forward, maintaining the Group's reputation with its customers and
employees, and a statement of confidence in its future.
In July 2023, as part of its
succession planning and of its consideration of diversity, the
Board appointed Jayne Almond, Angela Knight and Lord Sassoon as
non-executive directors with effect from 1 September 2023, subject
to the approval of Grant Thornton as Nominated Adviser and Aquis
Stock Exchange (AQSE) Corporate Adviser which was given towards the
end of August.
Interests of the Company's employees
As explained above, the decision
to move London offices was driven partly by the intention to
enhance the staff experience. Executive Directors and senior
management are fully engaged with the workforce, most of whom
interact on a daily basis. Employees are also able to raise
concerns in confidence with the HR Team, with grievances followed
up in line with a specified process which satisfies all legal
requirements. As explained in the section 172 (1) Statement of
Arbuthnot Latham, the Company's banking subsidiary, one of its
non-executive directors has been designated by its board as the
director to engage with Arbuthnot Latham group's workforce whereas
the Company itself has fewer than 20 employees, all of whom have
direct access to Board members.
As set out in the Whistleblowing Policy, Ian Dewar, a non-executive
director and chairman of the Audit Committee, is the Company's
Whistleblowing Champion and is available at all times in
this role. There is an anonymous whistleblowing
service via an external provider. There is also protection for
employees deriving from the Public Interest Disclosure Act 1998.
Any material whistleblowing events are notified to the Board and to
the applicable regulator.
The Board receives an update on
human resource matters at each of its meetings. It is also kept
informed of the results of employee surveys including one on
Diversity & Inclusion, conducted in September 2023, which
received a 73% response rate. It noted that on most measures the
Group scored around 60 to 70 with the exception of the measure of
Arbuthnot as an Employer, scoring 87. In November 2023 an
engagement survey was launched to focus on other important topics
that matter to employees, including their personal growth,
wellbeing, communication from senior leaders, reward and
recognition as well as the important measure of the Group's
engagement score and the results will be considered by the Board in
due course. The Board regards the maintenance of a high level of
employee engagement as key to the Company's future success as an
organisation on every level and the focus will continue to be to
develop our working environment to achieve this aim.
Company's business relationships with suppliers, customers
and others
The Directors attach great
importance to good relations with customers and business
partners. In particular, our clients are integral to our
business and forging and maintaining client relationships are core
to Arbuthnot Latham's ("AL") business and crucial for client
retention. The decision to move offices was driven partly by the
intention to enhance the client experience. As regards customers,
the Board reviewed the continuing Consumer Duty project, which is
overseen by the AL Risk Committee, from regular reports to it and
updates from its Board Champion, Angela Knight.
The Company is committed to
following agreed supplier payment terms. There is a Supplier
Management Framework in place covering governance around the
Company's procurement and supplier management activities. For due
diligence and compliance purposes, suppliers are assessed through
an external registration system. The Modern Slavery Statement,
approved by the Board in March as part of its annual review of the
Company's stance and approach to the Modern Slavery Act, explains
the risk-based approach that the Company has taken to give
assurance that slavery and human trafficking are not taking place
in its supply chains or any part of its business. The Board
requires that Arbuthnot Latham implements an
Anti-Modern Slavery Policy, procedures and processes in
relation to the AL Group, which reflects the commitment to act
ethically and with integrity, in all their respective business
relationships and additionally, to ensure that slavery and human
trafficking are not taking place anywhere in the AL Group or in the
AL Group's supply chain.
Balancing stakeholder interests
An illustration of the balancing
of the interests of our stakeholders in their long-term interest
was the Board's decision in July 2023 to continue its progressive
dividend policy, resolving to pay an interim dividend of 19p per
share to shareholders. This was an increase of 2p per share from
the interim dividend paid in 2022. Given the increased profits of
the Group in 2023, the Board has decided to recommend a final
dividend of 27p per share; this is an increase of 2p per share
compared to the final dividend of 2022.
A further example of the balancing
of stakeholders' interests was the decision in December 2023 to
renew the private issue of the Company's subordinated loan issued
on a bilateral basis to P Capital Partners, a Swedish Debt fund.
The loan, which is being increased by £1 million to £26 million
before fees and expenses, is expected to be drawn on 3 June 2024
which is the fifth anniversary of the initial loan. It is expected
to be classified as Tier 2 for capital purposes which will maintain
the current levels of capital to support the strategic plans of the
Group.
Impact of the Company's operations on the community and the
environment
As part of the management
information reviewed at its regular meetings, the Board receives a
Risk Management report, containing a report on Sustainability /
Environmental, Social and Governance ("ESG") matters which includes
a Climate Change Dashboard, monitoring climate change measures in
place including Scope 1, 2 and 3 GHG emissions. This dashboard sets
out climate-change measures and actions.
The Board is updated on the steps
the Group is taking to become more sustainable, given its exposure
to climate change transition risk as the UK evolves to a low carbon
economy. It is also kept informed of the formal approach to ESG
established to develop over time, which will underpin the Arbuthnot
Principles and Values within the workplace under five 'pillars of
sustainability' - governance, clients, employees, community and
environment (ESG Pillars). The ESG actions taken are in recognition
of the Group's responsibility to make a positive societal impact
and the political, regulatory and legal pressure with clients and
investors interested in the Group's ESG stance. The Board has again
approved an energy and carbon report meeting the requirements of
the Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting standards, as set out
in the Sustainability Report on pages 37 to 39.
In September 2023 the Board
approved the enterprise-wide climate change risk appetite, risk
assessments, and stress test scenarios and results. It also
considered climate change risk in major change decisions, including
in the case of the planned 2024 London premises relocation
initiated during 2023.
Desirability of the Company maintaining a reputation for high
standards of business conduct
The Directors believe that the
Arbuthnot culture set out in the Arbuthnot Principles and Values
manifests itself at Board level and in the external view of the
Group as a whole. The importance of the Group's reputation is
considered at each Board meeting. These Principles are
encapsulated in five Group cultural values, embedded into
day-to-day activities. These values are integrity, respect,
empowerment, energy and drive, and collaboration.
Acting fairly as between members of the
Company
The majority shareholder, Sir
Henry Angest, is the Company's Chairman and Chief Executive. There
is continuing engagement with other major shareholders and the
Directors make their decisions on behalf of all shareholders. The
Board welcomes engagement with them and will continue to maintain
communications via one-to-one meetings as appropriate. The
Directors treat all shareholders equally, albeit that holders of
non-voting shares do not have the right to vote in shareholder
meetings. This need to treat all shareholders equally was an
important consideration in limiting the amount of the fundraising
in May 2023 to £12m, a rights issue to all shareholders not being
practicable due to the additional complexity and associated high
costs. As a consequence for practical reasons, in addition to the
subscription by Sir Henry Angest, only institutional shareholders
were approached in conjunction with the Company's stockbroker,
Shore Capital, and invited to participate in the placing of shares.
The newly subscribed and placed shares represented just over 8% of
the Company's issued share capital which was approved by Ordinary
shareholders at the General Meeting held on 4 May
2023.
Strategic Report - Sustainability Report
Introduction
The Group has continued to embed
sustainable practices across the business and remains committed to
ensuring its business activities have a positive impact not just
for clients and shareholders but also for employees, society and
the environment. Two of our key business principles, reciprocity
and stability, rely on recognising our own responsibility to make a
positive societal impact.
Climate change is an important
topic for consumers and investors alike. In parallel, inclusive
growth and the impact organisations have on society are
increasingly a focus. More than ever before, organisations are
being held accountable for their impact. We focus on how we can
improve to build a future that delivers growth, sustainability and
inclusion.
Our responsible business
initiatives enable us to monitor and measure our social impact by
considering the impact of our practices and outputs across five
pillars: governance, clients, community, environment and employees
as explained on pages 30 to 32 below.
Governance
The Group has a solid system of
governance in place, endorsing the principles of openness,
integrity, and accountability that underpin good corporate
governance. The Group operates to high standards of corporate
accountability with an effective Board and Board committees. This,
together with the role and overall holding of Sir Henry Angest, the
ultimate majority shareholder, and compliance with PRA and FCA
regulations and with those of the London Stock Exchange Alternative
Investment Market and the Aquis Exchange, is fundamental to our
success as a business.
Policies
The Group has adopted a wide range
of policies that straddle the five pillars to ensure that employees
and management are aware of their responsibilities towards our
customers and comply with all regulatory requirements. Some of the
key policies are set out below and in the Non-Financial and
Sustainability Statement on page 22.
Human Rights commitments
The Group is committed to
operating in an ethical manner, and ensuring the relationships we
have with all our stakeholders adhere to high standards. These are
reflected in both our Anti-Modern Slavery Policy and in our
Supplier Code of Conduct.
The Group is committed to finding
and reducing the risk of slavery or human trafficking in every part
of our supply chain.
Clients
Relationships with our clients is
at the heart of what we do. We take the time to understand what is
important to our clients so that we can be confident that we are
working in their best interests, for business, for family, for
life. Being a relationship-led bank, every single one of our
clients has a dedicated relationship manager to guide and support
them. This is supported by our strong Net Promoter Score (NPS)
(Non-financial Key Performance Indicator) which is reviewed every
two years. Our most recent, 2022, NPS increased to 64%, up from 47%
in 2020, a reflection of our clients' support.
Our bankers have been engaging
pro-actively with clients, following the tightening of Credit
appetite in order to help those struggling due to the impact of
increasing interest rates, inflation and high cost of
living.
Consumer Duty
Our approach to the Financial
Conduct Authority's Consumer Duty means continuing to ensure that
clients are at the heart of everything we do.
Over the past year, we have
undertaken a large-scale assessment of the Consumer Duty outcomes
by reviewing our products and services, pricing structure,
communications and support infrastructure.
Client support
As a relationship-led bank, our
purpose is to help our clients go further. This means ensuring that
they receive a bespoke service, tailored to their needs, helping
them achieve their financial goals. As part of our product reviews,
we have assessed the level of support provided to clients and the
channels available to access this support.
The review spanned the entire
client base and we have concluded that the range of support
channels provided to clients, including those with characteristics
of vulnerability, enables them to pursue their financial goals and
receive good outcomes.
Vulnerable clients
The term 'vulnerability' captures
a range of circumstances our clients can face. To ensure we are
treating vulnerable clients fairly, we have implemented vulnerable
client guidance focused on identifying and supporting vulnerable
clients and recording information about them. We have a Vulnerable
Client Committee to ensure we continue to support our staff with
treating vulnerable clients; this includes providing training
resources.
Employees
We continually focus on creating
an outstanding culture and workplace for all our employees. Our
high engagement scores are a testament to this. In the most recent
employee engagement survey (Non-Financial Key Performance
Indicator), conducted in November 2023, our overall engagement
score maintained a very high-level of 83. Once again, benchmarking
across the industry showcases our significant lead over
competitors. 84% of employees would recommend Arbuthnot as a great
place to work, up 5% from last year and 17% against the benchmark.
This achievement is something we take pride in and solidifies our
reputation as a high-performing organisation.
Wellbeing
Our work environment fosters and
enhances the wellbeing of our employees. Aligned with our mission
and core values - Integrity, Respect, Empowerment, Energy &
Drive and Collaboration, our wellbeing strategy is designed to
resonate with the recognition that our employees constitute our
greatest asset. Our wellbeing strategy focuses on four pillars:
mental, physical, social and financial. Through these pillars, we
provide our employees with a range of resources and tools to
support their wellbeing, including resources provided by BUPA,
Headspace, Hargreaves Lansdown and our Employee Assistance
Programme.
We work with external provider
Activehub to encourage and incentivise our employees to get active,
with 322 employees downloading the app in 2023 to keep active. In
June we held a headline event with Activehub, rewarding employees
activity with tree planting. Through Eden Reforestation Project we
pledged to plant 7,696 trees.
Early Careers and Young Professionals
2023 saw the continuation of our
Structured Graduate and Apprenticeship Programme, with a total of
16 participants, along with the third year of our Industrial
Placement and Summer internship programmes.
The Group now offers five
different Early Careers Programmes, including work experience,
summer internships, one-year placements, graduate placements and
apprenticeships. We also continued our Leadership Development
Academy, with 13 new participants, 28 participants in total, and
have more programmes scheduled for 2024 for existing and aspiring
leaders.
We partner with Young
Professionals, an organisation which works with schools across the
UK from different socio-economic backgrounds to provide an insight
and introduction to different industries, in order to grow the
quality and diversity of our Early Careers talent pool.
In February 2023, we hosted an
evening inviting female students interested in a career in banking,
40 Year 13 students from the Young Professionals network and 20 for
female student referrals from employees. A further female student
event was hosted in October, this time attended by 90 Year 13
student from the Young Professionals network and referrals from
employees.
Employee development
As a rapidly growing business, we
encourage career progression and seek to develop our people's
skills to help them grow within the organisation.
Mentoring
We support our employees'
continued developed through our internal mentoring programme
between our employees. We partner with Pushfar, an internal
mentoring platform to ensure mentees can find a suitable mentor to
assist them in their careers.
Cost-of-living
To support our employees with the
economic uncertainties over the last year and to help alleviate
some of the burden of these increased costs on employees, we
provided further cost-of-living payments of £750 in both April and
September to those employees earning salaries of up to £50,000 pa.
and who joined the Group before 1 January 2023.
Benefits
We offer our employees an array of
benefits. The annual benefits window offers a benefits package
which includes the opportunity for eligible employees to enhance at
favourable rates their cover for certain benefits including life
assurance.
Workplace pension scheme
The Group offers all eligible
employees membership of a contributory defined contribution plan,
which is operated by Hargreaves Lansdown who present six-monthly to
the Pension Scheme Governance Committee. The matters discussed at
this Committee's meetings are communicated to employees, continuing
the focus on their financial wellbeing.
Employee networking forum: Connect
2023 marked the launch of our
employee network, Connect. The purpose of Connect is to:
1.
Promote a safe and supportive workplace for all to work, learn and
thrive.
2.
Understand the challenges faced in our workplace in order to effect
change to increase diversity.
3.
Attract and retain a diverse workforce.
Our Connect network hosted a range
of events covering Diversity, Equity and Inclusion ("DEI")
educational topics, including Eid al-Fitr, conscious inclusion, and
invisible illnesses.
Diversity, Equity, and Inclusion
In September 2023 we conducted an
employee survey to form a long-term DEI strategy. 73% of employees
completed the survey and the responses have been used to form our
strategy.
Our ambition is to create an
environment which enables everyone to perform to the best of their
potential.
We know that by leading a culture
which reduces groupthink, draws on everyone's diverse mindsets,
skills, backgrounds and perspectives we will develop the best
leaders and teams. We also understand that this will support our
product and service offering, tailoring these to reflect the
differing needs of our client base and ensuring that we provide
good customer outcomes. This will enable us to achieve our ambition
to be the leading full-service, human-scale relationship bank
powered by modern technology.
Therefore, we will continue to
create a culture where everyone is committed and empowered to
create a diverse and inclusive environment for all. An ambitious,
high performing culture where we support, enable and inspire our
people to be their best selves.
Together we will learn,
collaborate and challenge each other to create an organisation
where everyone can contribute towards our shared ambition and
collectively operate with a professional attitude towards our
colleagues and external stakeholders alike.
Community
The Group recognises that we must
commit to driving positive community impact, creating an impact
within the communities in which we exist and operate, and
connecting the dots between the charities we support and the social
initiatives we run.
Our corporate responsibility
strategy expanded in 2023 with the formation of a CSR Steering
Committee to ensure our CSR activities are focused on the Bank's
goals. In 2023, the strategy focused on both quality education and
no poverty.
Volunteering and Philanthropy
We partnered with The Felix
Project, a charity fighting hunger and food waste, and The
Whitechapel Mission, a homeless shelter in East London. We also
partnered with Surrey Docks Farm, a working city farm in the heart
of London, providing opportunities for local communities to learn
about farming and food production.
To assist with our skills-based
volunteering and to ensure we support education and financial
education, we partnered with The Switch, offering our employees the
opportunity to volunteer in schools in Tower Hamlets. Sessions here
included CV-writing workshops, Money Matter workshops and interview
preparation.
At The Felix Project, our
employees have volunteered in their warehouses and kitchens,
preparing and packaging meals made from surplus food. We also had
employees help sort clothes for homeless people in East London,
supporting the Whitechapel Mission.
Supported by the Worshipful
Company of Farmers, at Surrey Docks Farm, we have had large teams
of employees help with the running of the farm, including cleaning
out the goats, mucking out the sheep, hedge trimming, installing
raised beds, creating dead hedges, clearing overgrown areas and
more.
In 2024 we will work more closely
at our impact in our regional offices and aligning their
philanthropy and community impact with the Group's wider social
impact goals.
Pound for Pound and Payroll giving
We provide pound for pound
matching of up to £250 for UK registered charity fundraising events
each year.
We also offer our employees the
opportunity to donate regularly from their gross pay to charities
of their choice.
Environment
We have made a commitment to
reduce our environmental impact and to improve our environmental
performance as an integral part of our business strategy. We are
committed to achieving net-zero by 2050 and effective management of
our carbon footprint is an important part of our
strategy.
As a consequence, we have in place
an Environmental Management policy which sets out our high-level
approach to managing environmental issues and provides requirements
to help the Bank to achieve its commitments. Enhancing transparency
within our own supply chains is part of our mission to work closely
with our third-party relationships. In doing so, working together
will help us establish how we can better engage and be held
accountable.
Due to the nature of the Group's
business, we are primarily a consumer of services rather than goods
and materials. However, we are still committed to reducing the
impact of our supply chain. As a minimum, we expect our suppliers
to provide evidence towards their environmental status, where
relevant and appropriate.
Ahead of the relocation of our
London headquarters in the summer of 2024, we have been presented
with the opportunity to review and reduce our environmental impact.
Scope 1 and 2 emissions will be managed through energy efficiency,
renewable energy sourcing, and moving our company car fleet to be
fully electric or hybrid by 2035. We are also reviewing our waste
management; we currently send zero waste to landfill but need to
reduce the waste we produce across the business. We will be
managing paper use, printing, improving waste facilities and
raising recycling awareness across the workplace.
The Bank's Credit Policy sets out
the Group's limited appetite for financial and reputational risk
emanating from climate change, which includes physical risk
(extreme weather, flooding etc.) and transitional risk (changes to
law, policy, regulation and culture). The Bank adopts a favourable
stance towards a low carbon economy and lending propositions that
have a neutral or positive impact on the environment/climate. The
Bank will also consider the impact on public perception and
potential impact on continuing demand for clients' products and
services, as well as any impact on its underlying security. These
factors are assessed as part of the credit application process and
at least once a year through the annual review process.
20 Finsbury Circus
In 2024, we will be relocating our
London offices to a new site at 20 Finsbury Circus. As well as
creating a modern and collaborative workplace, sustainability and
our environmental impact have been taken into consideration for the
relocation.
20 Finsbury Circus is a
BREEAM-excellent-rated building that has undergone a new CAT
fit-out. The building itself is fitted with a modern building
management system and heating and cooling technology. We will have
access to a new lighting control system that will allow us to
create our own lighting zones and determine when and how each zone
operates on weekdays and weekends. Electricity consumption is
recorded for every circuit in the building, allowing us to analyse
consumption data to increase our efficiency.
While working on the fit-out
design, we have made efforts to re-use existing fixtures where
possible, such as lighting and ceilings in the staff working areas.
For example, the tea point worktops that are being installed are
made from 100% post-consumer plastic waste, the barista bar is made
from 65% wood waste, the acoustic panels in meeting rooms are made
from recycled plastic bottles, and the carpets are 71% recycled
content and carbon neutral. We have endeavoured to reuse existing
furniture where possible.
We have also reviewed our refuse
management process, including the installation of a compactor,
which will reduce the number of waste collections.
Over the next few years, the plan
is to roll out initiatives in our regional locations as
well.
Summary across our five pillars
We are taking steps, guided by our
five pillars of governance, clients, community, environment and
employees, to help us become more sustainable.
Governance
|
Current status
|
Ensure responsible and transparent
corporate governance which
aligns to business goals while making a positive societal
impact.
|
We have embedding sustainability
into our business practices by recording, monitoring, and
publishing performance.
|
We have policies in place, such as
our:
Anti-Money Laundering Policy
Board and Senior Management Diversity
Policy
Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy
Client Acceptance Policy
Group Market Abuse and Insider Dealing
Policy
Whistleblowing Policy
Anti-Modern Slavery Policy
|
We have a published Tax Strategy,
which sets out the Group's commitment to compliance with tax law
and practice in the UK, which includes paying the correct amount of
tax at the right place and right time and having a transparent and
constructive relationship with the tax authority.
|
We have effective risk management
which underpins our strong risk culture supporting the Group's
vision.
|
We have a Supplier Code of Conduct
that promotes equal opportunities and diversity, acting with
integrity, endorsement of sustainable procurement within the supply
chain, safe working practices, and data, cyber and privacy
protection.
|
|
|
Clients
|
Current status
|
Ensuring best outcomes for our
clients.
|
We seek regular feedback from our
clients to reinforce our proposition and service.
|
As reported last year, we
conducted an in-depth review of our client value proposition in
2022 which included a client survey and deep-dive individual client
interviews.
|
We also have a robust complaints
process and take dissatisfaction seriously, remediating issues
promptly.
|
We take the protection of our
client data seriously and have robust measures in place to protect
client data in line with our legal and regulatory
requirements.
|
We make regular anti-fraud
communications to clients, alerting them to the different
techniques used by criminals to seek to steal people's data and
money.
|
We have continued to invest in the
Bank's core banking system, demonstrating that operational
resilience and the ability to make services available to our
clients is of the utmost importance.
|
We continue to invest in our risk
management capabilities across Credit, Compliance, Operational Risk
and Financial Crime with a view to ensuring good client outcomes
through the continuing stability of the Bank.
|
We implemented the FCA's Consumer
Duty requirements for all relevant products and services from 31
July 2023. We continue to consider ways that we can improve
outcomes for our customers.
|
We have initiated a Digital
Transformation Project to further enhance the Bank's services to
clients.
|
We have policies in place, such as
our:
Complaints Handling Policy
Fraud Policy
Personal Data Protection Policy
Physical Security Policy
Vulnerable Clients Policy
|
We provide all our employees
access to our extensive Learning and Development Programme. We also
have a Leadership Development Academy and Early Careers
Programme.
|
We have a Pension Governance
Committee to manage and communicate our workplace pension
scheme.
|
|
|
Community
|
Current status
|
Having a positive impact on the
community in which we
operate.
|
We support philanthropy through
matching charity donations, payroll giving, and volunteer days. In
2023 we supported The Felix Project, The Whitechapel Mission, The
Switch and Surrey Docks Farm.
|
We will continue to encourage
skills-based and team-based volunteering, increasing our focus on
education and financial literacy.
|
We continue to encourage employees
fundraising and challenges.
|
We have established a CSR Steering
Committee that ensures the Bank's community impact is aligned with
the Bank's goals and objectives.
|
We aim to secure new
accreditations and signatories that align with our CSR activities
and values.
|
|
|
Environment
|
Current status
|
Ensuring that our business
practices have a positive impact on the environment.
|
We will set goals and progress
against these with a view to reaching net-zero carbon emissions as
a business by 2050.
|
We have reported this year in line
with the requirements of the Companies (Strategic Report)
(Climate-related Financial Disclosure) Regulations 2022.
|
We assess both direct and indirect
climate-related risks and opportunities.
|
We incorporate annual
sustainability reporting into our annual reports and
accounts.
|
We have an Environmental Management Policy to help
us achieve our commitments.
|
We have established a Sustainable
investment Service (SPS).
|
Energy and Waste
With the relocation of our London
headquarters we will be reviewing our energy consumption and
emissions across Scope 1, 2, and 3. We are actively reviewing our
premises strategy with specific reference to environmental factors
and agile working.
|
We have updated our Supplier
Management Framework to reflect the AL Environmental Management
Policy.
|
We ensure the responsible disposal
of computer equipment and have a waste recycling programme in
place.
|
Transport
Our benefits include a cycle to
work scheme and season ticket loan.
We continue to finance electric
vehicles through our RAF subsidiary while AAG strives to finance
the most environmentally friendly trucks in the UK which we seek to
keep as up to date as possible. AAG is actively considering how the
market in renewable energy develops.
|
We provided ESG training to
relationship managers and credit managers.
|
|
|
Employees
|
Current status
|
Creating a supportive and diverse
workplace in which employees can thrive.
|
We promote a working environment
that seeks to develop employee skills, and ensures employees are
treated fairly and supports their wellbeing. Policies to support
this include:
Agile Working Policy
Flexible Working Policy
Health and Safety Policy
Parental Leave Policy
Remuneration Policy
Training & Development Policy
Dignity at Work Policy
Equality and Diversity Policy
|
We have invested in new offices
and working environments in Bristol and in our London
headquarters.
|
We operate an internal recognition
scheme: Arbuthnot Achievers.
|
We conduct annual employee surveys
(conducted anonymously).
|
We have adopted agile and flexible
working policies.
|
We pay all employees a living wage
and have market aligned job families.
|
All eligible employees may receive
a bonus, in addition to pension contribution, absence pay and other
core and flex benefits. We also offered eligible employees the
opportunity to enhance at favourable rates their cover for life
assurance and related cover.
|
We publish details of our gender
pay gap annually.
|
We will launch a Group-wide DEI
strategy in 2024. And in 2023 we launched our internal staff
networking forum: Connect.
|
We have an internal colleague
wellbeing programme and wellbeing support resources.
|
We provide all our staff access to
our extensive Learning and Development Programme. We also have a
Leadership Development Academy and Early Careers
Programme.
|
We have a colleague Pension
Governance Committee to manage and communicate our workplace
pension scheme.
|
Metrics
Disclosures around metrics are
given in the section on Climate-related Financial Disclosures
above.
Climate-related Financial Disclosures
This section of the Strategic
Report describes how the Directors have implemented the
requirements of the Companies (Strategic Report) (Climate-related
Financial Disclosure) Regulations 2022 which amended the Companies
Act 2006 to introduce Task Force on Climate-related Financial
Disclosures' ("TCFD") aligned disclosure requirements into the
existing non-financial information requirements.
These regulations apply to the
Group from its financial year ended 31 December 2023 and are
broadly in line with the recommendations of the global TCFD,
information on which was given voluntarily in last year's
Report.
This report covers how climate
related risks and opportunities are managed; and on the performance
measures and targets applied in managing these issues. The
TCFD encourages consistent, reliable and clear measurement and
reporting of climate-related financial risks. Its recommendations
provide a framework for understanding and analysing how climate
change affects our customers, our own operations and our strategy.
The recommendations are to assess disclosures around governance,
strategy, risk management and metrics and targets.
As stated in the section on Risks
and Uncertainties on page 19 above, we have assessed the Group
against the TCFD recommended disclosures and we set out below our
assessments.
Requirement
|
Our Response
|
Governance
Describe the board's oversight of
climate-related risks and opportunities.
Describe management's role in
assessing and managing climate-related risks and
opportunities.
|
The Board annually review and
approve the enterprise-wide climate change
· Risk
appetite,
· Risk
assessments, and
· Stress test scenarios and results.
The Board review the ESG dashboard
(that includes Climate Change) at each meeting. This dashboard
details climate-change measures and actions. The tolerances are
partly based on the climate change stress test scenarios
outputs.
Climate change risk is considered
as falling within two categories:
Physical Risk: Arising from
longer-term changes in the climate and weather-related events,
rising average temperatures, heatwaves, droughts, floods, storms,
sea-level rise, coastal erosion and subsidence.
Transition Risk: Arising from the
adjustment towards a low-carbon economy and could lead to changes
in risk appetite, strategy, policy, technology and
sentiment.
The Board also consider climate
change risk in major change decisions, most recently in the case of
the planned 2024 London premises relocation initiated this
year.
The Senior Management Function
("SMF") accountability for the financial risks of climate change
sits with Stephen Kelly, the AL CRO.
Climate change is managed within
the Group's governance and risk management frameworks which
includes the consideration of both current and emerging
risks.
|
Strategy
Describe the climate-related risks
and opportunities the organisation has identified over the short,
medium, and long term.
Describe the impact of
climate-related risks and opportunities on the organisation's
businesses, strategy, and financial planning.
Describe the resilience of the
organisation's strategy, taking into consideration different
climate-related scenarios, including a 2°C or lower
scenario.
|
The Board considers the Group's
business model to be resilient to the financial risks from
climate-related risks based on the risk assessments and stress test
scenario results.
The existing income streams are
not materially impacted by either transitional or physical
risks.
The business strategy is also
positioned to capture opportunities and support the transition to a
low carbon economy.
The key risks and opportunities
are:
Short and medium term (0-5
years)
· Growing investor, client, and employee preference to work
with, or for companies promoting a low-carbon economy
· AL
Core transition risk and opportunity on the rising EPC expectations
for buy to let residential property
· RAF
transition risk and opportunity from the demise of combustion
engines and switch to electric engines.
· AAG
transition risk and opportunity from the demise of combustion
engines and switch to alternatives.
Long term (5-30 years)
· AL
Core physical risk (flood risk) on residential property.
These risks are mitigated as
follows:
· Residential property loan risks are mitigated by the loan
durations (typically less than 5 years) and strong loan to
values.
· RAF
combustion engine risks are mitigated by the short loan durations
(typically less than five years).
· AAG
heavy goods vehicles combustion engine risks are mitigated by the
short leasing durations (typically less than five years), lack of
viable alternate technologies and by the strategic objective to
keep the fleet focused on latest Euro 6 models and as young as
possible. Asset residual values and lifespans are monitored
considering possible technology changes.
· The
Group exposure to the Energy or Utility sectors is less than 1% of
the portfolio.
The Group is positively minded
toward supporting the transition to a low carbon economy and seeks
to capitalise on opportunities as follows:
· AL
looks more positively on lending applications with property
collateral that is C or better. The business is also piloting a
green lending product aimed at attracting higher EPC portfolios and
funding EPC improvements.
· RAF
is supporting clients by financing leases on electric and hybrid
vehicles. It has had success in financing hybrid London taxis and
smaller electric vehicles.
· AAG
finances electric buses and is working with the industry on
transition pathways to cleaner technology alternatives for heavy
goods vehicles.
· AL
has offered clients the option to invest funds in a Sustainable
Investment Service since 2021. This service seeks to incorporate
environmental, social and governance ("ESG") factors to achieve a
positive impact without sacrificing long-term financial
returns.
|
Risk Management
Describe the organisation's
processes for identifying and assessing climate-related
risks.
Describe the organization's
processes for managing climate-related risks.
Describe how processes for
identifying, assessing, and managing climate-related risks are
integrated into the organisation's overall risk
management.
|
The Board approve the climate
change risk assessment and stress test scenarios prepared by risk
management.
The risk assessments identify and
assesses the transition and physicals risk to the business model
and lending book. They consider the existing and emerging
regulatory requirements and other relevant factors, as well as the
potential size and scope of climate-related risks.
The stress test scenarios inform
the risk assessments. The scenarios are tailored versions of the
2021 Climate Biennial Exploratory Scenario ("CBES") as outlined in
the BOE "Key elements of the 2021 Biennial Exploratory Scenario:
Financial risks from climate change".
Three scenarios are considered
which are plausible representations of what might happen based on
different future paths of governments' climate policies. They cover
the period to 2050 and assume either early action (in current
year), late action (ten years' time) or no additional
action.
Two scenarios consider routes to
net-zero carbon dioxide emissions globally by 2050: an Early Action
scenario and a Late Action scenario. These scenarios primarily
explore transition risks from climate change:
· Early Action: Under this scenario, climate policy is
ambitious from the beginning, with a gradual intensification of
carbon taxes and other policies over time. Global carbon dioxide
emissions are reduced to net-zero by around 2050 and global warming
(relative to pre-industrial levels) is successfully limited to
1.8°C by the end of the scenario, falling to around 1.5°C by the
end of century. The required adjustment in the economy creates a
temporary headwind to growth but this dissipates in the latter half
of the scenario once a significant portion of the required
transition has occurred, and the productivity benefits of green
technology investments begin to be realised.
· Late
Action: The implementation of policy to drive the transition to a
net-zero economy is assumed to be delayed by a decade under this
scenario. Policy measures are then more sudden and disorderly as a
result of the delay. Global warming is limited to 1.8°C by the end
of the scenario (2050) relative to pre-industrial levels, but then
remains around this level at the end of the century. The more
compressed nature of the reduction in emissions also results in
material short-term macroeconomic and financial markets disruption.
UK unemployment rises to 8.5% and the economy goes into recession
for a short period. Falls in output are particularly concentrated
in emissions-intensive sectors.
The third scenario is based on the
physical risks that would begin to materialise if governments
around the world fail to enact policy responses to global warming
and no additional action is taken to address climate change.
This is considered a severe scenario, being based on climate
outcomes that would only occur later this century under the
assumption that no additional action is taken to address climate
change, and represents a worse than expected outcome even under
such conditions. The absence of transition policies in this
scenario leads to a growing concentration of greenhouse gas
emissions in the atmosphere and, as a result, global temperature
levels continue to increase, reaching 3.3°C higher relative to
pre-industrial levels by the end of the scenario. This leads to
chronic changes in precipitation, ecosystems and sea-levels, which
are unevenly distributed globally, and in some cases irreversible.
There is also a rise in the frequency and severity of extreme
weather events. There are permanent impacts on living and working
conditions, buildings and infrastructure. As a result, UK and
global GDP growth is permanently lower and macroeconomic
uncertainty increases. Reflecting the fact that the future looks
materially worse at the end of the scenario, with the adverse
effects of climate change set to worsen further, UK and US equity
prices are respectively just under 20 and 25% lower than they might
otherwise be.
Climate change is managed within
the Group's governance and risk management
frameworks.
Specifically, the
· AL
Risk Committee oversees ESG and the financial risks of climate
change.
· AL
Credit Committee considers implications of climate change on new
and existing lending.
· AL
Investment Committee considers implications of climate change on
investment decisions.
· AL
Product Governance Committee considers climate change on
propositions.
Climate Change is referenced in
key documents including the:
· ICAAP,
· Risk
appetite framework,
· AL
risk hierarchy,
· Credit policy.
|
Metrics and Targets
Describe the targets used by the
organisation to manage climate-related risks and opportunities and
performance against targets.
Disclose the metrics used by the
organisation to assess climate-related risks and opportunities in
line with its strategy and risk management process.
Disclose Scope 1, Scope 2 and, if
appropriate, Scope 3 greenhouse gas ("GHG") emissions and the
related risks.
|
Aspirations
All Buy To Let properties to be
either EPC C, or have valid exemption by 2035
AL lend against high quality
residential collateral. Typically these properties are EPC C. AL
also support Landlords to improve the quality of their collateral,
including EPC gradings, where they are currently beneath
C.
Following systems upgrade, EPC
ratings are now collected on all new lending and this metric will
be shared going forward.
|
Metrics
• % of Buy To Let properties
EPC C and above
|
All leases to be for electric, or
clean alternative, vehicles by 2050 with exception of classic
cars.
AL want to support clients as they
transition to the low carbon economy and recognise the transition
will occur at different speeds. However, AL will cease providing
financing on petrol and diesel cars and vans from 2035, and
non-zero emission heavy goods vehicles from 2040.
|
• Current year % of new
electric and hybrid of total vehicles
financed.
|
Energy & utility exposure to
be maintained at less than 1% of AL lending portfolio (0.22%, June
2023).
|
• Energy and Utility
Exposure as a % of portfolio.
|
Be Net Zero by 2050
By reducing carbon emissions and
minimising waste
• Complete switch to new
London
building which is
rated "Excellent"
• Company car fleet to be
fully electric
or hybrid by
2035
• Company heavy goods fleet
(AAG)
to be powered by
non-combustion
engines by
2040
Improve recycling rates to 60% by
2025
|
• Scope 1 and 2 intensity
ratios
• General Waste Recycling
%
|
|
Scope 1,2 and 3 emissions are
reported on page 38 below.
(Scope 3 emissions will remain as
per 2022. We have investigated and decided against extending Scope
3 emissions reporting to the lending and investment portfolios. The
Scope 3 emissions methodology and data would not be reliable and
would give an illusion of accuracy that would not help decision
making.)
|
Streamlined Energy & Carbon Reporting
(SECR)
The Group has worked again with a
specialist energy management consultancy, Carbon Decoded, to gather
the information required to be reported by large unquoted companies
under the Companies (Directors' Report) and Limited Liability
Partnerships (Energy and Carbon Report) Regulations
2018:
• All energy in line with
GHG Scope One - gas and owned transport, Scope Two - electricity
and Scope
Three - non-owned
transport.
• An intensity metric to
enable year on year improvements to be tracked.
The report covers data from 1
January to 31 December 2023. The Group has reported all
sources of environmental impact, as required in SECR, over which it
has financial control, being the Company and its
subsidiaries.
Base Year
The Base Year for the organisation
is a rolling annual comparison.
Reporting Methodology
• Data has been collected
for electricity, gas and transport.
• GHG Protocol Corporate
Accounting and Reporting Standard has been followed where
relevant.
• Data was collected
specifically for the purpose of SECR.
• The 2022 and 2023 UK
Government Conversion Factors for Company Reporting were used for
all calculations of Carbon emissions.
• Data was estimated where
necessary, as set out below.
Estimated Data
The following data was estimated
in 2023:
Dominion Street, London Natural
Gas
|
Gas use is included in the rent
for the property and sub-metering is not available, estimates are
based on floor area
|
Bristol and Gatwick
|
Energy is included in the rent,
and sub-metering for the office is not available, estimates are
based on floor area. Note that the floor area, occupied by the
business in Bristol, increased this year as has the estimated
electricity for this property.
|
On-site Transport
|
Diesel used for forklift trucks
and refrigerated vehicles held on site at Wolverhampton has been
estimated.
|
Operational Scopes
The report contains all Scope One
and Two energy use and Scope Three Grey Fleet for the whole Group
as required by SECR.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Reporting Summary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
|
2022
|
Scope One
|
Measure
|
kWh
|
Carbon
Tonnes tCO2e
|
Intensity Ratio tCO2e
|
|
Measure
|
kWh
|
Carbon
Tonnes tCO2e
|
Intensity Ratio tCO2e
|
Natural Gas - Intensity Ratio
tCO2e/m2
|
5,779
|
407,063
|
75
|
0.0130
|
|
5,779
|
397,824
|
73
|
0.0130
|
Kerosene - Intensity Ratio
tCO2e/m2
|
1,545
|
57,345
|
14
|
0.0090
|
|
1,545
|
61,926
|
15
|
0.0100
|
Diesel - Mixed Onsite Use No
Metric Available
|
|
336,008
|
80
|
|
|
|
287,841
|
69
|
|
Company HGVs Intensity Ratio
tCO2e/miles
|
68,985
|
293,381
|
70
|
0.0010
|
|
90,720
|
397,340
|
96
|
0.0017
|
Company Cars Intensity Ratio
tCO2e/miles
|
384,242
|
273,464
|
64
|
0.0002
|
|
314,699
|
269,795
|
65
|
0.0002
|
Total Scope One
|
|
1,367,261
|
303
|
|
|
|
1,414,726
|
318
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Scope Two
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Electricity - Intensity Ratio
tCO2e/m2
|
12,400
|
1,693,514
|
351
|
0.0283
|
|
14,274
|
1,703,083
|
329
|
0.0231
|
Company Cars Intensity Ratio
tCO2e/miles
|
17,106
|
3,063
|
1
|
-
|
|
19,656
|
8,317
|
2
|
0.0001
|
Total Scope Two
|
|
1,696,577
|
351
|
|
|
|
1,711,401
|
331
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Scope Three
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Grey Fleet Vehicles Intensity
Ratio tCO2e/miles
|
272,158
|
294,941
|
69
|
0.0003
|
|
270,683
|
337,205
|
80
|
0.0003
|
Total Scope Three
|
272,158
|
294,941
|
69
|
0.0003
|
|
270,683
|
337,205
|
80
|
0.0003
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total of all Scopes
|
|
3,358,778
|
724
|
|
|
|
3,463,331
|
729
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Estimated Data
|
|
18%
|
|
|
|
|
15%
|
|
|
Corrective Actions
The prior year numbers have been
restated due to further details about diesel use at Wolverhampton
being identified during the Energy Savings Opportunity Scheme
("ESOS") audit. The calculation in 2022 for HGVs was assessed as
average laden, but the ESOS audit revealed that this should be
unladen. The audit also showed that the value used for on-site
transport was under reported. Both of these numbers have been
corrected and restated for 2022, representing an overall increase
of one tonne of carbon for the prior year.
Changes from 2022
Scope One
There was a 2.6% increase in
carbon tonnes for Natural Gas. This is attributed to an increase at
Wilson Street for heating and hot water.
AAG fuels show improved control in
2023 with an 7.2% decrease in Kerosene, but Diesel used on-site has
increased by 15.7%, an overall increase in these fuels of 9.8
tCO2e.
The carbon tonnes for AAG HGVs
have reduced by 27.1% due to a reduction in miles of
24%.
Scope Two
There have been small changes in
the portfolio of properties compared to last year. Whilst
electricity measured in kWh shows a small decrease compared to
2022, the conversion factor for electricity has risen this year due
to the mix of fuels generating electricity for the grid. This has
caused a 6% increase in tCO2e in 2023, compared to 2022.
Scope Three Transport
Mileage driven by employees in
their own vehicles on behalf of the business has remained
reasonably similar in 2023 compared to 2022 with a 0.5% increase.
The significant drop in tCO2e of 13.9% is related to the type of
vehicles being driven with a higher number of miles driven in
petrol hybrid and electric vehicles.
Intensity Ratio
An intensity ratio is used to
enable year on year comparison. As Arbuthnot is an
office-based business the recognised standard measure is
kilowatt-hour per square metre (kWh/m2). This enables the energy
use to be compared to industry standard benchmarks. Similarly
for transport, the metric is kilowatt-hour per mile (kWh/mile). For
reporting purposes, the Carbon Tonnes/floor area and miles have
also been reported as required by the Regulations.
Energy Efficiency
Actions
Further improvement in transport
emissions have been made with Arbuthnot Latham running 100%
electric company cars and driving fewer company miles in 2023,
representing a 62.5% reduction in tCO2e. AAG have also continued to
improve the emissions of vehicles in the fleet, moving
significantly to petrol hybrid vehicles; however, increased mileage
in company vehicles means savings have only led to a drop of one
tCO2e.
Following the decision to relocate
the offices at Wilson Street and Dominion Street later in the year
to new head office premises at 20 Finsbury Circus, there has been
no further investment in energy savings in 2023 at these
buildings.
Group Directors' Report
The Directors present their report
for the year ended 31 December 2023.
Business Activities
The principal activities of the
Group are banking and financial services. The business review and
information about future developments, key performance indicators
and principal risks are contained in the Strategic Report on pages
7 to 39.
Corporate Governance
The Corporate Governance report on
pages 47 to 54 contains information about the Group's corporate
governance arrangements, including in relation to the Board's
application of the UK Corporate Governance Code.
Results and Dividends
The results for the year are shown
on page 66 of the financial statements. The profit after tax for
the year of £35.4m (2022: £16.5m) is included in reserves. The
Directors recommend the payment of a final dividend of 27p (2022:
25p) per share which, together with the interim dividend of 19p
(2022: 17p) paid on 22 September 2023 represents total dividends
for the year of 46p (2022: 42p). The final dividend, if approved by
members at the 2024 Annual General Meeting ("AGM"), will be paid on
31 May 2024 to shareholders on the register at close of business on
19 April 2024.
Directors
The names of the Directors of the
Company at the date of this report, together with biographical
details, are given on pages 40 and 41 of this Annual Report. Ms
J.D. Almond, Ms A.A. Knight and Lord Sassoon were appointed to the
Board on 1 September 2023. All the other Directors listed on those
pages were directors of the Company throughout the
year.
Ms Almond, Ms Knight and Lord
Sassoon offer themselves for election under Article 75 of the
Articles of Association. Messrs Cobb and Dewar being eligible,
offer themselves for re-election under Article 78 of the Articles
of Association. Mr. Cobb has a service agreement terminable on
twelve months' notice. Mr. Dewar, an independent non-executive
director, has a letter of appointment terminable on three months'
notice.
Articles of Association
The Company's articles of association may only
be amended by a special resolution of the Ordinary shareholders.
They were last amended at the AGM in May 2017 and can be viewed at
www.arbuthnotlatham.co.uk/group/investor-relations/announcements.
Viability Statement
In accordance with the UK
Corporate Governance Code, the Directors confirm that there is a
reasonable expectation that the Group will continue to operate and
meet its liabilities, as they fall due, for the three-year period
up to 31 December 2026. A period of three years has been chosen
because it is the period covered by the Group's strategic planning
cycle and also incorporated in the Individual Capital Adequacy
Assessment Process ("ICAAP"), which forecasts key capital
requirements, expected changes in capital resources and applies
stress testing over that period.
The Directors' assessment has been
made with reference to:
• the Group's current position and
prospects - please see the Financial Review on pages 11 to
21;
• the Group's key principles -
please see Corporate Philosophy on page 3; and
• the Group's risk management
framework and associated policies, as explained in Note 6 to the
financial statements.
The Group's strategy and
three-year plan are evaluated and approved by the Directors
annually. The plan considers the Group's future projections of
profitability, cash flows, capital requirements and resources, and
other key financial and regulatory ratios over the period. The
ICAAP is embedded in the risk management framework of the Group and
is subject to continuing updates and revisions when necessary. The
ICAAP process is used to stress the capital position of the Group
over the three-year planning period. It is updated at least
annually as part of the business planning process.
Going Concern
In assessing the Company's and the
Group's Going Concern position, the Directors have made appropriate
enquiries which assessed the following factors:
• the Group's strategy,
profitability and funding;
• the Group's risk management (see
Note 6 to the financial statements) and capital resources (see Note
7);
• the results of the Group's
capital and liquidity stress testing;
• the results of the Group's
reverse stress testing and the stress levels that have the
potential to cause its business plan failure; and
• the Group's recovery plan and
potential management actions to mitigate stress impacts on capital
and liquidity.
The key Macro-Economic Risks for
the stress testing included:
• Property market falls of up to
45% in property values;
• Stock market falls of up to 45%
in UK equity prices;
• Interest rate rise/fall;
and
• Regulation change.
The key Idiosyncratic Risks for
the stress testing included:
• Credit losses;
• Operational events (i.e. fraud,
cyber event, etc.);
• Decline in profitability;
and
• Liquidity event (i.e.
significant deposit outflow).
As a result of the assessment, the
Directors are satisfied that the Company and the Group have
adequate resources to continue in operation for a period of at
least twelve months from when the financial statements are
authorised for issue. The financial statements are therefore
prepared on the going concern basis.
Share Capital
The Company has in issue two
classes of shares, Ordinary shares and Ordinary Non-Voting shares,
each with a nominal value of 1p each. The Non-Voting shares rank
pari passu with the Ordinary shares, including the right to receive
the same dividends as the Ordinary shares, except that they do not
have the right to vote in shareholder meetings.
During the year the Company's
issued share capital increased by 1,297,297 ordinary shares through
the allotment and issue of ordinary shares through the placing of
and subscription for new voting Ordinary shares in the Company,
raising approximately £12.0 million in a fundraising. The shares
were allotted and issued on 5 May 2023 at the placing price on a
non-pre-emptive basis pursuant to authorities granted to the
directors of the Company at the general meeting held on 4 May 2023.
As a result of the issue, the Company's issued share capital
increased by 8.64%. In the three year period prior to the issue,
the Company did not issue any other shares for cash on a
non-pre-emptive basis.
Related Party Transaction
Of these newly issued shares, Sir
Henry Angest subscribed for 729,843 shares at a cost of
£6,751,047.75 which is disclosed in accordance with Rule 19 of the
AIM Rules for Companies.
Authority to Purchase Shares
Shareholders will be asked to
approve a Special Resolution renewing the authority of the
Directors to make market purchases of shares not exceeding 10% of
the issued Ordinary and Ordinary Non-Voting share capital. The
Directors will keep the position under review in order to maximise
the Company's resources in the best interests of shareholders.
Details of the resolutions renewing this authority are included in
the Notice of Meeting on pages 163 and 164. No shares were
purchased during the year. The maximum number of Treasury shares
held at any time during the year was 390,274 Ordinary shares and
19,040 Ordinary Non-Voting shares of 1p each.
Financial Risk Management
Details of how the Group manages
risk are set out in in the Strategic Report and in Note 6 to the
financial statements.
Directors' Interests
The interests of current Directors
and their families in the shares of the Company at the dates shown,
together with the percentage of the current issued share capital
held (excluding treasury shares), were as follows:
Beneficial Interests - Ordinary
shares
|
1
January 2023
|
31
December 2023
|
22 March
2024
|
%
|
Sir Henry Angest
|
8,376,401
|
9,176,185
|
9,276,185
|
57.3
|
Sir Nigel Boardman
|
26,062
|
26,062
|
26,062
|
0.2
|
J.D. Almond
|
-*
|
11,617
|
11,617
|
0.1
|
J.R. Cobb
|
6,000
|
6,000
|
6,000
|
-
|
A.A. Salmon
|
51,699
|
51,699
|
51,699
|
0.3
|
|
|
|
|
|
Beneficial Interests - Ordinary
Non-Voting shares
|
1
January 2023
|
31
December 2023
|
22 March
2024
|
%
|
Sir Henry Angest
|
86,674
|
86,674
|
86,674
|
64.9
|
J.R. Cobb
|
60
|
60
|
60
|
-
|
A.A. Salmon
|
516
|
516
|
516
|
0.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
*At date of appointment
|
|
|
|
|
Substantial Shareholders
The Company was aware at 12 March
2024 of the following substantial holdings in the Ordinary shares
of the Company, other than those held by one director shown
above:
Holder
|
|
Ordinary
Shares
|
%
|
Liontrust Asset
Management
|
1,643,954
|
10.2
|
Slater Investments
|
|
1,190,376
|
7.4
|
Mr. R Paston
|
|
529,130
|
3.3
|
Significant Contracts
No Director, either during or at the end of
the financial year, was materially interested in any contract with
the Company or any of its subsidiaries, which was significant in
relation to the Group's business. At 31 December 2023, one Director
had a loan from Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Limited amounting to
£1.5m (2022: £1.4m) and four directors had deposits amounting to
£3.2m (2022: £4.4m), all on normal commercial terms as disclosed in
Note 43 of the financial statements.
Directors' Indemnities
The Company's Articles of
Association provide that, subject to the provisions of the
Companies Act 2006, the Company may indemnify any Director or
former Director in respect of liabilities (and associated costs and
expenses) incurred in connection with the performance of their
duties as a Director of the Company or any subsidiary and may
purchase and maintain insurance against any such liability. The
Company maintained directors and officers liability insurance
throughout the year.
Employee Engagement
The Company gives due consideration to the
employment of disabled persons and is an equal opportunities
employer. It also regularly provides employees with
information on matters of concern to them, consults on decisions
likely to affect their interests and encourages their involvement
in the performance of the Company through regular communications
and in other ways. Further information on employee engagement is
given in the Strategic Report on pages 27 and 28.
The Company has a policy in place to ensure
that it applies the Equality Act 2010 which makes it unlawful to
discriminate on the grounds of disability and other protected
characteristics. At the recruitment stage, reasonable adjustments
are made to ensure that no candidate is disadvantaged because of
their disability. Should existing employees become disabled, every
effort is made to retain them within the workforce wherever
reasonable and practicable. The Group also endeavours to provide
equal opportunities in the training, promotion and general career
development of disabled employees.
Engagement with Suppliers, Customers and
Others
Information on engagement with suppliers,
customers and other stakeholders is given in the Strategic Report
on page 24.
Streamlined Energy & Carbon Reporting
The information required by the
Companies (Directors' Report) and Limited Liability Partnerships
(Energy and Carbon Report) Regulations 2018 is set out in the
Sustainability Report on pages 37 to 39. These Regulations
implement the Government's policy on Streamlined Energy and Carbon
Reporting (SECR) to support business in understanding its
responsibility for carbon emissions and to help establish plans to
become Net Zero by 2050.
Political Donations
The Company made political
donations of £7,500 during the year (2022: £30,000), being payment
for attendance at political functions. An Ordinary resolution will
be proposed at the forthcoming AGM to renew the authority, last
given in June 2020, to make such donations in accordance with
Sections 366 and 367 of the Companies Act 2006. This resolution is
for the total amount donated or expended not to exceed £250,000,
which is the same level as the current authority granted in June
2020, over a further four years to 22 May 2028.
Shareholders may recall that at
the AGM in June 2020 74.6% of total votes cast were in favour of
the resolution and so, in line with the UK Corporate Governance
Code, the Company consulted with five institutional shareholders,
comprising almost all of the votes of those which it identified as
not having supported the resolution, in order to understand why
they had voted against the resolution. The renewal of the
resolution in 2020 followed an exceptional amount of expenditure of
£77,000 being incurred during 2019, being donations to the
Conservative Party ahead of the 2019 General Election in view of
the significant adverse impact that a Labour government under
Jeremy Corbyn would have had on the Group's clients and business.
Having explained its position, the Board was encouraged by the
continued support of its major shareholders.
Since June 2020, aggregated
political donations have been well within the authorised amount,
totalling £67,500 (£10,000 in 2020, £20,000 in 2021, £30,000 in
2022 and £7,500 in 2023). These payments were made for payment
mainly for attendance at political functions associated with the
Conservative Party for which, as publicly disclosed in the
Electoral Commission register, Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Limited
acts as a banker.
The Board continues to believe
that it is in the interests of shareholders that it has the
flexibility to make such payments in light of prevailing political
circumstances over the next few years. It accepts that
institutional shareholders may have a policy of voting against
political donations, but believes the Company's circumstances
justify a different approach. The Board therefore recommends
approval of the resolution which is for a further four-year period
in order to retain this flexibility. It welcomes engagement
with shareholders and continues to maintain communications via
one-to-one meetings as appropriate.
Events after the Balance Sheet Date
There were no material post
balance sheet events.
AGM
The Company's AGM will be held on
Wednesday 22 May 2024 at which Ordinary Shareholders will be asked
to vote on a number of resolutions. Shareholders are encouraged to
submit their votes in respect of the business to be discussed via
proxy, appointing the Chairman of the meeting as their proxy. This
will ensure that votes will be counted if shareholders are unable
to attend the meeting in person. The resolutions, together with
explanatory notes about voting arrangements, are set out on pages
163 to 167.
Auditor
A resolution for the
re-appointment of Mazars LLP as auditor will be proposed at the
forthcoming AGM in accordance with section 489 of the Companies Act
2006.
Disclosure of Information to the Auditor
Each of the persons who are
Directors at the date of approval of this Annual Report confirm
that:
• so far as each director is
aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the
Company's auditor is unaware; and
• they have taken all the steps
they ought to have taken as a director to make themselves aware of
any relevant audit
information and to
establish that the Company's auditor is aware of that
information.
This confirmation is given and
should be interpreted in accordance with the provisions of section
418 of the Companies Act 2006.
Statement of Directors' Responsibilities in Respect of the
Strategic Report and the Directors' Report and the Financial
Statements
The Directors are responsible for
preparing the Strategic Report, the Directors' Report and the
Financial Statements in accordance with applicable law and
regulations. Company Law requires the Directors to prepare Group
and Parent Company Financial Statements for each financial year. As
required by the AIM Rules for Companies and in accordance with the
Rules of the AQSE Growth Market, they are required to prepare the
Group Financial Statements in accordance with UK-adopted
international accounting standards in conformity with the
requirements of the Companies Act 2006 and have elected to prepare
the Parent Company Financial Statements on the same
basis.
Financial Statements
Under Company Law the Directors
must not approve the Financial Statements unless they are satisfied
that they give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the
Group and the Company and of the Group profit or loss for that
period. In preparing each of the Group and Parent Company Financial
Statements, the Directors are required to:
•
select suitable accounting policies and then apply them
consistently;
•
make judgements and estimates that are reasonable, relevant and
reliable;
•
state whether they have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted
International Accounting Standards in conformity with the
requirements of the Companies Act 2006;
•
assess the Group and Parent Company's ability to continue as a
going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going
concern; and
•
use the going concern basis of accounting unless they intend either
to liquidate the Group or the Parent Company or to cease
operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do
so.
The Directors are responsible for
keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and
explain the Parent Company's transactions and disclose with
reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the
Parent Company and enable them to ensure that its Financial
Statements comply with the Companies Act 2006. They are responsible
for such internal control as they determine is necessary to enable
the preparation of financial statements that are free from material
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and have general
responsibility for taking such steps as are reasonably open to them
to safeguard the assets of the Company and to prevent and detect
fraud and other irregularities.
The Directors are responsible for
the maintenance and integrity of the corporate and financial
information included on the Company's website. Legislation in the
UK governing the preparation and dissemination of Financial
Statements may differ from legislation in other
jurisdictions.
The Directors confirm that the
Annual Report and financial statements, taken as a whole, are fair,
balanced and understandable and provide the information necessary
for shareholders to assess the Group and Parent Company's position,
performance, business model and strategy.
By order of the Board
Corporate Governance
Introduction and Overview
The Company has a strong and
effective corporate governance framework. The Board endorses the
principles of openness, integrity and accountability which underlie
good governance and applies the principles of the UK Corporate
Governance Code, published by the Financial Reporting Council in
July 2018 ("the FRC Code"), and complies with its provisions in so
far as they are considered appropriate for the Company, given its
size and circumstances, and the role and overall shareholding of
its majority shareholder. The Company has been approved by the
Prudential Regulation Authority ("PRA") as a parent financial
holding company of its banking subsidiary, Arbuthnot Latham &
Co., Limited. Arbuthnot Latham is authorised by the PRA and
regulated by the Financial Conduct Authority ("FCA") and by the
PRA. Three of its subsidiaries, Asset Alliance Leasing Limited,
Forest Asset Finance Limited and Renaissance Asset Finance Limited,
are authorised and regulated by the FCA. Accordingly, the Group
operates to the high standards of corporate accountability and
regulatory compliance appropriate for such a business.
The Board decided in 2018 to
report against the FRC Code. This decision was made in light of the
requirement in the AIM Rules for Companies that AIM listed
companies state which corporate governance code they have decided
to apply, how the company complies with that code, and where it
departs from its chosen code an explanation of the reasons for
doing so. The Rules of the AQSE Growth Market also require the
Company to adopt, as far as possible, the principles and standards
set down in a recognised UK corporate governance code. This
information is published on the Company's website and the Company
reviews it each year as part of its annual reporting cycle.
This section of the Annual Report summarises how the Company
applies the FRC Code and in broad terms how it has complied with
its provisions throughout the year, giving explanations where it
has chosen not to do so.
In January 2024 the FRC made
limited revisions to its Code, publishing a UK Corporate Governance
Code 2024 ("the 2024 Code"). The 2024 Code is not applicable to the
Company until its year beginning 1 January 2025 and for one
provision until its year beginning 1 January 2026. The Company will
be reviewing its procedures to enable the Board to report under the
2024 Code, as required, in due course.
Leadership and Purpose
The Company is led by the Board
which comprises ten members: Sir Henry Angest, the Executive
Chairman and Chief Executive; two other executive directors, Andrew
Salmon and James Cobb; six independent non-executive directors, Sir
Nigel Boardman, Angela Knight, Ian Dewar, Sir Alan Yarrow, Jayne
Almond and Lord Sassoon; and one other non-executive Director,
Frederick Angest. This means that more than half of the Board,
excluding the Chairman, comprises independent non-executive
directors.
The Board sets the long-term focus
and customer-oriented culture of the Group. The responsibilities of
Sir Henry Angest as Chairman include leading the Board, ensuring
its effectiveness in all aspects of its role, ensuring effective
communication with shareholders, setting the Board's agenda and
ensuring that all Directors are encouraged to participate fully in
the activities and decision-making process of the Board.
The Board has for many years led a
company which focuses on sustainable growth over the longer-term
with a culture to match. Investment in resources has been strong
and has continued where and as appropriate, with the focus on the
benefit this will bring to bear for stakeholders over time. The aim
continues to be for a culture of openness among the workforce which
combines with the prudent and effective technological and
individual controls in place across the business to ensure strong
risk management in the Company's continued long-term
success.
The Group's cultural values are
reflected in a brand values document linking the Arbuthnot
Principles to the Group's culture as a way of communicating culture
across the business. These cultural Principles are encapsulated in
five Group values which are fully embedded into day-to-day
activities. These are integrity, respect, empowerment, energy and
drive, and collaboration. A formal approach to Environmental,
Social and Governance (ESG) is in place to develop over time under
five 'pillars of sustainability' - governance, employees,
community, environment and clients.
The Board
The Board met regularly throughout
the year. In total it held eight scheduled meetings, six of which
were held jointly with the Board of Arbuthnot Latham with the other
two being held to approve the Annual and Interim Reports, and two
ad-hoc meetings relating to the fundraising. It also held a
separate strategy meeting, together with the AL Directors, in
September. Substantive agenda items have briefing papers, which are
circulated in a timely manner before each meeting. The Board
ensures that it is supplied with all the information that it
requires and requests in a form and of a quality to fulfil its
duties.
In addition to overseeing the
management of the Group, the Board has determined certain items
which are reserved for decision by itself, as set out in the
Schedule of Matters Reserved to the Board which is reviewed
annually and is published on the Company's website at
https://www.arbuthnotlatham.co.uk/group/about/corporate-governance.
These matters include approval of the Group's long-term objectives
and commercial strategy, ensuring a sound system of internal
control, risk management strategy, approval of major investments,
acquisitions and disposals, any changes to the capital structure
and the overall review of corporate governance.
The Company Secretary is
responsible for ensuring that the Board processes and procedures
are appropriately followed and support effective decision making.
All directors have access to the Company Secretary's advice and
services. There is an agreed procedure for directors to obtain
independent professional advice in the course of their duties, if
necessary, at the Company's expense.
New directors receive induction
training upon joining the Board, with individual listed company
training provided by the Company's AIM Nominated Adviser and AQSE
Corporate Adviser. Regulatory and compliance training is provided
by the AL Chief Compliance Officer or by an external firm of
lawyers, accountants and other subject matter experts. Risk
management training is provided, including that in relation to the
ICAAP and ILAAP, by the AL Chief Risk Officer with an overview of
credit and its associated risks and mitigation by the AL Chief
Credit Officer.
Board Evaluation
The annual Board Effectiveness
Review was conducted internally. The 2023 evaluation took the form
of a confidential online questionnaire which assessed the
performance of the Board and its Committees. The questions were set
to explore the themes developed over recent years including Board
effectiveness, Board composition, Board dynamics, alignment of the
Board and executive team, interaction with major shareholders,
induction, performance and training, Board Committees and the
Secretariat. They also covered clarity of the business,
strategy and risk and accountability. The results were discussed by
the Board in February 2024 and proposed actions arising will be
considered in due course. The responses were positive, confirming
that the Board was of the view that it receives the correct level
of insight into and oversight of the Company, both directly to it
and in terms of management information and oral updates provided
during meetings. Directors also agreed that the Arbuthnot culture
set out in the Arbuthnot Principles and Values manifests itself at
Board level and in the external view of the Group as a
whole.
Overview of Compliance with the FRC Code, together with
Exceptions
The Board focuses not only on the
provisions of the Code but on its principles, ensuring as
follows:
•
The Company's purpose, values and strategy as a prudently managed
organisation align with its culture, with a focus on fairness and
long-term shareholder returns.
•
The Board has an appropriate combination of executive and
non-executive directors, who have both requisite knowledge and
understanding of the business and the time to commit to their
specific roles.
•
The Board comprises directors with the necessary combination of
skills to ensure the effective discharge of its obligations, with
an annual evaluation of the capability and effectiveness of each
director as well as the Board as a composite whole; appropriate
succession plans are also in place and reviewed annually, or more
frequently if appropriate.
•
The Board and Audit Committee monitor the procedures in place to
ensure the independence and effectiveness of both external and
internal auditors, and the risk governance framework of the
Company, with all material matters highlighted to the relevant
forum (Board/Committee).
•
Remuneration policies and practices are designed to support
strategy and promote long-term sustainable success, with a
Remuneration Committee in place to oversee director and senior
management pay.
In respect of the Code's specific
provisions, an annual review is carried out, comparing the
Company's governance arrangements and practices against them. Any
divergences are noted, with relevant rationale considered carefully
to determine whether it is appropriate. Consideration is also given
to guidance issued, which may require a review of the relevant
reasoning intra-year. In line with the FRC's Guidance on Board
Effectiveness, the Board additionally takes into account its
suggestions of good practice when applying the Code focusing on the
five key principles specified in the Code.
Where the Company's governance
does not align completely with the Code, it is generally as a
result of the role of its overall majority shareholder, itself
adding a level of protection to long-term shareholder interests,
which has had a positive impact on the Company.
All divergences from the Code,
with an explanation of the reasons for doing so are set out
below:
Provision 5 - The Board has regard
to the interests of all its key stakeholders in its decision
making. Executive Directors and senior management are fully engaged
with the workforce, all of whom interact on a daily basis. Mr.
Dewar is the Company's Whistleblowing Champion and is available at
all times in this role. It has not been deemed necessary to appoint
an employee representative to the Board as the Company has fewer
than 20 employees, all of whom have direct access to the Board
including its Non-Executive Directors. Given its size, as stated in
the s.172 Statement on page 23, one of the non-executive directors
of Arbuthnot Latham and its Whistleblowing Champion, has been
designated by its board as the director to engage with the
Arbuthnot Latham Group's workforce.
Provision 9 - The Chairman was not
independent on appointment, though he was appointed prior to the
introduction of the provision. Sir Henry Angest carries out the
role of Chairman and Chief Executive, given his long-term interest
as majority shareholder, itself aligning with the interests of
other shareholders. The Company follows the US model that is
successful in ensuring commercial success with strong corporate
governance and stakeholder awareness, having a shared Chairman and
CEO, with a separate, empowered, Chief Operating Officer. In
his role as CEO, Sir Henry Angest is responsible for the effective
operation and delivery of the business and ensures that he is
surrounded by an exceptional management team which ensures the
strong leadership required. In particular, ABG has a strong Group
Chief Operating Officer and Group Finance Director ensuring
challenge and independence from a business perspective, against the
stakeholder focus of the Chairman carrying out his Chairman's
role.
Provision 10 ¬ The Board considers
Jayne Almond, Sir Nigel Boardman, Angela Knight and Lord Sassoon to
be independent, notwithstanding their directorships and, in the
case of Sir Nigel his chairmanship, at Arbuthnot Latham since their
views and any challenge are firmly independent from executive
management in both companies. The Board is of the view that the
dual directorships complement one another and that there is a
benefit to be derived from the appointment of independent directors
to both boards simultaneously.
Provision 12 - The Board has not
appointed a Senior Independent Director, as the main shareholder is
the Chairman and other large independent shareholders communicate
frequently with the Chairman, the Group Chief Operating Officer and
the Group Finance Director and with the Company's stockbroker,
Shore Capital.
Provision 14 - Attendance at
meetings is not reported. In the event that a Director is unable to
attend a meeting, that Director receives relevant papers in the
normal manner and relays any comments in advance of the meeting to
the Chairman. The same process applies in respect of the Board
Committees.
Provision 18 - Directors retire by rotation every three years in accordance
with the Company's Articles of Association and company law. The
Directors seeking re-election at the 2024 AGM are James Cobb and
Ian Dewar, who have served on the Board for 15 years and 8½ years
respectively. The contribution of Mr. Cobb as the Group Financial
Director has been invaluable in managing the capital and liquidity
requirements of the Group. He has also played a pivotal role in
sourcing and delivering the acquisitions that have shaped the
strategy of the Group. Mr. Dewar, with a wealth of experience as a
partner in a major accounting firm, has successfully chaired the
Audit Committee. Jayne Almond, Angela Knight and Lord Sassoon,
appointed to the Board by the Directors on 1 September 2023, will
be seeking election by Ordinary shareholders. Accordingly, the
Board fully supports the resolutions for their respective
reappointment and appointment of these Directors.
Provision 19 - Sir Henry Angest's
role as Chairman is critical to and reflective of the overall group
structure. It is through the responsibilities that derive from this
role that he is able to consider and protect not only the interests
of other shareholders, but also his own interests as a majority
shareholder as their interests are aligned. It is for this reason
that he surrounds himself with notably strong directors who
individually, and as a group, ensure the protection of not only his
investments, but also those of other shareholders. As such, he
remains as Chairman notwithstanding the length of his
tenure.
Provision 23 - The Nomination
Committee takes into account the provisions of the Board Diversity
Policy and in terms of succession planning the Equality, Diversity
and Inclusion Policy which promotes equality of opportunity for all
staff. Further information on diversity and inclusion is given in
the Sustainability Report on pages 27, 28 and 32, though the gender
balance of senior management and their direct reports has not been
given.
Provision 32 - Sir Henry Angest is
Chairman of the Remuneration Committee, as is appropriate in the
context of his majority shareholding.
Internal Control and Financial Reporting
The Board of directors has overall
responsibility for the Group's system of internal control and for
reviewing its effectiveness. Such a system is designed to manage
rather than eliminate risk of failure to achieve business
objectives and can only provide reasonable, but not absolute,
assurance against the risk of material misstatement or
loss.
The Directors and senior
management of the Group review and approve the Group's Risk
Management Policy and Risk Appetite framework. The Risk Management
Policy describes and articulates the risk management and risk
governance framework, methodologies, processes and infrastructure
required to ensure due attention to all material risks for
Arbuthnot Latham, including compliance with relevant regulatory
requirements.
The Risk Appetite framework sets
out the Board's risk attitude for the principal risks through a
series of qualitative statements and quantitative risk tolerance
metrics. These guide decision-making at all levels of the
organisation and form the basis of risk reporting. The key business
risks and emerging risks are continuously identified, evaluated and
managed by means of limits and controls at an operational level by
Arbuthnot Latham management, and are governed through AL
committees.
There are well-established
budgeting procedures in place and reports are presented regularly
to the Board detailing the results, in relation to Arbuthnot
Latham, of each principal business unit, variances against budget
and prior year, and other performance data. The Board receives
regular reports on risk matters that need to be brought to its
attention, enabling it to assess the Group's principal and emerging
risks. Material items are presented to the Board in the Risk
Report, which includes a risk dashboard, from the AL Chief Risk
Officer, who attends the Board meetings held concurrently with
those of Arbuthnot Latham. Significant risks identified in
connection with the development of new activities are subject to
consideration by the Board. The risk dashboard covers key
management actions which have included the climate change agenda
and its potential longer-term impact on property and other asset
classes and on management's approach to sustainability.
In November 2023, the Board
received a separate report from the AL CRO enabling it to monitor
the company's risk management and internal control systems and to
carry out its annual review of the effectiveness of the Group's
risk management and internal control systems. The report explained
the Risk Management Policy, together with principal risks, risk
appetite, policies, three lines of defence, systems, processes,
procedures and controls and the risk board dashboard. Following its
review, the Board confirms the effectiveness of the Company's risk
management and internal control systems.
Shareholder Communications
The majority shareholder is Sir
Henry Angest, Chairman and Chief Executive. The Company maintains
communications with its major external shareholders via one-to-one
meetings, as appropriate, by the Chairman and Chief Executive, the
Group Chief Operating Officer or the Group Finance Director on
governance and other matters. When practicable it also makes use of
the AGM to communicate with shareholders in person. The Company
aims to present a balanced and understandable assessment in all its
reports to shareholders, its regulators, other stakeholders and the
wider public. Key announcements and other information can be found
at www.arbuthnotgroup.com.
Board Committees
The Board has Audit, Nomination,
Remuneration, Donations and Policy Committees, each with formally
delegated duties and responsibilities and with written terms of
reference, which require consideration of the committee's
effectiveness. The Board keeps the governance arrangements under
review. Further information in relation to these committees is set
out below and the terms of reference of the Audit, Nomination and
Remuneration Committees are published on the Company's website. The
Board maintains direct responsibility for issues of Risk without
the need for its own Risk Committee, since responsibility for large
lending proposals is a direct responsibility of its subsidiary,
Arbuthnot Latham. Additionally the Chairman of the AL Risk
Committee reports to the Board at its regular meetings, held
jointly with the Arbuthnot Latham Board, on the activities of that
Committee which is responsible for monitoring the status of the
Arbuthnot Latham group against its principal risks.
Audit Committee
Membership and meetings
Membership of the Audit Committee
comprises Ian Dewar (as Chairman), Sir Nigel Boardman, Sir Alan
Yarrow and, since September 2023, Jayne Almond, Angela Knight and
Lord Sassoon. All of the Committee's members are therefore
independent non-executive Directors. Mr. Dewar and Lord Sassoon
have recent and relevant financial experience and the Committee as
a whole has competence relevant to the financial sector in which
the Company operates. The Company Secretary acts as its
Secretary.
The Audit Committee oversees, on
behalf of the Board, financial reporting, the appropriateness and
effectiveness of systems and controls, the work of Internal Audit
and the arrangements for and effectiveness of the external audit.
The ultimate responsibility for reviewing and approving the Annual
Report and Accounts and the Interim Report lies with the Board. The
Committee also reviews procedures for detecting fraud and
preventing bribery, reviews whistleblowing arrangements for
employees to raise concerns in confidence, and reviews, as
necessary, arrangements for outsourcing significant
operations.
External Audit
The external auditors, Mazars LLP,
have held office since their appointment in 2019 following a
competitive tender. The Committee assesses the independence and
objectivity, qualifications and effectiveness of the external
auditors on an annual basis as well as making a recommendation to
the Board on their reappointment. The Committee received a report
showing the level of non-audit services provided by the external
auditors during the year and members were satisfied that the extent
and nature of these did not compromise auditor independence. The
Committee has concluded that Mazars are independent and that their
audit is effective.
Activity in 2023
The Audit Committee held five
meetings during the year, four of which
were held jointly with the Audit Committee of Arbuthnot Latham with
the other one being held to review the Annual Report & Accounts
and draft final results announcement.
Internal Audit
On behalf of the Board, the Audit
Committee monitors the effectiveness of systems and controls. To
this end, Internal Audit provides the Committee and the Board with
detailed independent and objective assurance on the effectiveness
of governance, risk management and internal controls. It
additionally provides assurance to the Board that the culture
throughout the business is aligned with the Group's values,
incorporating within each internal audit an assessment of culture
in the area under review.
The Audit Committee approves the
Internal Audit risk-based programme of work and monitors progress
against the annual plan. The Committee reviews Internal Audit
resources and the arrangements that: ensure Internal Audit faces no
restrictions or limitations to conducting its work; that it
continues to have unrestricted access to all personnel and
information; and that Internal Audit remains objective and
independent from business management.
The Head of Internal Audit reports
directly to the Chairman of the Arbuthnot Latham Audit Committee.
In April 2023, the incumbent moved into a new senior internal
position after six years in the role and was succeeded by an
external candidate who had previously been Senior Manager of the
Group's Internal Audit, thereby providing a seamless transition. He
provides reports on the outcomes of Internal Audit work directly to
the Committee which monitors progress against actions identified in
these reports.
The Committee received a
self-assessment report on Internal Audit from the Head of Internal
Audit in September 2023 and is satisfied with Internal Audit
arrangements during the year.
Integrity of Financial Statements
and oversight of external audit
The Committee:
•
Received and agreed the Audit Plan prepared by the external
auditors;
•
Considered and formed a conclusion on the critical judgements
underpinning the Financial Statements, as presented in papers
prepared by management. In respect of all of these critical
judgements, the Committee concluded that the treatment in the
Financial Statements was appropriate.
•
Received reports from the external auditors on the matters arising
from their work, the key issues and conclusions they had reached;
and
•
Reviewed closely the detailed work carried out by management in
respect of Going Concern and Viability.
The reports from the external
auditors include details of internal control matters that they have
identified as part of the annual statutory financial statements
audit. Certain aspects of the system of internal control are also
subject to regulatory supervision, the results of which are
monitored closely by the Committee and the Board. In addition, the
Committee receives by exception reports on the ICAAP and ILAAP
which are key control documents that receive detailed consideration
by the board of Arbuthnot Latham.
The Committee approved the terms
of engagement and made a recommendation to the Board on the
remuneration to be paid to the external auditors in respect of
their audit services.
Significant areas of judgement and
estimation
The Audit Committee considered the
following significant issues and accounting judgements and
estimates in relation to the Financial Statements:
Impairment of financial assets
The Committee reviewed
presentations from management detailing the provisioning
methodology across the Group as part of the full year results
process. The Committee considered and challenged the provisioning
methodology applied by management, including timing of cash flows,
valuation and recoverability of supporting collateral on impaired
assets. The Committee concluded that the impairment
provisions, including management's judgements and estimates, were
appropriate.
The charge for impaired financial
assets totalled £3.2m for the year ended 31 December 2023. The
disclosures relating to impairment provisions are set out in Note
4.1(a) to the financial statements.
Property Portfolio
The Group owns two commercial
office properties and two repossessed properties. Of these
properties, two are held as inventory, one is held for sale and one
as an investment property. The properties held as inventory and
held for sale are measured at the lower of cost and net realisable
value on the basis of internal discounted cash flow models and
external valuation reports. The investment property is measured at
fair value on the basis of an external valuation report. The
Committee discussed the bases of valuation with management and with
the auditors who had engaged an internal expert to review
management's valuations.
As at 31 December 2023, the
Group's total property portfolio totalled £23.9m. The disclosures
relating to the carrying value of the investment property and the
properties held as inventory and for sale are set out in Notes
4.1(c), 4.1(d), 20, 25 and 31 to the financial
statements.
Residual Value Risk
The Committee discussed the fair
value adjustment for the portfolio of leased assets of Asset
Alliance Group where an uplift had been applied to represent
markets at the time of acquisition at 31 March 2021. The Committee
also reviewed the maintenance provision, recognised to eliminate
temporarily inflated values. It
established that the uplift in lease values at that date appeared
to have been completely justified by the subsequent asset sales
experience where in aggregate
losses had not
been made on sales of trucks at the uplifted
values. It also established that the
residual value provision at that time was deemed sufficient to
cover the shortfall between the value of the portfolio and the
estimated net sales value. This provision
has since been realised through sales, with no remaining balance at
year-end.
Going Concern and Viability
Statement
The financial statements are
prepared on the basis that the Group and Company are each a going
concern for a period of at least twelve months from when the
financial statements are authorised for issue. The Audit Committee
reviewed management's assessment, which incorporated analysis of
the ICAAP and ILAAP approved by the Board of Arbuthnot Latham and
of relevant metrics, focusing on liquidity, capital, and the stress
scenarios. It is satisfied that the going concern basis and
assessment of the Group's longer-term viability is
appropriate.
Other Committee
activities
The Audit Committee reviewed and
discussed the minutes of meetings of the Financial Regulatory
Reporting Committee whose main responsibility is to ensure that the
Group meets the PRA's regulatory reporting expectations. The
Committee performs this role since it is concerned with financial
reporting as well as with external reporting. During the year, it
also reviewed the FRC Publication: Audit Committees and the
External Audit: Minimum Standard in particular around audit
tendering, albeit that the report is only applicable to premium
listed FTSE 350 companies.
In November 2023, Committee
members contributed to the review of the Committee's effectiveness
as part of its evaluation by the Board. In February 2024, the
Committee reviewed its performance and agreed that it continued to
operate effectively. In March 2024 the Committee met separately
with each of the Head of Internal Audit and the Senior Statutory
Auditor without any other executives present. There were no
concerns raised by them in regard to discharging their
responsibilities.
On behalf of the Board, the Audit
Committee reviewed the financial statements as a whole in order to
assess whether they were fair, balanced and understandable. The
Committee discussed and challenged the balance and fairness of the
overall report with the executive directors and also considered the
views of the external auditor. The Committee was satisfied that the
Annual Report could be regarded as fair, balanced and
understandable and that it provides the information necessary for
shareholders to assess the Company's position and performance,
business model and strategy. It proposed that the Board approve the
Annual Report in that respect.
Nomination Committee
Membership and meetings
The Nomination Committee is
chaired by Sir Henry Angest and its other members are Sir Nigel
Boardman and Sir Alan Yarrow. A majority of the Committee's members
are therefore independent non-executive Directors. The Company
Secretary acts as its Secretary. The Committee meets once a year
and otherwise as required.
The Nomination Committee assists
the Board in discharging its responsibilities relating to the
composition of the Board. The Nomination Committee is responsible
for and evaluates on a regular basis the balance of skills,
experience, independence and knowledge on the Board, its size,
structure and composition, retirements and appointments of
additional and replacement directors and will make appropriate
recommendations to the Board on such matters. The Nomination
Committee also considers performance, training requirements and
succession planning, taking into account the skills and expertise
that will be needed on and beneficial to the Board in the
future.
Activity in 2023
The Nomination Committee met twice
during the year. It met first to assess and recommend the
appointment of Jayne Almond, Lord Sassoon and Angela Knight as
three new independent Non-Executive Directors as part of succession
planning and of its consideration of diversity as directors of the
Company. Jayne Almond is a highly experienced professional in the
banking, mortgages and financial services arenas, with past and
present appointments as Chairman, Chief Executive and NED in a wide
range of organisations. Angela Knight has a wealth of commercial
and financial experience from her time in government as a Treasury
Minister, as Chief Executive of the British Bankers' Association
(now UK Finance) and of Energy UK and as a non-executive director
of a range of listed companies over many years. Lord Sassoon
is a highly experienced professional in the banking and financial
services industry.
It was not considered appropriate
to widen the search to include other banking and financial services
experts for the roles, given the status and profile of these
individuals, and their exceptional knowledge of the sector and, in
the case of Ms Knight, her knowledge of the Group as a director of
Arbuthnot Latham since October 2016. In each case, it was regarded
that their careers and reputation demonstrably reflected a good
cultural fit with the Group and its Principles, Values and ESG
Pillars. For all of these reasons, each individual was approached
directly and it not being considered necessary to widen the search
to comprise other experts for the role, and so neither advertising
nor an external consultancy was used for these
appointments.
The Committee also met to assess
and confirm the collective and individual suitability of the
existing Board members. The contribution of Sir Henry Angest
remains invaluable in the successful development of the Company. As
regards the non-executive Directors' skill sets, Sir Nigel
Boardman's credibility, knowledge and reputation have been a real
benefit to the Board both in terms of collective and individual
suitability and when third parties are considering dealings with
the wider group. Ian Dewar, with a wealth of experience as a
partner in a major accounting firm, has successfully chaired the
Audit Committee. The Board has benefitted from Sir Alan Yarrow's
wise counsel, challenge to management and many years' banking
experience in the City of London. Frederick Angest is deepening his
knowledge about the business, working at Arbuthnot Latham as a
private banker, having worked previously within Wealth Management
and Credit Risk.
In terms of individual
performance, the Chairman confirmed that his assessment of all
Directors was that they were performing well, with the Executive
Directors additionally being formally reviewed in the context of
the Senior Managers' Regime applicable to Arbuthnot Latham which
confirmed continued strong performance. The Committee agreed with
this assessment individually in relation to all members of the
Board. Collectively, it was agreed that the Board had operated
effectively with a wide range of experience and knowledge. As noted
in the responses to the Board Effectiveness Questionnaire,
Non-Executives had provided appropriate challenge and
guidance.
In terms of the performance of the
Company's Board generally, the Committee noted that it takes into
account the provisions of the Board Diversity Policy and the Board
Suitability Policy. It reviewed the summary of training carried out
by each Director during 2023 and noted that Directors had been able
to carry out sufficient training both in person and
online.
In November 2023, the Nomination
Committee confirmed that the Board's current composition provides
the Company with a balanced, knowledgeable, diverse and informed
group of directors, bringing strategic acumen, foresight and
challenge to the executive, commensurate with the size of the
business. The Committee reviewed succession planning and
agreed that a sensible and strong plan remained in place. It also
agreed that it continued to operate effectively and, as such, no
further changes to its membership, composition or activities were
proposed to the Board.
Remuneration Committee
Membership and meetings
Membership is detailed in the
Remuneration Report on page 55. The Committee meets once a year and
otherwise as required. The Remuneration Report on pages 55 to 57
gives information on the Committee's responsibilities, together
with details of each Director's remuneration.
Donations Committee
Membership and meetings
The Donations Committee is chaired
by Sir Henry Angest and its other members are Andrew Salmon and Sir
Alan Yarrow The Company Secretary acts as its Secretary. The
Committee considers any political donation or expenditure as
defined within sections 366 and 367 of the Companies Act 2006. It
meets as necessary.
Activity in 2023
The Donations Committee met once
during the year. It agreed that the Committee was constituted and
continued to operate efficiently with its overall performance and
the performance of its individual members effective throughout the
year. As such, no changes to its membership or activities were
proposed to the Board.
Policy Committee
Membership and meetings
The Policy Committee is chaired by
Andrew Salmon. Amongst its responsibilities, the Committee reviews
the content of policy documentation to ensure that it meets legal
and regulatory requirements and approves it on behalf of the Board.
In December 2023, the Board approved a proposal to combine the
Committee with that of the Arbuthnot Latham Policy Committee. In
addition to Mr. Salmon and its other members, James Cobb and the AL
Chief Compliance Officer, two other members of the AL Committee,
being the AL Chief Risk Officer and an AL non-executive director
were appointed to it. A member of the Operational Risk team acts as
its Secretary.
Activity in 2023
The Policy Committee met three
times during the year to review and approve Company
policies.
Remuneration Report
Remuneration Committee
Membership of the Remuneration
Committee is limited to non-executive directors together with Sir
Henry Angest as Chairman. The other members of the Committee
are Sir Nigel Boardman and Sir Alan Yarrow. As such, a majority of
the Committee's members are therefore independent non-executive
Directors. The Company Secretary acts as its Secretary. The
Committee normally meets twice a year and otherwise, as
required.
The Remuneration Committee has
responsibility for approving the overall remuneration policy for
directors for review by the Board. The Committee is also
responsible for remuneration more generally including, inter alia,
in relation to the Company's policy on executive remuneration
determining, the individual remuneration and benefits package of
each of the Executive Directors and the fees for Non-Executive
Directors. Members of the Committee do not vote on their own
remuneration.
The Committee also deals with
remuneration-related issues, taking into account the requirements
established by the PRA and the FCA.
Remuneration Policy
The Remuneration Committee
determines the remuneration of individual directors having regard
to the size and nature of the business; the importance of
attracting, retaining and motivating management of the appropriate
calibre without paying more than is necessary for this purpose;
remuneration data for comparable positions, in particular at
challenger banks; the need to align the interests of executives
with those of shareholders; and an appropriate balance between
current remuneration and longer-term performance-related rewards.
The remuneration package can comprise a combination of basic annual
salary and benefits (including pension), a discretionary annual
bonus award related to the Committee's assessment of the
contribution made by the executive during the year and longer-term
incentives, including executive share options. Pension benefits
take the form of contributions paid by the Company to individuals
in the form of cash allowances, and, where applicable, to
individual money purchase schemes. The Remuneration Committee
reviews salary levels each year based on the performance of the
Group during the preceding financial period. This review does not
necessarily lead to increases in salary levels. For the purposes of
the requirements established by the PRA and the FCA, the Company
and its subsidiaries are all considered to be Tier 3
institutions.
Activity in 2023
The Remuneration Committee met
four times during the year. It undertook its regular activities
including reviewing the operation of the Remuneration Policy,
having regard to the performance of the Company during the year. It
reviewed the level of fees for non-executive Directors which it
decided to standardise, reflecting the appropriate level of fee to
continue to secure the services of a high level non-executive
director. It also reviewed and approved the Executive Directors'
remuneration.
The Committee also met to approve
the payment to Jayne Almond, and Lord Sassoon of the standardised
director's fee for a non-executive director, and to Angela Knight
who receives an extra amount being for her additional role as the
Board's Consumer Duty Champion, her fee already being received in
her capacity as a non-executive director of Arbuthnot
Latham.
In March 2024, the Committee met
again to review the Executive Directors' remuneration, approving,
after due consideration of comparable market rates, salary rises
for each of them and the award of bonuses to Messrs Salmon and Cobb
for exceptional performance in the year. As in previous years, Sir
Henry Angest waived his right to be considered for receipt of a
bonus. It decided to increase by £5,000 p.a. with effect from June
2024 the additional fee payable for chairing the Audit Committee,
whilst leaving unchanged the basic fee for acting as a
non-executive director. The Committee also agreed that it continued
to operate effectively with its overall performance and the
performance of its individual members effective throughout the 2023
year.
Directors' Service Contracts
Sir Henry Angest, Mr. Salmon and
Mr. Cobb each have service contracts terminable at any time on 12
months' notice in writing by either party.
Long Term Incentive Schemes
Grants were made to Messrs Salmon
and Cobb on 14 June 2016 under Phantom Option Scheme introduced on
that date, to acquire ordinary 1p shares in the Company at 1591p
exercisable in respect of 50% on or after 15 June 2020 and in
respect of the remaining 50% on or after 15 June 2021 when a cash
payment would be made equal to any increase in market
value.
Under this Scheme, these directors
were granted a phantom option to acquire 200,000 and 100,000
ordinary 1p shares respectively in the Company. The value of each
phantom option is related to the market price of an Ordinary Share.
The fair value of these options at the grant date was £1m. The
first tranche of share lapsed on 14 June 2023 when not exercised at
1591p. The second tranche had lapsed in 2020 as one of the
performance conditions was not met, being the payment of dividends
which was not possible in 2020 due to the regulators' response to
the pandemic, requiring banks to cease payment of dividends, and to
its economic impact.
On 23 July 2021, Messrs Salmon and
Cobb were granted further phantom options relating to 200,000 and
100,000 ordinary shares respectively. The fair value of these
options at the grant date was £1.4m. The value of each Ordinary
Share for the purposes of this grant of phantom options is 990
pence, being the mid-market share price at close of business on 23
July 2021. An increase in the value of an Ordinary Share over
990 pence will give rise to an entitlement to a cash payment by the
Company on the exercise of a phantom option. The right to exercise
phantom options is subject to the satisfaction of performance
conditions, as set out in note 40 to the financial statements. 50%
of each director's individual holding of phantom options is
exercisable after 23 July 2024 and the other 50% is exercisable
after 23 July 2026. These phantom options will lapse if not
exercised within seven years of the date of grant, i.e. by 23 July
2028. The fair value of the outstanding options at 31 December 2023
was £0.1m (2022: £0.1m).
Details of outstanding options are
set out below.
Phantom Options
|
At 1
January 2023
|
At 31
December 2023
|
Exercise
Price
£
|
Date
from which exercisable
|
Expiry
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
AA Salmon
|
100,000
|
-
|
£15.90
|
15-Jun-19
|
14-Jun-23
|
|
100,000
|
100,000
|
£9.90
|
23-Jul-24
|
23-Jul-28
|
|
100,000
|
100,000
|
£9.90
|
23-Jul-26
|
23-Jul-28
|
|
300,000
|
200,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
JR Cobb
|
50,000
|
-
|
£15.90
|
15-Jun-19
|
14-Jun-23
|
|
50,000
|
50,000
|
£9.90
|
23-Jul-24
|
23-Jul-28
|
|
50,000
|
50,000
|
£9.90
|
23-Jul-26
|
23-Jul-28
|
|
150,000
|
100,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
450,000
|
300,000
|
|
|
|
Directors' Emoluments
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Fees (including benefits in
kind)
|
416
|
301
|
Salary payments (including
benefits in kind)
|
6,094
|
5,197
|
Pension contributions
|
73
|
71
|
|
6,583
|
5,569
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
Total
|
|
Salary
|
Bonus
|
Benefits
|
Pension
|
Fees
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Sir Henry Angest
|
1,200
|
-
|
61
|
-
|
-
|
1,261
|
1,278
|
JD Almond
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
23
|
23
|
-
|
F Angest
|
68
|
20
|
1
|
3
|
34
|
126
|
37
|
The Hon Sir Nigel
Boardman
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
158
|
158
|
121
|
JR Cobb
|
850
|
1,000
|
20
|
35
|
-
|
1,905
|
1,498
|
IA Dewar
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
83
|
83
|
75
|
AA Knight
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
25
|
25
|
-
|
Sir Christopher Meyer
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
25
|
AA Salmon
|
1,350
|
1,500
|
24
|
35
|
-
|
2,909
|
2,465
|
Lord Sassoon
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
23
|
23
|
-
|
Sir Alan Yarrow
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
70
|
70
|
70
|
|
3,468
|
2,520
|
106
|
73
|
416
|
6,583
|
5,569
|
Details of any shares or options
held by directors are presented above.
The emoluments of the Chairman
were £1,261,000 (2022: £1,278,000). The emoluments of the highest
paid director were £2,909,000 (2022: £2,465,000) including pension
contributions of £35,000 (2022: £35,000). The emoluments reported
on the previous page for Ms Knight and in the prior year for Mr. F
Angest are pro-rated from the date they became Directors of the
Company.
Retirement benefits are accruing
under money purchase schemes for three directors who served during
2023 (2022: three directors).
Independent Auditor's Report
Opinion
We have audited the financial
statements of Arbuthnot Banking Group PLC (the 'Parent Company')
and its subsidiaries (the 'Group') for the year ended 31 December
2023 which comprise the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive
Income, the Consolidated Statement of Financial Position, the
Company Statement of Financial Position, the Consolidated Statement
of Changes in Equity, the Company Statement of Changes in Equity,
the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows, the Company Statement of
Cash Flows, and notes to the financial statements, including
material accounting policy information.
The financial reporting framework
that has been applied in their preparation is applicable law and
UK-adopted international accounting standards, and as regards the
Parent Company financial statements, as applied in accordance with
the provisions of the Companies Act 2006.
In our opinion, the financial
statements:
· give
a true and fair view of the state of the Group and of the Parent
Company's affairs as at 31 December 2023 and of the Group's profit
for the year then ended;
· have
been properly prepared in accordance with UK-adopted international
accounting standards and, as regards the Parent Company financial
statements, as applied in accordance with the provisions of the
Companies Act 2006; and
· have
been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies
Act 2006.
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in
accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (ISAs
(UK)) and applicable law. Our responsibilities under those
standards are further described in the "Auditor's responsibilities
for the audit of the financial statements" section of our report.
We are independent of the Group and the Parent Company in
accordance with the ethical requirements that are relevant to our
audit of the financial statements in the UK, including the
Financial Reporting Council's ("FRC") Ethical Standard as applied
to listed entities and we have fulfilled our other ethical
responsibilities in accordance with these requirements. We believe
that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and
appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.
Conclusions relating to going concern
In auditing the financial
statements, we have concluded that the directors' use of the going
concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the financial
statements is appropriate.
Our audit procedures to evaluate
the directors' assessment of the Group and the Parent Company's
ability to continue to adopt the going concern basis of accounting
included but were not limited to:
· Undertaking an initial assessment at the planning stage of
the audit to identify events or conditions that may cast
significant doubt on the Group's and the Parent Company's ability
to continue as a going concern;
· Obtaining an understanding of the relevant controls relating
to the directors' going concern assessment;
· Making enquiries of the directors to understand the period of
assessment considered by them, the assumptions they considered and
the implication of those when assessing the Group's and the Parent
Company's future financial performance;
· Evaluating management's going concern assessment of the Group
and the Parent Company and challenging the appropriateness of the
key assumptions used in and mathematical accuracy of management's
forecasts, including assessing the historical accuracy of
management's forecasting and budgeting;
· Assessing the sufficiency of the Group's capital and
liquidity taking into consideration the most recent Internal
Capital Adequacy Assessment Process ('ICAAP') and Internal
Liquidity Assessment Process ('ILAAP') performed by Arbuthnot
Latham & Co., Ltd, a wholly owned subsidiary within the Group
which is a bank regulated by the Prudential Regulation Authority
('PRA'), and evaluating the results of management's scenarios and
reverse stress testing which includes sensitivity analysis, and
including consideration of principal and emerging risks on
liquidity and regulatory capital;
· Assessing the accuracy of management's forecast through a
review of post year-end performance;
· Evaluating the Group's Resolution and Recovery plans which
includes possible cost saving measures that could be taken in the
event circumstances prevent forecast results from being
achieved;
· Reading regulatory correspondence, minutes of meetings of the
Audit Committee and the Board of Directors, and post balance sheet
events to identify events of conditions that may impact the Group
and the Parent Company's ability to continue as a going
concern;
· Considering the consistency of management's forecasts with
other areas of the financial statements and our audit;
and
· Evaluating the appropriateness of the disclosures in the
financial statements related to going concern.
Based on the work we have
performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties
relating to events or conditions that, individually or
collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group's and the
Parent Company's ability to continue as a going concern for a
period of at least twelve months from when the financial statements
are authorised for issue.
Our responsibilities and the
responsibilities of the directors with respect to going concern are
described in the relevant sections of this report.
In relation to Arbuthnot Banking
Group PLC's reporting on how it has applied the UK Corporate
Governance Code, we have nothing material to add or draw attention
to in relation to the directors' statement in the financial
statements about whether the directors considered it appropriate to
adopt the going concern basis of accounting.
Key Audit Matters
Key audit matters are those
matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most
significance in our audit of the financial statements of the
current period and include the most significant assessed risks of
material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) we identified,
including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit
strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing
the efforts of the engagement team. These matters were addressed in
the context of our audit of the financial statements as a whole,
and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a
separate opinion on these matters.
We summarise below the key audit
matters in forming our opinion above, together with an overview of
the principal audit procedures performed to address each matter and
our key observations arising from those procedures.
These matters, together with our
findings, were communicated to those charged with governance
through our Audit Completion Report.
Key Audit Matter
|
How our scope addressed this matter
|
Allowances for impairment of loans and
advances
Group - £6.8m; 2022: £6.6m (refer
to notes 4, 23 and 24)
The determination of Expected
Credit Loss ('ECL') under IFRS 9 is an inherently judgmental area
due to the use of subjective assumptions and a high degree of
estimation. ECL relating to the Group's loan portfolio requires the
directors to make judgements over the ability of the Groups'
customers to make future loan repayments.
As set out in note 3.4, ECL is
measured using a three-stage model. ECL is determined based on
Probability of Default ('PD') and the present value of future cash
flows arising primarily from the sale of or repossession of
security which determines the Loss Given Default ('LGD') and the
Exposure at Default ('EAD'). For loans with no significant
deterioration in credit risk since origination (stage l), ECL is
determined using collective portfolio assumptions. For loans that
have experienced a significant deterioration in credit risk since
origination (stage 2) or have defaulted (stage 3), key assumptions
are determined on a case-by-case basis.
The model used by the Group to
determine the ECL provision requires judgement to the input
parameters and assumptions, in particular, uncertainty around
macro-economic assumptions.
The most significant areas where
we identified greater levels of management judgement and estimate
are:
• Staging of loans and advances to customers and the
identification of significant increase in credit risk;
• Stage 3 impairment assessments;
• Key LGD assumptions around adjustments to collateral when
estimating the present value of future recoverable cashflows;
and
• Use of macro-economic variables reflecting a range of future
scenarios.
Further detail on the key
judgements and estimates involved are set out within the critical
accounting estimates and judgements in applying accounting policies
(note 4) and in notes 23 and 24 to the financial
statements.
We consider the risk to have
increased in the year given the sustained impact of high interest
rates and inflation, as well as the sustained economic impact of
the rising cost of living on the ECL provision.
|
Our audit procedures included but
were not limited to:
Staging of loans
We have:
• Assessed the methodology of identifying significant increase
in credit risk to ensure compliance with IFRS 9;
• Tested the design and implementation and tested the operating
effectiveness of the key controls in relation to credit monitoring,
including missed payments monitoring, covenants monitoring and
annual reviews;
• Tested management's controls to allocate loans to the
respective staging categories;
• Tested the appropriateness of staging movements throughout
the year;
• Back tested the staging criteria to assess previous
effectiveness of the criteria; and
• Assessed loans that have cured during the year, including
ensuring the curing is in line with policy and IFRS 9.
Stage 3 impairment assessments
We have:
• Performed credit file reviews to test data used in the
determination of LGD assumptions;
• Re-calculated the ECL provision for a sample of higher risk
loans, including consideration of multiple economic scenarios;
and
• Involved our in-house valuation specialist to independently
assess the underlying collateral used in the ECL calculations for a
sample of higher risk loans. However, in some cases, we relied on
management's external valuation experts with indexing applied and,
in this situation, we assessed the capabilities, professional
competence, and objectivity of the experts.
Key LGD assumptions
We have:
• Tested and challenged the key assumptions applied to LGD;
and
• Back tested key assumptions to assess
appropriateness.
Use of macro-economic variables
We have:
• Involved our in-house credit risk specialists and economist
experts in the assessment of model approach and assumptions,
including assessing the impact on commercial and residential
property prices, the completeness and appropriateness of key
economic variables and the appropriateness of the economic
scenarios and the probability weightings applied by
management.
Stand back assessment
We have:
• Performed a stand back analysis to assess the overall
adequacy of the ECL coverage. In performing this procedure, we
considered the credit quality of the portfolio and performed
benchmarking across similar banks considering both staging
percentages and provision coverage ratios.
Disclosures
We have assessed the adequacy and
appropriateness of the disclosures in the financial statements in
relation to ECL.
Our observations
We found the approach taken in
respect to ECL is materially in accordance with the requirements of
IFRS 9 and determined that the allowance for impairment of loans
and advances is not materially misstated at 31 December
2023.
|
Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope
of our audit
The scope of our audit was
influenced by our application of materiality. We set certain
quantitative thresholds for materiality. These, together with
qualitative considerations, helped us to determine the scope of our
audit and the nature, timing and extent of our audit procedures on
the individual financial statement line items and disclosures and
in evaluating the effect of misstatements, both individually and on
the financial statements as a whole. Based on our professional
judgement, we determined materiality for the financial statements
as a whole as follows:
Group materiality
Overall materiality
|
£2.4m (2022: £1.0m)
|
How we determined it
|
5% of profit before tax (2022:
0.5% of net assets but capped at component materiality
levels)
|
Rationale for benchmark
applied
|
Our materiality benchmark for the
Group has changed during the year from net assets to profit before
tax. We consider profit before tax to be the appropriate benchmark
as the Group's profits have now established a track record
following the pandemic and the low interest rate environment, and
profit is increasingly a key focus for the users of the financial
statements in assessing the performance of the Group.
|
Performance materiality
|
Performance materiality is set to
reduce, to an appropriately low level, the probability that the
aggregate of uncorrected and undetected misstatements in the
financial statements exceeds materiality for the financial
statements as a whole.
We set performance materiality at
£1.6m (2022: £0.7m), which represents 70% of overall materiality
(2022: 70%).
In determining the performance
materiality, we considered a number of factors, including the level
and nature of uncorrected and corrected misstatements in the prior
year and the robustness of the control environment, and concluded
that an amount toward the upper end of our normal range was
appropriate.
|
Reporting threshold
|
We agreed with the directors that
we would report to them misstatements identified during our audit
above £71k (2022: £30k) as well as misstatements below that amount
that, in our view, warranted reporting for qualitative
reasons.
|
Parent company materiality
Overall materiality
|
£0.8m (2022: £0.2m)
|
How we determined it
|
0.5% of net assets (2022: 0.5% of
net assets but capped at component materiality levels).
|
Rationale for benchmark
applied
|
Given that the Parent Company's
primary purpose is to be an investment holding entity, we consider
net assets to be the most appropriate benchmark to apply in our
determination of materiality. The Parent Company does not have
significant revenue generating activities and therefore a
profit-based measure was not considered to be
appropriate.
|
Performance materiality
|
Performance materiality is set to
reduce, to an appropriately low level, the probability that the
aggregate of uncorrected and undetected misstatements in the
financial statements exceeds materiality for the financial
statements as a whole.
We set performance materiality at
£0.6m (2022: £0.1m), which represents 70% of overall materiality
(2022: 70%).
In determining the performance
materiality, we considered a number of factors, including the level
and nature of uncorrected and corrected misstatements in the prior
year and the robustness of the control environment, and concluded
that an amount toward the upper end of our normal range was
appropriate.
|
Reporting threshold
|
We agreed with the directors that
we would report to them misstatements identified during our audit
above £24k (2022: £6k) as well as misstatements below that amount
that, in our view, warranted reporting for qualitative
reasons.
|
As part of designing our audit, we
assessed the risk of material misstatement in the financial
statements, whether due to fraud or error, and then designed and
performed audit procedures responsive to those risks. In
particular, we looked at where the directors made subjective
judgements, such as assumptions on significant accounting
estimates.
We tailored the scope of our audit
to ensure that we performed sufficient work to be able to give an
opinion on the financial statements as a whole. We used the outputs
of our risk assessment, our understanding of the Group and the
Parent Company, their environment, controls and critical business
processes, to consider qualitative factors in order to ensure that
we obtained sufficient coverage across all financial statement line
items.
Our Group audit scope included an
audit of the Group and the Parent Company financial statements.
Based on our risk assessment, six components of the Group,
including the Parent Company, were subject to full scope audit. We
used a Mazars UK component audit team as component auditor for one
component (2022: one component). All other components were audited
by the Group audit team.
Our component performance
materiality ranged from £0.05m to £1.5m (2022: £0.02m to £0.7m).
Full scope audits carried out on six components (2022: eight
components), including the Parent Company, account for 99.5% of
interest income (2022: 100%), 97.3% of profit before tax (2022:
100%), 99.1% of net assets (2022: 100%) and 99.8% of total assets
(2022: 100%).
At the Parent Company level, the
Group audit team also tested the consolidation process and carried
out analytical procedures to confirm our conclusion that there were
no significant risks of material misstatement of the aggregated
financial information.
Working with our component audit team
We determined the level of
involvement we needed as the Group team in the work of the
component audit team to be able to conclude whether sufficient and
appropriate audit evidence was obtained to provide a basis for our
opinion on the Group financial statements as a whole. We maintained
oversight of the component audit team, directing and supervising
their activities related to our audit of the Group. The Group team
maintained frequent communications to monitor progress. The Senior
Statutory Auditor and senior members of the Group team attended
component meetings, which were held via video conference. We issued
instructions to our component audit team and interacted with them
throughout the audit process. In the absence of component visits,
we reviewed electronic work papers remotely which were prepared by
the component audit team and held meetings with component
management.
Other information
The other information comprises
the information included in the annual report other than the
financial statements and our auditor's report thereon. The
directors are responsible for the other information. Our opinion on
the financial statements does not cover the other information and,
except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in our report, we
do not express any form of assurance conclusion thereon.
Our responsibility is to read the
other information and, in doing so, consider whether the other
information is materially inconsistent with the financial
statements or our knowledge obtained in the course of audit or
otherwise appears to be materially misstated. If we identify such
material inconsistencies or apparent material misstatements, we are
required to determine whether this gives rise to a material
misstatement in the financial statements themselves. If, based on
the work we have performed, we conclude that there is a material
misstatement of this other information, we are required to report
that fact.
We have nothing to report in this
regard.
Opinions on other matters prescribed by the Companies Act
2006
In our opinion, the part of the
directors' remuneration report to be audited has been properly
prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006.
In our opinion, based on the work
undertaken in the course of the audit:
· the
information given in the strategic report and the directors' report
for the financial year for which the financial statements are
prepared is consistent with the financial statements;
and
· the
strategic report and the directors' report have been prepared in
accordance with applicable legal requirements.
Matters on which we are required to report by
exception
In light of the knowledge and
understanding of the Group and the Parent Company and their
environment obtained in the course of the audit, we have not
identified material misstatements in the strategic report or the
directors' report.
We have nothing to report in
respect of the following matters in relation to which the Companies
Act 2006 requires us to report to you if, in our
opinion:
· adequate accounting records have not been kept by the Parent
Company, or returns adequate for our audit have not been received
from branches not visited by us; or
· the
Parent Company financial statements and the part of the directors'
remuneration report to be audited are not in agreement with the
accounting records and returns; or
· certain disclosures of directors' remuneration specified by
law are not made; or
· we
have not received all the information and explanations we require
for our audit.
Corporate governance statement
We have reviewed the directors'
statement in relation to going concern, longer term viability and
that part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating to the
Group and the Parent Company's voluntary compliance with the
provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code.
Based on the work undertaken as
part of our audit, we have concluded that each of the following
elements of the Corporate Governance Statement is materially
consistent with the financial statements or our knowledge obtained
during the audit:
· Directors' statement with regards the appropriateness of
adopting the going concern basis of accounting and any material
uncertainties identified, set out on pages 42 and 43;
· Directors' explanation as to its assessment of the entity's
prospects, the period this assessment covers and why they period is
appropriate, set out on page 42;
· Directors' statement on fair, balanced and understandable,
set out on page 46;
· Board's confirmation that it has carried out a robust
assessment of the emerging and principal risks, set out on page
50;
· The
section of the annual report that describes the review of
effectiveness of risk management and internal control systems, set
out on pages 49 and 50; and;
· The
section describing the work of the audit committee, set out on
pages 50 to 52.
Responsibilities of Directors
As explained more fully in the
'Statement of Directors' Responsibilities in Respect of the
Strategic Report and the Directors' Report and the Financial
Statements' set out on page 46, the directors are responsible for
the preparation of the financial statements and for being satisfied
that they give a true and fair view, and for such internal control
as the directors determine is necessary to enable the preparation
of financial statements that are free from material misstatement,
whether due to fraud or error.
In preparing the financial
statements, the directors are responsible for assessing the Group's
and the Parent Company's ability to continue as a going concern,
disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern and
using the going concern basis of accounting unless the directors
either intend to liquidate the Group or the Parent Company or to
cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do
so.
Auditor's responsibilities for the audit of the financial
statements
Our objectives are to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a
whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or
error, and to issue an auditor's report that includes our opinion.
Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance but is not a
guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will
always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements
can arise from fraud or error and are considered material if,
individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected
to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of
these financial statements.
The extent to which our procedures
are capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud is
detailed below.
Irregularities, including fraud,
are instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations. We
design procedures in line with our responsibilities, outlined
above, to detect material misstatements in respect of
irregularities, including fraud.
Based on our understanding of the
Group and the Parent Company and their industry, we considered that
non-compliance with the following laws and regulations might have a
material effect on the financial statements: regulations and
supervisory requirements of the PRA and the Financial Conduct
Authority ('FCA'), Alternative Investment Market ('AIM') rules,
Aquis Stock Exchange ('AQSE') rules, Streamlined Energy and Carbon
Reporting ('SECR') requirements, Anti Money Laundering regulations
('AML'), General Data Protection Regulation ('GDPR') and the UK
Corporate Governance Code.
To help us identify instances of
non-compliance with these laws and regulations, and in identifying
and assessing the risks of material misstatement in respect to
non-compliance, our procedures included, but were not limited
to:
· Gaining an understanding of the legal and regulatory
framework applicable to the Group and the Parent Company, the
industry in which they operate, and the structure of the Group, and
considering the risk of acts by the Group and the Parent Company
which were contrary to the applicable laws and regulations,
including fraud;
· Inquiring of the directors, management and, where
appropriate, those charged with governance, as to whether the Group
and the Parent Company is in compliance with laws and regulations,
and discussing their policies and procedures regarding compliance
with laws and regulations;
· Inspecting correspondence with relevant licensing or
regulatory authorities including the PRA and FCA;
· Review of minutes of meetings of the Board of Directors and
the Audit Committee held during the year and up until the date of
approval of the financial statements;
· Discussing amongst the engagement team the laws and
regulations listed above, and remaining alert to any indications of
non-compliance; and
· Focusing on areas of laws and regulations that could
reasonably be expected to have a material effect on the financial
statements from our general commercial and sector experience and
through discussions with those charged with governance and senior
management, review of regulatory and legal correspondence, and
review of minutes of meetings of the Board of Directors and the
Audit Committee during the year and up until the date of the
approval of the financial statements.
We also considered those laws and
regulations that have a direct effect on the preparation of the
financial statements, such as UK tax legislation, pension
legislation and the Companies Act 2006.
In addition, we evaluated the
directors' and management's incentives and opportunities for
fraudulent manipulation of the financial statements, including the
risk of management override of controls, and determined that the
principal risks related to posting manual journal entries to
manipulate financial performance, management bias through
judgements and assumptions in significant accounting estimates, and
significant one-off or unusual transactions.
Our procedures in relation to
fraud included but were not limited to:
· Making enquiries of the Directors and management on whether
they had knowledge of any actual, suspected or alleged
fraud;
· Gaining an understanding of the internal controls established
to mitigate risks related to fraud;
· Discussing amongst the engagement team the risks of
fraud;
· Addressing the risks of fraud through management override of
controls by performing journal entry testing on a sample basis;
and
· Being sceptical to the potential of management bias through
judgements and assumptions in significant accounting
estimates.
The primary responsibility for the
prevention and detection of irregularities, including fraud, rests
with both those charged with governance and management. As with any
audit, there remained a risk of non-detection of irregularities, as
these may involve collusion, forgery, intentional omissions,
misrepresentations or the override of internal controls.
The risks of material misstatement
that had the greatest effect on our audit are discussed in the "Key
Audit Matters" section of this report.
A further description of our
responsibilities is available on the FRC's website at
www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities.
This description forms part of our auditor's report.
Other matters which we are required to
address
Following the recommendation of
the Audit Committee, we were appointed by the Board of Directors on
6 December 2019 to audit the financial statements for the year
ended 31 December 2019 and subsequent financial periods. The period
of total uninterrupted engagement is five years, covering the years
ended 31 December 2019 to 31 December 2023.
The non-audit services prohibited
by the FRC's Ethical Standard were not provided to the Group or the
Parent Company and we remain independent of the Group and the
Parent Company in conducting our audit.
Our audit opinion is consistent
with our additional report to the Audit Committee.
Use of the audit report
This report is made solely to the
Company's members as a body in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16
of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been undertaken so
that we might state to the Company's members those matters we are
required to state to them in an auditor's report and for no other
purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept
or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the
Company's members as a body for our audit work, for this report, or
for the opinions we have formed.
Greg Simpson (Senior Statutory
Auditor)
for and on behalf of Mazars LLP
Chartered Accountants and Statutory Auditor
30 Old Bailey
London
EC4M 7AU
27 March 2024
Company statement of financial position
|
|
|
At 31
December
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
Note
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
18
|
|
623
|
8,434
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
19
|
|
38,129
|
24,437
|
Deferred tax asset
|
27
|
|
520
|
523
|
Intangible assets
|
28
|
|
-
|
1
|
Property, plant and
equipment
|
29
|
|
130
|
130
|
Other assets
|
25
|
|
1,449
|
74
|
Interests in
subsidiaries
|
44
|
|
164,354
|
159,354
|
Total assets
|
|
|
205,205
|
192,953
|
EQUITY AND LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Equity
|
|
|
|
|
Share capital
|
38
|
|
167
|
154
|
Share premium account
|
38
|
|
11,606
|
-
|
Other reserves
|
39
|
|
(1,280)
|
(1,280)
|
Retained earnings*
|
39
|
|
148,809
|
152,115
|
Total equity
|
|
|
159,302
|
150,989
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Current tax liability
|
|
|
2,641
|
879
|
Other liabilities
|
34
|
|
5,536
|
3,491
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
36
|
|
37,726
|
37,594
|
Total liabilities
|
|
|
45,903
|
41,964
|
Total equity and liabilities
|
|
|
205,205
|
192,953
|
|
|
|
|
|
*The Company has elected to take
the exemption under section 408 of the Companies Act 2006 not to
present the Parent Company profit and loss account. The Parent
Company recorded a profit after tax for the year of £3,551k (2022:
£4,446k).
|
Consolidated statement of changes in equity
|
Attributable to equity holders of the Group
|
|
|
Share
capital
|
Share
premium
|
Capital
redemption reserve
|
Fair
value reserve
|
Treasury
shares
|
Retained
earnings
|
Total
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Balance at 31 December 2022
|
154
|
-
|
19
|
1,067
|
(1,299)
|
212,037
|
211,978
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit for 2023
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
35,379
|
35,379
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in fair value of equity
investments at fair value through other comprehensive income
(FVOCI)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
412
|
-
|
-
|
412
|
Sale of financial assets carried
at FVOCI
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(47)
|
-
|
47
|
-
|
Tax on other comprehensive
income
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(91)
|
-
|
-
|
(91)
|
Total other comprehensive income
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
274
|
-
|
47
|
321
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
274
|
-
|
35,426
|
35,700
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transactions with owners, recorded directly in
equity
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issue of new ordinary
shares
|
13
|
11,606
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
11,619
|
Final dividend relating to
2022
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3,756)
|
(3,756)
|
Interim dividend relating to
2023
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3,101)
|
(3,101)
|
Total contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
13
|
11,606
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(6,857)
|
4,762
|
Balance at 31 December 2023
|
167
|
11,606
|
19
|
1,341
|
(1,299)
|
240,606
|
252,440
|
|
|
|
Attributable to equity holders of the Group
|
|
|
Share
capital
|
Capital
redemption reserve
|
Fair
value reserve
|
Treasury
shares
|
Retained
earnings
|
Total
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Balance at 31 December 2021
|
154
|
19
|
979
|
(1,299)
|
201,026
|
200,879
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit for 2022
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
16,458
|
16,458
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in fair value of equity
investments at fair value
through other comprehensive income
(FVOCI)
|
-
|
-
|
628
|
-
|
-
|
628
|
Sale of financial assets carried
at FVOCI
|
|
|
(412)
|
|
412
|
|
Tax on other comprehensive
income
|
-
|
-
|
(128)
|
-
|
-
|
(128)
|
Total other comprehensive income
|
-
|
-
|
88
|
-
|
412
|
500
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
-
|
-
|
88
|
-
|
16,870
|
16,958
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transactions with owners, recorded directly in
equity
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Special dividend relating to
2021
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3,305)
|
(3,305)
|
Interim dividend relating to
2022
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(2,554)
|
(2,554)
|
Total contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(5,859)
|
(5,859)
|
Balance at 31 December 2022
|
154
|
19
|
1,067
|
(1,299)
|
212,037
|
211,978
|
Company statement of changes in equity
|
Attributable to equity holders of the Company
|
|
|
Share
capital
|
Share
premium
|
Capital
redemption reserve
|
Fair
value reserve
|
Treasury
shares
|
Retained
earnings
|
Total
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Balance at 1 January 2022
|
154
|
-
|
19
|
-
|
(1,299)
|
153,528
|
152,402
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit for 2022
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
4,446
|
4,446
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other comprehensive income, net of income
tax
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
4,446
|
4,446
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transactions with owners, recorded directly in
equity
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Final dividend relating to
2021
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3,305)
|
(3,305)
|
Interim dividend relating to
2022
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(2,554)
|
(2,554)
|
Total contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(5,859)
|
(5,859)
|
Balance at 31 December 2022
|
154
|
-
|
19
|
-
|
(1,299)
|
152,115
|
150,989
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit for 2023
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,551
|
3,551
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other comprehensive income, net of income
tax
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the period
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,551
|
3,551
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transactions with owners, recorded directly in
equity
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issue of new ordinary
shares
|
13
|
11,606
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
11,619
|
Final dividend relating to
2022
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3,756)
|
(3,756)
|
Interim dividend relating to
2023
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3,101)
|
(3,101)
|
Total contributions by and distributions to
owners
|
13
|
11,606
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(6,857)
|
4,762
|
Balance at 31 December 2023
|
167
|
11,606
|
19
|
-
|
(1,299)
|
148,809
|
159,302
|
|
Consolidated statement of cash flows
|
|
|
Year
ended 31 December
|
Year
ended 31 December
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
Note
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cash flows from operating activities
|
|
|
|
|
Profit before tax
|
|
|
47,117
|
20,009
|
Adjustments for:
|
|
|
|
|
- Depreciation and
amortisation
|
29,28,30
|
|
9,819
|
7,193
|
- Impairment loss on loans and
advances
|
24
|
|
208
|
214
|
- Net interest expense
|
|
|
564
|
80
|
- Elimination of exchange
differences on debt securities
|
|
|
8,712
|
(8,783)
|
- Other non-cash or non-operating
items included in profit before tax
|
|
|
155
|
163
|
- Tax expense
|
|
|
(11,738)
|
(3,551)
|
Cash flows from operating profits
before changes in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
54,837
|
15,325
|
Changes in operating assets and
liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
- net decrease/(increase) in
derivative financial instruments
|
|
|
3,005
|
(4,605)
|
- net increase in loans and
advances to customers
|
|
|
(28,347)
|
(165,328)
|
- net increase in assets
held for leasing
|
|
|
(95,853)
|
(50,175)
|
- net (increase)/decrease in
other assets
|
|
|
(1,176)
|
57,563
|
- net increase in amounts
due to customers
|
|
|
667,018
|
254,680
|
- net increase in other
liabilities
|
|
|
18,013
|
6,323
|
Net cash inflow from operating activities
|
|
|
617,497
|
113,783
|
Cash flows from investing activities
|
|
|
|
|
Acquisition of financial
investments
|
|
|
(174)
|
(53)
|
Disposal of financial
investments
|
|
|
63
|
640
|
Purchase of intangible
assets
|
28
|
|
(1,523)
|
(6,174)
|
Purchase of property, plant and
equipment
|
29
|
|
(4,846)
|
(1,065)
|
Proceeds from sale of property,
plant and equipment
|
29
|
|
5
|
50
|
Purchase of debt
securities
|
|
|
(1,582,889)
|
(799,341)
|
Proceeds from redemption of debt
securities
|
|
|
1,071,232
|
670,164
|
Net cash outflow from investing activities
|
|
|
(518,132)
|
(135,779)
|
Cash flows from financing activities
|
|
|
|
|
Issue of new ordinary
shares
|
|
|
11,619
|
-
|
Decrease in borrowings
|
|
|
(43,049)
|
(4,306)
|
Lease payments
|
|
|
(3,654)
|
(7,458)
|
Dividends paid
|
|
|
(6,857)
|
(5,860)
|
Net cash outflow from financing activities
|
|
|
(41,941)
|
(17,624)
|
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash
equivalents
|
|
|
57,424
|
(39,620)
|
Cash and cash equivalents at 1
January
|
|
|
848,516
|
888,136
|
Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December
|
42
|
|
905,940
|
848,516
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Company statement of cash flows
|
|
|
Year
ended 31 December
|
Year
ended 31 December
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
Note
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cash flows from operating activities
|
|
|
|
|
Profit before tax
|
|
|
6,856
|
5,850
|
Adjustments for:
|
|
|
|
|
- Depreciation and
amortisation
|
28,
29
|
|
1
|
10
|
- Net interest (income) /
expense
|
|
|
(523)
|
80
|
- Elimination of exchange
differences on debt securities
|
|
|
(170)
|
741
|
- Other non-cash or non-operating
items included in profit before tax
|
|
|
84
|
(71)
|
- Tax expense
|
|
|
(3,305)
|
(1,404)
|
Cash flows from operating profits
before changes in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
2,943
|
5,206
|
Changes in operating assets and
liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
- net increase in group
company balances
|
|
|
(93)
|
(1,013)
|
- net (increase)/decrease in
other assets
|
|
|
(1,372)
|
221
|
- net increase in other
liabilities
|
|
|
3,900
|
2,242
|
Net cash inflow from operating activities
|
|
|
5,378
|
6,656
|
Cash flows from investing activities
|
|
|
|
|
Issue of subordinated debt to
Arbuthnot Latham
|
|
|
(12,951)
|
-
|
Receipt on dissolution of People's
Trust & Savings PLC
|
|
|
-
|
50
|
Capital contribution to Arbuthnot
Latham
|
|
|
(5,000)
|
-
|
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from investing
activities
|
|
|
(17,951)
|
50
|
Cash flows from financing activities
|
|
|
|
|
Issue of new shares
|
|
|
11,619
|
-
|
Dividends paid
|
|
|
(6,857)
|
(5,859)
|
Net cash used in financing activities
|
|
|
4,762
|
(5,859)
|
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash
equivalents
|
|
|
(7,811)
|
847
|
Cash and cash equivalents at 1
January
|
|
|
8,434
|
7,587
|
Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December
|
42
|
|
623
|
8,434
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes to the Consolidated Financial
Statements
1. Reporting entity
Arbuthnot Banking Group PLC is a
company domiciled in the United Kingdom. The registered address of
Arbuthnot Banking Group PLC is 7 Wilson Street, London, EC2M 2SN.
The consolidated financial statements of Arbuthnot Banking Group
PLC as at and for the year ended 31 December 2023 comprise
Arbuthnot Banking Group PLC and its subsidiaries (together referred
to as the "Group" and individually as "subsidiaries"). The Company
is the holding company of a group primarily involved in banking and
financial services.
2. Basis of preparation
(a) Statement of compliance
The Group's consolidated financial
statements and the Company's financial statements have been
prepared in accordance with UK-adopted international accounting
standards in conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act
2006.
The consolidated financial
statements were authorised for issue by the Board of Directors on
27 March 2024.
(b) Basis of measurement
The consolidated and company
financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost
convention, as modified by investment property and derivatives,
financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value through
profit or loss or other comprehensive income.
(c) Functional and presentational currency
Items included in the financial
statements of each of the Group's entities are measured using the
currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity
operates ("the functional currency"). The consolidated financial
statements are presented in Pounds Sterling, which is the Company's
functional and the Group's presentational currency.
(d) Use of estimates and judgements
The preparation of financial
statements in conformity with IFRS requires the use of certain
critical accounting estimates. It also requires management to
exercise its judgement in the process of applying the Group's
accounting policies. The areas involving a higher degree of
judgement or complexity, or areas where assumptions and estimates
are significant to the consolidated financial statements are
disclosed in Note 4.
(e) Going concern
After making appropriate enquiries
which assessed strategy, profitability, funding, risk management
(see Note 6), capital resources (see Note 7) and the potential impact of
climate-related risks, the directors are satisfied that the Company
and the Group have adequate resources to continue as a going
concern for a period of at least twelve months from when the
financial statements are authorised for issue. The Audit Committee
reviewed management's assessment, which incorporated analysis of
the ICAAP and ILAAP approved by the Board of AL and of relevant
metrics, focusing on liquidity, capital, and the stress scenarios.
It is satisfied that the going concern basis and assessment of the
Group's longer-term viability is appropriate. The financial
statements are therefore prepared on the going concern
basis.
(f) Accounting developments
The accounting policies adopted
are consistent with those of the previous financial
year.
3. Material accounting policies
The accounting policies applied in
the preparation of these consolidated financial statements are set
out below. These policies have been consistently applied to all the
years presented, unless otherwise stated.
3.1. Consolidation
(a) Subsidiaries
Subsidiaries are all investees
(including special purpose entities) controlled by the Group. The
Group controls an investee when it is exposed, or has rights, to
variable returns from its involvement with the investee and has the
ability to affect those returns through its power over the
investee. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date on
which control is transferred to the Group. They are de-consolidated
from the date that control ceases.
The acquisition method of
accounting is used to account for the acquisition of subsidiaries
by the Group. The cost of an acquisition is measured as the fair
value of the assets given, equity instruments issued and
liabilities incurred or assumed at the date of exchange.
Identifiable assets acquired, liabilities and contingent
liabilities assumed in a business combination are measured
initially at their fair values at the acquisition date,
irrespective of the extent of any non-controlling interest. The
excess of the cost of acquisition over the fair value of the
Group's shares of the identifiable net assets acquired is recorded
as goodwill. If the cost of acquisition is less than the fair value
of the net assets of the subsidiary acquired, the difference is
recognised directly in the Statement of Comprehensive Income as a
gain on bargain purchase. Contingent consideration related to an
acquisition is initially recognised at the date of acquisition as
part of the consideration transferred, measured at its acquisition
date fair value and recognised as a liability. The fair value of a
contingent consideration liability recognised on acquisition is
remeasured at key reporting dates until it is settled, changes in
fair value are recognised in the profit or loss.
The Company's investments in
subsidiaries are recorded at cost less, where appropriate,
provisions for impairment in value.
Inter-company transactions,
balances and unrealised gains on transactions between Group
companies are eliminated. Unrealised losses are also eliminated.
Accounting policies of subsidiaries have been changed where
necessary to ensure consistency with the policies adopted by the
Group.
(b) Special purpose entities
Special purpose entities ("SPEs")
are entities that are created to accomplish a narrow and
well-defined objective such as the securitisation of particular
assets or the execution of a specific borrowing or lending
transaction. SPEs are consolidated when the investor controls the
investee. The investor would only control the investee if it had
all of the following:
•
power over the investee;
•
exposure, or rights, to variable returns from its involvement with
the investee; and
•
the ability to use its power over the investee to affect the amount
of the investor's returns.
The assessment of whether the
Group has control over an SPE is carried out at inception and the
initial assessment is only reconsidered at a later date if there
were any changes to the structure or terms of the SPE, or there
were additional transactions between the Group and the
SPE.
3.2. Foreign currency translation
Foreign currency transactions are
translated into the functional currency using the spot exchange
rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions or valuation
where items are remeasured. Foreign exchange gains and losses
resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the
translation at year end exchange rates of monetary assets and
liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognised in the
Statement of Comprehensive Income. Foreign exchange differences
arising from translation of equity instruments, where an election
has been made to present subsequent fair value changes in Other
Comprehensive Income ("OCI"), will also be recognised in
OCI.
3.3. Financial assets and financial
liabilities
IFRS 9 requires financial assets
and liabilities to be measured at amortised cost, fair value
through other comprehensive income ("FVOCI") or fair value through
the profit and loss ("FVPL"). Liabilities are measured at amortised
cost or FVPL. The Group classifies financial assets and financial
liabilities in the following categories: financial assets and
financial liabilities at FVPL; FVOCI, financial assets and
liabilities at amortised cost and other financial liabilities.
Management determines the classification of its financial
instruments at initial recognition.
A financial asset or financial
liability is measured initially at fair value plus, transaction
costs that are directly attributable to its acquisition or issue
with the exception of financial assets at FVPL where these costs
are debited to the income statement.
(a) Financial assets measured at amortised
cost
Financial assets that are held to
collect contractual cash flows where those cash flows represent
solely payments of principal and interest are measured at amortised
cost. A basic lending arrangement results in contractual cash flows
that are solely payments of principal and interest ("SPPI") on the
principal amount outstanding. Financial assets measured at
amortised cost are predominantly loans and advances and debt
securities.
Loans and advances
Loans and advances are
non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments
that are not quoted in an active market. They arise when the Group
provides money, goods or services directly to a debtor with no
intention of trading the receivable and the SPPI criteria are met.
Loans are recognised when cash is advanced to the borrowers
inclusive of transaction costs. Loans and advances, other than
those relating to assets leased to customers, are carried at
amortised cost using the effective interest rate method.
Debt securities at amortised cost
Debt securities at amortised cost
are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable
payments and fixed maturities that the Group has determined meets
the SPPI criteria. Certain debt securities are held by the Group
Central Treasury in a separate portfolio for long-term yield. These
securities may be sold, but such sales are not expected to be more
than infrequent. The Group considers that these securities are held
within a business model whose objective is to hold assets to
collect the contractual cash flows. Debt security investments are
carried at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method,
less any impairment loss.
(b) Financial assets and financial liabilities at
FVPL
Financial assets and liabilities
are classified at FVPL where they do not meet the criteria to be
measured at amortised cost or FVOCI or where financial assets are
designated at FVPL to reduce an accounting mismatch. They are
measured at fair value in the statement of financial position, with
fair value gains/losses recognised in the income
statement.
Financial assets that are held for
trading or managed within a business model that is evaluated on a
fair value basis are measured at FVPL, because the business
objective is neither hold-to-collect contractual cash flows nor
hold-to-collect-and-sell contractual cash flows.
This category comprises derivative
financial instruments and financial investments. Derivative
financial instruments utilised by the Group include structured
notes and derivatives used for hedging purposes.
Financial assets and liabilities
at FVPL are initially recognised on the date from which the Group
becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument,
including any acquisition costs. Subsequent measurement of
financial assets and financial liabilities held in this category
are carried at FVPL until the investment is sold.
(c) Financial assets at FVOCI
These include investments in
special purpose vehicles and equity investments. They may be sold
in response to liquidity requirements, interest rate, exchange rate
or equity price movements. Financial investments are initially
recognised at cost, which is considered as the fair value of the
investment including any acquisition costs. The securities are
subsequently measured at fair value in the statement of financial
position.
Fair value changes in the
securities are recognised directly in equity (OCI).
There is a rebuttable presumption
that all equity investments are FVPL, however on initial
recognition the Group may make an irrevocable election to present
the fair value movement of equity investments that are not held for
trading within OCI. The election can be made on an instrument by
instrument basis.
For equity instruments, there are
no reclassifications of gains and losses to the profit or loss
statement on derecognition and no impairment recognised in the
profit or loss. Equity fair value movements are not reclassified
from OCI under any circumstances.
(d) Financial guarantees and loan
commitments
Financial guarantees represent
undertakings that the Group will meet a customer's obligation to
third parties if the customer fails to do so. Commitments to extend
credit represent unused portions of authorisations to extend credit
in the form of loans, guarantees or letters of credit. The Group is
exposed to loss in an amount equal to the total guarantees or
unused commitments, however, the likely amount of loss is expected
to be significantly less; most commitments to extend credit are
contingent upon customers maintaining specific credit standards,
where the amount of loss exceeds the total unused commitments an
ECL is recognised. Liabilities under financial guarantee contracts
are initially recorded at their fair value, and the initial fair
value is amortised over the life of the financial guarantee.
Subsequently, the financial guarantee liabilities are measured at
the higher of the initial fair value, less cumulative amortisation,
and the ECL of the obligations.
(e) Financial liabilities at amortised cost
Financial liabilities at amortised
cost are non-derivative financial liabilities with fixed or
determinable payments. These liabilities are recognised when cash
is received from the depositors and carried at amortised cost using
the effective interest rate method. The fair value of these
liabilities repayable on demand is assumed to be the amount payable
on demand at the Statement of Financial Position date.
Basis of measurement for financial assets and
liabilities
Amortised cost measurement
The amortised cost of a financial
asset or financial liability is the amount at which the financial
asset or financial liability is measured at initial recognition,
minus principal payments, plus or minus the cumulative amortisation
using the effective interest rate method of any difference between
the initial amount recognised and the maturity amount, less any
reduction for impairment.
Fair value measurement
Fair value is the price that would
be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an
orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement
date.
When available, the Group measures
the fair value of an instrument using quoted prices in an active
market for that instrument. A market is regarded as active if
quoted prices are readily and regularly available and represent
actual and regularly occurring market transactions on an arm's
length basis.
If a market for a financial
instrument is not active, the Group establishes fair value using a
valuation technique. These include the use of recent arm's length
transactions, reference to other instruments that are substantially
the same for which market observable prices exist, net present
value and discounted cash flow analysis.
Derecognition
Financial assets are derecognised
when the rights to receive cash flows from the financial assets
have expired or when the Group has transferred substantially all
risks and rewards of ownership. Any interest in transferred
financial assets that qualify for derecognition that is created or
retained by the Group is recognised as a separate asset or
liability in the Statement of Financial Position. In transactions
in which the Group neither retains nor transfers substantially all
the risks and rewards of ownership of a financial asset and it
retains control over the asset, the Group continues to recognise
the asset to the extent of its continuing involvement, determined
by the extent to which it is exposed to changes in the value of the
transferred asset. There have not been any instances where assets
have only been partially derecognised.
The Group derecognises a financial
liability when its contractual obligations are discharged,
cancelled, expire, are modified or exchanged.
Offsetting
Financial assets and financial
liabilities are offset and the net amount presented in the
statement of financial position when, and only when, the Group
currently has a legally enforceable right to set off the amounts
and it intends either to settle them on a net basis or to realise
the asset and settle the liability simultaneously.
Income and expenses are presented
on a net basis only when permitted under IFRS, or for gains and
losses arising from a group of similar transactions such as the
Group's trading activity.
Modification of financial assets
If the terms of financial assets
are modified, then the Group evaluates whether the cash flow of the
modified asset are substantially different.
If the cash flows are
substantially different, then the contractual rights to cash flows
from the original financial asset are deemed to have expired. In
this case, the original financial asset is derecognised and a new
financial asset is recognised at fair value plus any eligible
transaction costs. Any fees received as part of the modification
are accounted as follows:
•
fees that are considered in determining the fair value of the new
asset and fees that represent reimbursement of eligible transaction
costs are included in the initial measurement of the asset;
and
•
other fees are included in profit or loss as part of gain or loss
on derecognition.
3.4 Impairment for financial assets at amortised cost and
lease receivables
IFRS 9 impairment model adopts a
three stage expected credit loss approach ("ECL") based on the
extent of credit deterioration since origination.
The three stages under IFRS 9 are as
follows:
•
Stage 1 - if, at the reporting date, the credit risk on a financial
instrument has not increased significantly since initial
recognition, an entity shall measure the loss allowance for that
financial instrument at an amount equal to 12-month expected credit
losses.
•
Stage 2 - a lifetime loss allowance is held for financial assets
where a significant increase in credit risk has been identified
since initial recognition for financial assets that are not credit
impaired. The assessment of whether credit risk has increased
significantly since initial recognition is performed for each
reporting period for the life of the loan.
•
Stage 3 - a lifetime ECL allowance is required for financial assets
that are credit impaired at the reporting date.
Measurement of ECL
The assessment of credit risk and
the estimation of ECL are unbiased and probability weighted. ECL is
measured on either a 12 month (Stage 1) or lifetime (Stage 2) basis
depending on whether a significant increase in credit risk has
occurred since initial recognition or where an account meets the
Group's definition of default (Stage 3).
The ECL calculation is a product
of an individual loan's probability of default ('PD'), exposure at
default ('EAD') and loss given default ('LGD') discounted at the
effective interest rate ('EIR').
Significant increase in credit risk ("SICR") (movement to
Stage 2)
The Group's transfer criteria
determines what constitutes a significant increase in credit risk,
which results in a financial asset being moved from Stage 1 to
Stage 2. The Group has determined that a significant increase in
credit risk arises when an individual borrower is more than 30 days
past due or in other circumstances such as forbearance
measures.
The Group monitors the ongoing
appropriateness of the transfer criteria, where any proposed
amendments will be reviewed and approved by the Group's Credit
Committees at least annually and more frequently if
required.
A borrower will move back into
Stage 1 conditional upon a period of good account conduct and the
improvement of the Client's situation to the extent that the
probability of default has receded sufficiently and a full
repayment of the loan, without recourse to the collateral, is
likely.
Definition of default (movement to Stage 3)
The Group uses a number of
qualitative and quantitative criteria to determine whether an
account meets the definition of default and as a result moves into
Stage 3. The criteria are as follows:
•
The rebuttable assumption that more than 90 days past due is an
indicator of default. The Group therefore deems more than 90 days
past due as an indicator of default except for cases where the
customer is already within forbearance. This will ensure that the
policy is aligned with the Basel/Regulatory definition of
default.
•
The Group has also deemed it appropriate to classify accounts where
there has been a breach in agreed forbearance arrangements,
recovery action is in hand or bankruptcy proceedings have been
initiated or similar insolvency process of a client, or director of
a company.
A borrower will move out of Stage
3 when their credit risk improves such that they are no longer past
due and remain up to date for a minimum period of six months and
the improvement in the borrower's situation to the extent that
credit risk has receded sufficiently and a full repayment of the
loan, without recourse to the collateral, is likely.
Forward looking macroeconomic scenarios
IFRS 9 requires the entity to
consider the risk of default and impairment loss taking into
account expectations of economic changes that are
reasonable.
The Group uses bespoke
macroeconomic models to determine the most significant factors
which may influence the likelihood of an exposure defaulting in the
future. At present, the most significant macroeconomic factors
relate to property prices, UK real GDP growth and unemployment
rate. The Group currently consider five probability weighted
scenarios: baseline; extreme downside; downside 2; downside 1 and
upside. The Group has derived an approach for factoring probability
weighted macroeconomic forecasts into ECL calculations, adjusting
PD and LGD estimates.
Expected life
IFRS 9 requires lifetime expected
credit losses to be measured over the expected life. Currently the
Group considers the loans' contractual term as the maximum period
to consider credit losses. This approach will continue to be
monitored and enhanced if and when deemed appropriate.
Government guarantees
During March and April 2020, the
UK government launched a series of temporary schemes designed to
support businesses deal with the impact of Covid-19. The BBLS,
CBILS, CLBILS and RLS lending products were originated by the Group
but are covered by government guarantees. These are to be set
against the outstanding balance of a defaulted facility after the
proceeds of the business assets have been applied. The government
guarantee is 80% for CBILS, CLBILS and RLS and 100% for BBLS.
Arbuthnot Latham recognises lower LGDs for these lending products
as a result, with 0% applied to the government guaranteed part of
the exposure.
3.5 Derivatives held for risk management purposes and hedge
accounting
The Group has elected, as an
accounting policy choice permitted under IFRS 9 'Financial
Instruments', to continue to apply the hedge accounting rules set
out in IAS 39 'Financial Instruments - Recognition and
measurement'. However, additional hedge accounting disclosures
introduced by IFRS 9's consequential amendments to IFRS 7 are
provided.
Derivatives held for risk
management purposes include all derivative assets and liabilities
that are not classified as trading assets or liabilities. All
derivatives are measured at fair value in the statement of
financial position.
The Group designates certain
derivatives held for risk management as hedging instruments in
qualifying hedging relationships.
Policy applicable generally to hedging
relationships
On initial designation of the
hedge, the Group formally documents the relationship between the
hedging instrument(s) and hedged item(s), including the risk
management objective and strategy in undertaking the hedge,
together with the method that will be used to assess the
effectiveness of the hedging relationship. The Group makes an
assessment, both on inception of the hedging relationship and on an
ongoing basis, of whether the hedging instrument(s) is (are)
expected to be highly effective in offsetting the changes in the
fair value of the respective hedged item(s) during the period for
which the hedge is designated, and whether the actual results of
each hedge are within a range of 80-125%.
Fair value hedges
When a derivative is designated as
the hedging instrument in a hedge of the change in fair value of a
recognised asset or liability or a firm commitment that could
affect profit or loss, changes in the fair value of the derivative
are recognised immediately in profit or loss. The change in fair
value of the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk is
recognised in profit or loss. If the hedged item would otherwise be
measured at cost or amortised cost, then its carrying amount is
adjusted accordingly.
If the hedging derivative expires
or is sold, terminated or exercised, or the hedge no longer meets
the criteria for fair value hedge accounting, or the hedge
designation is revoked, then hedge accounting is discontinued
prospectively. However, if the derivative is novated to a central
counterparty by both parties as a consequence of laws or
regulations without changes in its terms except for those that are
necessary for the novation, then the derivative is not considered
expired or terminated.
Any adjustment up to the point of
discontinuation to a hedged item for which the effective interest
method is used is amortised to profit or loss as an adjustment to
the recalculated effective interest rate of the item over its
remaining life.
On hedge discontinuation, any
hedging adjustment made previously to a hedged financial instrument
for which the effective interest method is used is amortised to
profit or loss by adjusting the effective interest rate of the
hedged item from the date on which amortisation begins. If the
hedged item is derecognised, then the adjustment is recognised
immediately in profit or loss when the item is
derecognised.
3.6. Impairment of non-financial
assets
The carrying amounts of the
Group's non-financial assets, other than inventories and deferred
tax assets, are reviewed at each reporting date to determine
whether there is any indication of impairment. If any such
indication exists, then the asset's recoverable amount is
estimated. Impairment for goodwill is discussed in more detail
under Note 28.
3.7. Fiduciary activities
The Group commonly acts as trustee
and in other fiduciary capacities that result in the holding or
placing of assets on behalf of individuals, trusts, retirement
benefit plans and other institutions. These assets and income
arising thereon are excluded from these financial statements, as
they are not assets of the Group.
3.8. Adoption of new and revised reporting
standards
There are no standards,
interpretations or amendments to existing standards that have been
published and are mandatory for the Group's accounting periods
beginning on or after 1 January 2023 or later periods, that will
have any material impact on the Group's financial
statements.
3.9. Standards issued but not yet
effective
A number of new standards and
amendments to standards are effective for annual periods beginning
after 1 January 2023 and earlier application is permitted; however,
the Group has not early adopted the new and amended standards in
preparing these consolidated financial statements.
Other standards
The following new and amended
standards are not expected to have a significant impact on the
Group's consolidated financial statements.
•
International Tax Reform - Pillar Two Model Rules (Amendments
to IAS 12, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 23
May 2023).
•
Non-current Liabilities with Covenants (Amendments to IAS 1,
effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January
2024).
•
Classification of Liabilities as Current or Non-Current
(Amendments to IAS 1, effective for annual periods beginning
on or after 1 January 2024).
•
Lease Liability in a Sale and Leaseback (Amendments to IFRS
16, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January
2024).
•
Supplier Finance Arrangements (Amendments to IAS 7 and IFRS
7, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January
2024).
•
Lack of Exchangeability (Amendments to IAS 21, effective for
annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2025).
•
Sale or Contribution of Assets between an Investor and its
Associate or Joint Venture (Amendments to IFRS 10 and IAS 28,
available for optional adoption/ effective date deferred
indefinitely).
4. Critical accounting estimates and judgements in
applying accounting policies
The Group makes estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities within the next financial year. Estimates and
judgements are continually evaluated and are based on historical
experience and other factors, including expectations of future
events that are believed to be reasonable under the
circumstances.
4.1 Critical accounting judgements
Information about judgements made
in applying accounting policies that have the most significant
effects on the amounts recognised in the consolidated financial
statements is included in the following notes:
•
Notes 3.4 and 6(a): establishing the criteria for determining
whether credit risk on a financial asset has increased
significantly since initial recognition.
•
Notes 3.4 and 6(a): establishing the criteria to determine whether
an account meets the definition of default and as a result moves
into Stage 3.
•
Notes 3.3 and 6(f): classification of financial assets: assessment
of the business model within which the assets are held and
assessment of whether the contractual terms of financial asset are
SPPI on the principal amount outstanding.
4.2 Estimation uncertainty
(a) Expected credit losses ("ECL") on financial
assets
The Group reviews its loan
portfolios and debt security investments to assess impairment at
least on a quarterly basis. The basis for evaluating impairment
losses is described in Note 11. The measurement of ECL required by
the implementation of IFRS 9, necessitates a number of significant
judgements. Specifically, judgements and estimation uncertainties
relate to assessment of whether credit risk on the financial asset
has increased significantly since initial recognition,
incorporation of forward-looking information ("FLI") in the
measurement of ECLs and key assumptions used in estimating
recoverable cash flows. These estimates are driven by a number of
factors that are subject to change which may result in different
levels of ECL allowances.
The Group incorporates FLI into
the assessment of whether there has been a significant increase in
credit risk. Forecasts for key macroeconomic variables that most
closely correlate with the Bank's portfolio are used to produce
five economic scenarios, comprising of a base case, which is the
central scenario, developed internally based on consensus forecast,
and four less likely scenarios, one upside and three downside
scenarios (downside 1, downside 2 and extreme downside), and the
impacts of these scenarios are then probability weighted. The
estimation and application of this FLI will require significant
judgement supported by the use of external information.
12-month ECLs on loans and
advances (loans within Stage 1) are calculated using a statistical
model on a collective basis, grouped together by product and
geographical location. The key assumptions are the probability of
default, the economic scenarios and loss given default having
consideration to collateral. Lifetime ECLs on loans and advances
(loans within Stage 2 and 3) are calculated based on an individual
valuation of the underlying asset and other expected cash
flows.
For financial assets in Stage 2
and 3, ECL is calculated on an individual basis and all relevant
factors that have a bearing on the expected future cash flows are
taken into account. These factors can be subjective and can include
the individual circumstances of the borrower, the realisable value
of collateral, the Group's position relative to other claimants,
and the likely cost to sell and duration of the time to collect.
The level of ECL is the difference between the value of the
recoverable amount (which is equal to the expected future cash
flows discounted at the loan's original effective interest rate),
and its carrying amount.
Five economic scenarios were
modelled. A probability was assigned to each scenario to arrive at
an overall weighted impact on ECL. Management judgment is required
in the application of the probability weighting for each
scenario.
The Group considered the impact of
various assumptions on the calculation of ECL (changes in GDP,
unemployment rates, inflation, exchange rates, equity prices, wages
and collateral values/property prices) and concluded that
collateral values/property prices, UK GDP and UK unemployment rate
are key drivers of credit risk and credit losses for each portfolio
of financial instruments.
Using an analysis of historical
data, management has estimated relationships between macro-economic
variables and credit risk and credit losses. The Group estimates
each key driver for credit risk over the active forecast period of
between two and five years. This is followed by a period of mean
reversion of five years.
The five macroeconomic scenarios
modelled on future property prices and macroeconomic variables were
as follows:
•
Baseline
•
Upside
•
Downside 1
•
Downside 2
•
Extreme downside
The tables below therefore reflect
the expected probability weightings applied for each macroeconomic
scenario:
|
|
|
|
Probability weighting
|
Group
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Economic Scenarios
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Baseline
|
|
|
|
46.0%
|
53.0%
|
Upside
|
|
|
|
16.0%
|
13.0%
|
Downside 1
|
|
|
|
18.0%
|
12.0%
|
Downside 2
|
|
|
|
12.0%
|
11.0%
|
Extreme downside
|
|
|
|
8.0%
|
11.0%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The tables below show the five-year forecasted average for property
prices growth, UK unemployment rate and UK real GDP
growth:
|
|
31 December
2023
|
|
|
Base
|
Upside
|
Downside 1
|
Downside 2
|
Extreme
downside
|
Five-year summary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK House price index - average
growth
|
|
1.5%
|
5.8%
|
-0.4%
|
-2.3%
|
-4.2%
|
UK Commercial real estate price -
average growth
|
|
1.5%
|
3.6%
|
-0.7%
|
-2.8%
|
-4.9%
|
UK Unemployment rate -
average
|
|
4.9%
|
3.9%
|
5.7%
|
6.5%
|
7.3%
|
UK GDP - average growth
|
|
1.3%
|
2.1%
|
0.9%
|
0.4%
|
0.0%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31 December
2022
|
|
|
Base
|
Upside
|
Downside 1
|
Downside 2
|
Extreme
downside
|
Five-year summary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK House price index - average
growth
|
|
(0.8%)
|
1.7%
|
(1.9%)
|
(3.0%)
|
(4.2%)
|
UK Commercial real estate price -
average growth
|
|
(2.6%)
|
0.2%
|
(3.4%)
|
(4.1%)
|
(4.9%)
|
UK Unemployment rate -
average
|
|
4.3%
|
2.8%
|
5.3%
|
6.3%
|
7.3%
|
UK GDP - average growth
|
|
1.2%
|
2.1%
|
0.8%
|
0.4%
|
0.0%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The tables below list the
macroeconomic assumptions at 31 December 2023 used in the base,
upside and downside scenarios over the five-year forecast period.
The assumptions represent the absolute percentage unemployment
rates and year-on-year percentage change for GDP and property
prices.
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK House price index - four quarter growth
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year
|
Baseline
|
Upside
|
Downside 1
|
Downside 2
|
Extreme
downside
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2024
|
(2.3%)
|
5.5%
|
(5.2%)
|
(8.1%)
|
(11.0%)
|
2025
|
(2.2%)
|
3.8%
|
(7.1%)
|
(12.0%)
|
(16.9%)
|
2026
|
2.1%
|
4.8%
|
(0.9%)
|
(3.8%)
|
(6.8%)
|
2027
|
5.0%
|
7.7%
|
5.7%
|
6.4%
|
7.2%
|
2028
|
5.1%
|
7.2%
|
5.6%
|
6.1%
|
6.6%
|
5 year average
|
1.5%
|
5.8%
|
(0.4%)
|
(2.3%)
|
(4.2%)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK Commercial real estate price - four quarter
growth
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year
|
Baseline
|
Upside
|
Downside 1
|
Downside 2
|
Extreme
downside
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2024
|
0.8%
|
7.5%
|
(9.5%)
|
(19.8%)
|
(30.0%)
|
2025
|
1.5%
|
3.9%
|
(5.2%)
|
(11.9%)
|
(18.6%)
|
2026
|
1.9%
|
3.1%
|
3.6%
|
5.3%
|
7.0%
|
2027
|
1.6%
|
1.9%
|
3.9%
|
6.2%
|
8.5%
|
2028
|
1.6%
|
1.9%
|
3.9%
|
6.3%
|
8.6%
|
5 year average
|
1.5%
|
3.6%
|
(0.7%)
|
(2.8%)
|
(4.9%)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK Unemployment rate - annual average
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year
|
Baseline
|
Upside
|
Downside 1
|
Downside 2
|
Extreme
downside
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2024
|
4.7%
|
3.9%
|
5.1%
|
5.5%
|
6.0%
|
2025
|
4.7%
|
3.9%
|
5.9%
|
7.2%
|
8.4%
|
2026
|
4.9%
|
3.9%
|
5.9%
|
6.9%
|
8.0%
|
2027
|
5.2%
|
3.9%
|
5.9%
|
6.6%
|
7.4%
|
2028
|
5.0%
|
3.9%
|
5.6%
|
6.1%
|
6.7%
|
5 year average
|
4.9%
|
3.9%
|
5.7%
|
6.5%
|
7.3%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK GDP - annual growth
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year
|
Baseline
|
Upside
|
Downside 1
|
Downside 2
|
Extreme
downside
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2024
|
0.4%
|
1.9%
|
(1.4%)
|
(3.2%)
|
(5.0%)
|
2025
|
1.4%
|
2.0%
|
1.3%
|
1.4%
|
1.2%
|
2026
|
1.7%
|
2.4%
|
1.5%
|
1.4%
|
1.2%
|
2027
|
1.6%
|
2.2%
|
1.5%
|
1.3%
|
1.2%
|
2028
|
1.6%
|
2.1%
|
1.5%
|
1.3%
|
1.2%
|
5 year average
|
1.3%
|
2.1%
|
0.9%
|
0.4%
|
0.0%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The graphs below plot the
historical data for HPI, Commercial real estate price, unemployment
rate and GDP growth rate in the UK as well as the forecasted data
under each of the five scenarios.
The table below compares the 31
December 2023 ECL provision using the 31 December 2023 economic
scenarios and the 31 December 2023 ECL provision using the 31
December 2022 economic scenarios.
|
|
|
|
Economic scenarios as at
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
ECL Provision
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stage 1
|
900
|
852
|
Stage 2
|
429
|
429
|
Stage 3
|
5,479
|
5,642
|
At 31 December 2023
|
6,808
|
6,923
|
|
|
|
Additionally, management have
assessed the impact of assigning a 100% probability to each of the
economic scenarios, which would have the following impact on the
Profit or Loss of the Group:
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£m
|
£m
|
Impact of 100% scenario probability
|
|
|
|
|
|
Baseline
|
0.8
|
0.7
|
Upside
|
1.6
|
1.0
|
Downside 1
|
(1.7)
|
(2.0)
|
Downside 2
|
(8.1)
|
(7.5)
|
Extreme downside
|
(24.0)
|
(19.1)
|
|
|
|
(b) Effective Interest Rate
Loans and advances to customers
are initially recognised at fair value. The fair value of a loan on initial recognition is generally
its transaction price. Subsequently, they
are measured under the effective interest rate method. Management
review the expected cash flows against actual cash flows to ensure
future assumptions on customer behaviour and future cash flows
remain valid. If the estimates of future cash flows are revised,
the gross carrying value of the financial asset is recalculated as
the present value of the estimated future contractual cash flows
discounted at the original effective interest rate. The adjustment
to the carrying value of the loan book is recognised in the
Statement of Comprehensive Income.
The accuracy of the effective
interest rate is affected by unexpected market movements resulting
in altered customer behaviour, inaccuracies in the models used
compared to actual outcomes and incorrect assumptions.
In 2023 the Group recognised £28k
(2022: £Nil)
additional interest income to reflect a revision in the timing of
expected cash flows on the originated book, reflecting a shortening
of the expected life of originated loan book.
If customer loans repaid 6 months
earlier than anticipated on the originated loan book, interest
income would increase by £0.5m (2022: £0.7m), due to acceleration of
fee income.
In 2023 the Group recognised £13k
additional (2022:
additional £0.1m) of interest income to reflect actual cash flows
received on the acquired mortgage books being less than forecast
cash flows.
The key judgements in relation to
calculating the net present value of the acquired mortgage books
relate to the timing of future cash flows on principal repayments.
Management have considered an early and delayed 6-month sensitivity
on the timing of repayment and a 10% increase and decrease of
principal repayments to be reasonably possible.
If the acquired loan books were
modelled to accelerate cash flows by 6 months, it would increase
interest income in 2023 by £0.03m (2022: £0.1m) while a 10% increase in
principal repayments will increase interest income in 2023 by £0.1m
(2022: £0.2m)
through a cash flow reset adjustment.
(c) Investment property
The valuations that the Group
places on its investment properties are subject to a degree of
uncertainty and are calculated on the basis of assumptions in
relation to prevailing market rents and effective yields. These
assumptions may not prove to be accurate, particularly in periods
of market volatility.
The uncertainty due to Brexit,
rising inflation and interest rates has resulted in less market
evidence being available for Management in making its judgement on
the key assumptions of property yield and market rent. The Group
currently owns one (2022: one) investment property, as
outlined in Note 31.
Management valued the investment
property utilising externally sourced market information and
property specific knowledge. The valuations were reviewed by the
Group's in-house surveyor.
Crescent Office Park in Bath with value of £6.0m (2022:
£6.6m)
In December 2017, the office
building was acquired with the intention to be included within a
new property fund initiative that the Group had planned to
start-up. The property had tenants in situ with the Fund
recognising rental income.
The property was initially
recognised as held for sale under IFRS 5. In 2018 the launch of the
property fund was placed on hold and as a result it was
reclassified as an investment property as the property no longer
met the IFRS 5 criteria. The property remained occupied as at 31
December 2023 with the Group receiving rental income.
In accordance with IAS 40, the
property is measured at fair value, with its carrying value at year
end of £5.95m equal to its fair value.
The valuation of the property has
the following key inputs:
•
yield: 7.48%
• total topped up rental income per annum: £0.47m
The external valuation that the
Group places on its investment property is subject to a degree of
uncertainty and is calculated on the basis of assumptions in
relation to prevailing market conditions and subject to comparable
properties for sale. This valuation is therefore susceptible to
uncertainty particularly where there is a limited level of activity
in the property market.
Management have assessed that
should the fair value of the investment property reduce by 5% this
would impact profit or loss by £0.3m and a reduction of 10% would
impact profit or loss by £0.6m.
(d) Inventory
The Group owns one commercial
property (2022:
one property) and one repossessed property (2022: one property), classified as
inventory and presented as part of other assets in the Statement of
Financial Position. The properties are assessed at the reporting
date for impairment.
The internal valuations that the
Group places on its properties are subject to a degree of
uncertainty and are calculated on the basis of assumptions in
relation to prevailing market rents and effective yields. These
assumptions may not prove to be accurate, particularly in periods
of market volatility.
Similarly to investment property,
the uncertainty due to Brexit, rising inflation and interest rates
resulted in less market evidence being available for Management in
making its judgement on the key assumptions of property yield and
market rent.
The external valuations that the
Group places on its properties are subject to a degree of
uncertainty and are calculated on the basis of assumptions in
relation to prevailing market conditions and subject to comparable
properties for sale. These valuations are therefore susceptible to
uncertainty particularly where there is a limited level of activity
in the property market.
Management have assessed that
should the net realisable value less cost to sell of each of the
combined property inventory reduce by 5% this would impact profit
or loss by £0.7m and a reduction of 10% would impact profit or loss
by £1.5m (or 10% of cost).
(e) Residual value
At the end of lease terms, assets
may be sold to third parties or leased for further terms. Rentals
are calculated to recover the cost of assets less their residual
value ("RV"), and earn finance income. RV's represent the estimated
value of the leased asset at the end of lease period. Residual
values are calculated after analysing the market place and the
company's own historical experience in the market. Expected
residual values of leased assets are prospectively adjusted for
through the depreciation adjustments which are charged to the
income statement each year. The key estimates and judgements that
arise in relation to RV's are timing of lease terminations and
expected residual value of returned vehicles.
The profitability of the Group's
operating lease contracts is highly dependent on the RV of the
vehicle at the end of the agreement. On inception of the lease, the
Group uses its knowledge and experience of the market and industry
to estimate the final RV of the vehicle. The Group is exposed to
the risk that the RV of the vehicle may be less than anticipated at
the outset of the contract impacting profitability. The Group
manages the risk through effective and robust procedures by
continually monitoring historic, current and forecast RV
performance.
Management have assessed that
should the residual value decrease by 5% this would impact profit
or loss by £2.1m and a reduction of 10% would impact profit or loss
by £4.2m. Expected residual values underlying the calculation of
depreciation of leased assets are kept under review to take account
of any change in circumstances. Refer to Note 29 for further
detail.
(f) Climate change
The Group has considered the
potential impact of climate change on the Group's financial
position and performance.
This included performing an
assessment over the Group's financial and non-financial assets and
evaluating information about the observable effects of physical and
transition risk of climate change on the Group's financial position
and performance. Many of the effects of climate change will be less
significant in the short term and will have limited impact on
accounting estimates and judgements in the current year.
The following items represent the most
significant effects:
• The
Group's loan portfolio is exposed to the potential impact of
climate-related risks, due to the ECL implications and expectations
on the ability of the borrowers to meet their loan obligations. As
the Group has limited appetite for financial and reputational risk
emanating from climate change, the potential ECL impact as a result
of climate change is not expected to be material in the short
term.
• The
assessment of asset impairment and the Group's deferred tax asset
depends on the Group's future performance and cash flows. The Group
has incorporated market expectations on climate risk it its
profitability and cash flow forecasts and doesn't consider any
additional adjustments are required.
|
|
|
|
5. Maturity analysis of assets and
liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The table below shows the maturity
analysis of assets and liabilities of the Group as at 31 December
2023:
|
|
Due
within one year
|
Due
after more than one year
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
826,559
|
-
|
826,559
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
79,381
|
-
|
79,381
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
859,430
|
83,007
|
942,437
|
Assets classified as held for
sale
|
3,281
|
-
|
3,281
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
4
|
4,210
|
4,214
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
563,244
|
1,500,973
|
2,064,217
|
Other assets
|
32,619
|
24,531
|
57,150
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
3,942
|
3,942
|
Intangible assets
|
6,116
|
23,471
|
29,587
|
Property, plant and
equipment
|
107,600
|
166,706
|
274,306
|
Right-of-use assets
|
5,987
|
46,829
|
52,816
|
Investment property
|
-
|
5,950
|
5,950
|
|
2,484,221
|
1,859,619
|
4,343,840
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
3,410
|
190,000
|
193,410
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
66
|
966
|
1,032
|
Deposits from customers
|
3,687,489
|
72,078
|
3,759,567
|
Current tax liability
|
294
|
-
|
294
|
Other liabilities
|
40,700
|
-
|
40,700
|
Deferred tax liability
|
-
|
4,910
|
4,910
|
Lease liabilities
|
2,559
|
51,202
|
53,761
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
|
3,734,518
|
356,882
|
4,091,400
|
|
|
|
|
The table below shows the maturity
analysis of assets and liabilities of the Group as at 31 December
2022:
|
|
Due
within one year
|
Due
after more than one year
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
732,729
|
-
|
732,729
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
115,788
|
-
|
115,788
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
328,988
|
110,765
|
439,753
|
Assets classified as held for
sale
|
3,279
|
-
|
3,279
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
113
|
6,209
|
6,322
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
690,145
|
1,345,932
|
2,036,077
|
Other assets
|
31,034
|
21,151
|
52,185
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
3,404
|
3,404
|
Deferred tax asset
|
-
|
2,425
|
2,425
|
Intangible assets
|
8,716
|
23,833
|
32,549
|
Property, plant and
equipment
|
77,599
|
97,674
|
175,273
|
Right-of-use assets
|
3,134
|
4,580
|
7,714
|
Investment property
|
-
|
6,550
|
6,550
|
|
1,991,525
|
1,622,523
|
3,614,048
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
11,027
|
225,000
|
236,027
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
135
|
-
|
135
|
Deposits from customers
|
3,041,084
|
51,465
|
3,092,549
|
Current tax liability
|
1,748
|
-
|
1,748
|
Other liabilities
|
26,144
|
-
|
26,144
|
Lease Liabilities
|
3,325
|
4,547
|
7,872
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
|
3,083,463
|
318,606
|
3,402,069
|
|
|
|
|
The table below shows the maturity
analysis of assets and liabilities of the Company as at 31 December
2023:
|
|
Due
within one year
|
Due
after more than one year
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
7
|
-
|
7
|
Loans and advances to banks - due
from subsidiary undertakings
|
616
|
-
|
616
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
38,129
|
38,129
|
Deferred tax asset
|
-
|
520
|
520
|
Property, plant and
equipment
|
-
|
130
|
130
|
Other assets
|
1,449
|
-
|
1,449
|
Interests in
subsidiaries
|
-
|
164,354
|
164,354
|
|
2,072
|
203,133
|
205,205
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
Current tax liability
|
2,641
|
-
|
2,641
|
Other liabilities
|
5,536
|
-
|
5,536
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
|
8,177
|
37,726
|
45,903
|
|
|
|
|
The table below shows the maturity
analysis of assets and liabilities of the Company as at 31 December
2022:
|
|
Due
within one year
|
Due
after more than one year
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
6
|
-
|
6
|
Loans and advances to banks - due
from subsidiary undertakings
|
8,427
|
-
|
8,427
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
24,437
|
24,437
|
Deferred tax asset
|
-
|
522
|
522
|
Intangible assets
|
-
|
1
|
1
|
Property, plant and
equipment
|
-
|
130
|
130
|
Other assets
|
73
|
-
|
73
|
Interests in
subsidiaries
|
-
|
159,354
|
159,354
|
|
8,506
|
184,444
|
192,950
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
Current tax liability
|
879
|
-
|
879
|
Other liabilities
|
3,490
|
-
|
3,490
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
|
4,369
|
37,594
|
41,963
|
6. Financial risk management
Strategy
By their nature, the Group's
activities are principally related to the use of financial
instruments. The Directors and senior management of the Group have
formally adopted a Group Risk and Controls Policy which sets out
the Board's attitude to risk and internal controls. Key risks
identified by the Directors are formally reviewed and assessed at
least once a year by the Board, in addition to which key business
risks are identified, evaluated and managed by operating management
on an ongoing basis by means of procedures such as physical
controls, credit and other authorisation limits and segregation of
duties. The Board also receives regular reports on any risk matters
that need to be brought to its attention. Significant risks
identified in connection with the development of new activities are
subject to consideration by the Board. There are budgeting
procedures in place and reports are presented regularly to the
Board detailing the results of each principal business unit,
variances against budget and prior year, and other performance
data.
The principal non-operational
risks inherent in the Group's business are credit, macroeconomic,
market, liquidity and capital.
(a) Credit risk
The Company and Group take on
exposure to credit risk, which is the risk that a counterparty will
be unable to pay amounts in full when due. Significant changes in
the economy, or in the health of a particular industry segment that
represents a concentration in the Company and Group's portfolio,
could result in losses that are different from those provided for
at the balance sheet date. Credit risk is managed through the
Credit Committee of the banking subsidiary.
The Committee regularly reviews
the credit risk profile of the Group, with a clear focus on
performance against risk appetite statements and risk metrics. The
Committee considered credit conditions during the year, and in
particular the impact of the rising inflation and interest rates on
performance against both credit risk appetite and a range of key
credit risk metrics.
The Company and Group structure
the levels of credit risk it undertakes by placing limits on the
amount of risk accepted in relation to products, and one borrower
or groups of borrowers. Such risks are monitored on a revolving
basis and subject to an annual or more frequent review. The limits
are approved periodically by the Board of Directors and actual
exposures against limits are monitored daily.
Exposure to credit risk is managed
through regular analysis of the ability of borrowers and potential
borrowers to meet interest and capital repayment obligations and by
changing these lending limits where appropriate. Exposure to credit
risk is also managed in part by obtaining collateral, and corporate
and personal guarantees.
The economic environment remains
uncertain and future impairment charges may be subject to further
volatility (including from changes to macroeconomic variable
forecasts).
Rising inflation and interest
rates have created a challenge for ECL modelling, given the
severity of economic shock and associated uncertainty for the
future economic path coupled with the scale of government and
central bank intervention that have altered the relationships
between economic drivers and default.
The Group has attempted to
leverage stress test modelling insights to inform ECL model
refinements to enable reasonable estimates. Management review of
modelling approaches and outcomes continues to inform any necessary
adjustments to the ECL estimates through the form of in-model
adjustments, based on expert judgement including the use of
available information. Management considerations included the
potential severity and duration of the economic shock, including
the mitigating effects of government support actions, as well the
potential trajectory of the subsequent recovery.
The Group employs a range of
policies and practices to mitigate credit risk. The most
traditional of these is the taking of collateral to secure
advances, which is common practice. The principal collateral
types for loans and advances include, but are not limited
to:
•
Charges over residential and commercial properties;
•
Charges over business assets such as premises, inventory and
accounts receivable;
•
Charges over financial instruments such as debt securities and
equities;
•
Charges over other chattels; and
•
Personal guarantees
Upon initial recognition of loans
and advances, the fair value of collateral is based on valuation
techniques commonly used for the corresponding assets. In
order to minimise any potential credit loss the Group will seek
additional collateral from the counterparty as soon as impairment
indicators are noticed for the relevant individual loans and
advances. Repossessed collateral, not readily convertible into
cash, is made available for sale in an orderly fashion, with the
proceeds used to reduce or repay the outstanding indebtedness, or
held as inventory where the Group intends to develop and sell in
the future. Where excess funds are available after the debt has
been repaid, they are available either for other secured lenders
with lower priority or are returned to the customer.
Commitments to extend credit
represent unused portions of authorisations to extend credit in the
form of loans, guarantees or letters of credit. With respect to
credit risk on commitments to extend credit, the Group is
potentially exposed to loss in an amount equal to the total unused
commitments. However, the likely amount of loss is less than the
total unused commitments, as most commitments to extend credit are
contingent upon customers maintaining specific credit
standards.
The Group incorporates
forward-looking information into both its assessment of whether the
credit risk of an instrument has increased significantly since its
initial recognition and its measurement of ECL. The key inputs into
the measurement of the ECL are:
•
assessment of significant increase in credit risk
•
future economic scenarios
•
probability of default
•
loss given default
•
exposure at default
The IFRS 9 impairment model adopts
a three stage approach based on the extent of credit deterioration
since origination, see Note 11.
The Group's maximum exposure to
credit risk before collateral held or other credit enhancements is
as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
Group
|
Banking
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ABL
|
ASFL
|
AAG
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Total
|
Credit risk exposures (all stage
1, unless otherwise stated)
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
On-balance sheet:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
826,397
|
826,397
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
79,381
|
79,381
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
942,437
|
942,437
|
Assets classified as held for
sale
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,281
|
3,281
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
4,214
|
4,214
|
Loans and advances to customers
(Gross of ECL)
|
1,442,827
|
124,905
|
200,606
|
240,178
|
3,113
|
59,396
|
-
|
2,071,025
|
Stage 1
|
1,333,006
|
95,231
|
194,571
|
223,912
|
3,113
|
59,109
|
-
|
1,908,942
|
Stage 2
|
59,681
|
10,084
|
2,267
|
10,432
|
-
|
287
|
-
|
82,751
|
Stage 3
|
50,140
|
19,590
|
3,768
|
5,834
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
79,332
|
Other assets
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
22,361
|
22,361
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,942
|
3,942
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Off-balance sheet:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Guarantees
|
2,051
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
2,051
|
Loan commitments and other credit
related liabilities
|
156,027
|
-
|
-
|
294,399
|
113
|
-
|
-
|
450,539
|
At 31 December
|
1,600,905
|
124,905
|
200,606
|
534,577
|
3,226
|
59,396
|
1,882,013
|
4,405,628
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
Group
|
Banking
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ABL
|
ASFL
|
AAG
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Total
|
Credit risk exposures (all stage
1, unless otherwise stated)
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
On-balance sheet:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
732,513
|
732,513
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
115,788
|
115,788
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
439,753
|
439,753
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
6,322
|
6,322
|
Loans and advances to customers
(Gross of ECL)
|
1,455,607
|
148,957
|
134,724
|
270,999
|
14,950
|
17,442
|
-
|
2,042,679
|
Stage 1
|
1,363,572
|
126,726
|
128,807
|
267,962
|
13,756
|
17,066
|
-
|
1,917,889
|
Stage 2
|
59,904
|
10,777
|
2,454
|
-
|
1,001
|
376
|
-
|
74,512
|
Stage 3
|
32,131
|
11,454
|
3,463
|
3,037
|
193
|
-
|
-
|
50,278
|
Other assets
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
14,160
|
14,160
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,404
|
3,404
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Off-balance sheet:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Guarantees
|
2,591
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
662
|
-
|
3,253
|
Loan commitments and other credit
related liabilities
|
219,490
|
-
|
-
|
250,276
|
1,312
|
-
|
-
|
471,078
|
At 31 December
|
1,677,688
|
148,957
|
134,724
|
521,275
|
16,262
|
18,104
|
1,311,940
|
3,828,950
|
|
|
|
The Company's maximum exposure to
credit risk (all stage 1) before collateral held or other credit
enhancements is as follows:
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Credit risk exposures relating to
on-balance sheet assets are as follows:
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
623
|
8,434
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
38,129
|
24,437
|
At 31 December
|
38,752
|
32,871
|
The above tables represent the
maximum credit risk exposure (net of impairment) to the Group and
Company at 31 December 2023 and 2022 without taking account of any
collateral held or other credit enhancements attached. For
financial assets, the balances are based on carrying amounts as
reported in the Statement of Financial Position. For guarantees and
loan commitments, the amounts in the table represent the amounts
for which the group is contractually committed.
The table below represents an
analysis of the loan to values of the exposures secured by property
for the Group:
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
|
|
|
Banking
|
|
Mortgage Portfolios
|
|
Total
|
|
|
|
|
Loan
Balance
|
Collateral
|
|
Loan
Balance
|
Collateral
|
|
Loan
Balance
|
Collateral
|
Group
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Less than 60%
|
|
|
|
1,029,694
|
2,374,285
|
|
82,690
|
202,310
|
|
1,112,384
|
2,576,595
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
961,118
|
2,225,190
|
|
64,514
|
158,253
|
|
1,025,632
|
2,383,443
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
48,766
|
102,890
|
|
7,530
|
18,493
|
|
56,296
|
121,383
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
19,810
|
46,205
|
|
10,646
|
25,564
|
|
30,456
|
71,769
|
60%-80%
|
|
|
|
332,632
|
528,678
|
|
27,929
|
43,196
|
|
360,561
|
571,874
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
308,321
|
491,617
|
|
20,814
|
32,103
|
|
329,135
|
523,720
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
8,578
|
13,530
|
|
1,649
|
2,655
|
|
10,227
|
16,185
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
15,733
|
23,531
|
|
5,466
|
8,438
|
|
21,199
|
31,969
|
80%-100%
|
|
|
|
23,236
|
27,603
|
|
8,466
|
10,710
|
|
31,702
|
38,313
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
23,236
|
27,603
|
|
6,132
|
7,608
|
|
29,368
|
35,211
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
350
|
496
|
|
350
|
496
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
1,984
|
2,606
|
|
1,984
|
2,606
|
Greater than 100%*
|
|
|
|
20,952
|
9,843
|
|
5,820
|
6,354
|
|
26,772
|
16,197
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
3,350
|
2,583
|
|
3,772
|
3,895
|
|
7,122
|
6,478
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
1,978
|
260
|
|
554
|
691
|
|
2,532
|
951
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
15,624
|
7,000
|
|
1,494
|
1,768
|
|
17,118
|
8,768
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
|
1,406,514
|
2,940,409
|
|
124,905
|
262,570
|
|
1,531,419
|
3,202,979
|
*In addition to property, other
security is taken, including charges over Arbuthnot Latham
Investment Management portfolios, other chattels and personal
guarantees. The increase in loan to values greater than 100% is due
to an increase in exposures collateralised by other assets.
Additionally under the government scheme for BBLs, collateral is
not required as the loans are 100% backed by the
government.
Loans in the Banking segment with
a loan to value of greater than 100% have additional collateral of
£1.0m in the form of cash deposits and security over Arbuthnot
Latham Investment Management Portfolios and personal guarantees of
£7.0m. Non-property collateral reduces loan to value below 100% for
all such exposures in the Banking segment.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The table below represents an
analysis of the loan to values of the exposures secured by property
for the Group:
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
|
|
|
Banking
|
|
Mortgage Portfolios
|
|
Total
|
|
|
|
|
Loan
Balance
|
Collateral
|
|
Loan
Balance
|
Collateral
|
|
Loan
Balance
|
Collateral
|
Group
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Less than 60%
|
|
|
|
844,024
|
1,869,734
|
|
53,759
|
131,561
|
|
897,783
|
2,001,295
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
797,219
|
1,781,638
|
|
45,833
|
113,996
|
|
843,052
|
1,895,634
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
38,781
|
73,946
|
|
4,037
|
10,277
|
|
42,818
|
84,223
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
8,024
|
14,150
|
|
3,889
|
7,288
|
|
11,913
|
21,438
|
60%-80%
|
|
|
|
553,383
|
864,566
|
|
62,113
|
92,996
|
|
615,496
|
957,562
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
525,296
|
823,256
|
|
53,692
|
80,529
|
|
578,988
|
903,785
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
20,900
|
31,250
|
|
4,295
|
6,209
|
|
25,195
|
37,459
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
7,187
|
10,060
|
|
4,126
|
6,258
|
|
11,313
|
16,318
|
80%-100%
|
|
|
|
11,911
|
13,976
|
|
20,961
|
23,563
|
|
32,872
|
37,539
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
9,776
|
11,626
|
|
17,109
|
19,136
|
|
26,885
|
30,762
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
1,231
|
1,426
|
|
1,231
|
1,426
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
2,135
|
2,350
|
|
2,621
|
3,001
|
|
4,756
|
5,351
|
Greater than 100%*
|
|
|
|
24,182
|
13,005
|
|
17,142
|
13,925
|
|
41,324
|
26,930
|
Stage 1
|
|
|
|
11,142
|
6,880
|
|
13,191
|
10,623
|
|
24,333
|
17,503
|
Stage 2
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
1,741
|
1,586
|
|
1,741
|
1,586
|
Stage 3
|
|
|
|
13,040
|
6,125
|
|
2,210
|
1,716
|
|
15,250
|
7,841
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
|
1,433,500
|
2,761,281
|
|
153,975
|
262,045
|
|
1,587,475
|
3,023,326
|
*In addition to property, other
security is taken, including charges over Arbuthnot Latham
Investment Management portfolios, other chattels and personal
guarantees. The increase in loan to values greater than 100% is due
to an increase in exposures collateralised by other assets.
Additionally under the government scheme for BBLs, collateral is
not required as the loans are 100% backed by the
government.
Loans in the Banking segment with
a loan to value of greater than 100% have additional collateral of
£9.4m in the form of cash deposits and security over Arbuthnot
Latham Investment Management Portfolios and personal guarantees of
£13.1m. Non-property collateral reduces loan to value below 100%
for all such exposures in the Banking segment.
The table below represents an
analysis of loan commitments compared to the values of property
collateral for the Group (all Stage 1):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loan
commitments
|
Collateral
|
Group
|
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Less than 60%
|
|
|
|
|
|
34,105
|
178,155
|
60%-80%
|
|
|
|
|
|
22,261
|
31,524
|
Greater than 100%
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,042
|
2,992
|
Total
|
|
|
|
|
|
65,408
|
212,671
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loan
commitments
|
Collateral
|
Group
|
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Less than 60%
|
|
|
|
|
|
122,582
|
387,942
|
60%-80%
|
|
|
|
|
|
35,807
|
51,828
|
80%-100%
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,100
|
12,432
|
Greater than 100%
|
|
|
|
|
|
31,347
|
19,606
|
Total
|
|
|
|
|
|
200,836
|
471,808
|
Renegotiated loans and
forbearance
The contractual terms of a loan
may be modified due to factors that are not related to the current
or potential credit deterioration of the customer (changing market
conditions, customer retention, etc.). In such cases, the modified
loan may be derecognised and the renegotiated loan recognised as a
new loan at fair value.
When modification results in
derecognition, a new loan is recognised and allocated to Stage 1
(assuming it is not credit-impaired at that time).
The Group renegotiates loans to
customers in financial difficulties (referred to as 'forbearance')
to maximise collection opportunities and minimise the risk of
default. Under the Group's forbearance policy, loan forbearance is
granted on a selective basis if the debtor is currently in default
on its debt, or if there is a high risk of default, there is
evidence that the debtor made all reasonable efforts to pay under
the original contractual terms and the debtor is expected to be
able to meet the revised terms.
The revised terms can include
changing the timing of interest payments, extending the date of
repayment of the loan, transferring a loan to interest only
payments and a payment holiday. Both retail and corporate loans are
subject to the forbearance policy. The Group Credit Committee
regularly reviews reports on forbearance.
For financial assets modified as
part of the Group's forbearance policy, the estimate of PD reflects
whether the modification has improved or restored the Group's
ability to collect interest and principal and the Group's previous
experience of similar forbearance action. As part of this process,
the Group evaluates the borrower's payment performance against the
modified contractual terms and considers various behavioural
indicators. Whilst the customer is under forbearance, the customer
will be classified as Stage 2 and the Group recognise a lifetime
ECL. The customer will transfer to Stage 1 and revert to a 12 month
ECL when they exit forbearance. This is conditional upon both a
minimum six months' good account conduct and the improvement to the
client's situation to the extent the probability of default has
receded sufficiently and full repayment of the loan, without
recourse to the collateral, is likely.
Forbearance is a qualitative
indicator of a SICR (see Notes 3.3 and 3.4)
As at 31 December 2023, loans for
which forbearance measures were in place totalled 3.45% (2022:
3.0%) of total value of loans to customers for the Group. These are
set out in the following table:
|
2023
|
|
Stage
1
|
|
Stage
2
|
|
Stage
3
|
|
Total
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
Group
|
|
£000
|
|
|
£000
|
|
|
£000
|
|
|
£000
|
Time for asset sale
|
-
|
-
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
2
|
4,157
|
|
2
|
4,157
|
Term extension
|
-
|
-
|
|
11
|
3,701
|
|
2
|
796
|
|
13
|
4,497
|
Time for refinance with third
party
|
-
|
-
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
1
|
2,360
|
|
1
|
2,360
|
Payment holiday
|
-
|
-
|
|
13
|
23,771
|
|
3
|
5,490
|
|
16
|
29,261
|
Covenant waived
|
-
|
-
|
|
1
|
8,205
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
1
|
8,205
|
Switch to interest only
|
-
|
-
|
|
2
|
1,882
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
2
|
1,882
|
Modification in terms and
conditions
|
-
|
-
|
|
39
|
10,212
|
|
41
|
8,868
|
|
80
|
19,080
|
Restructure
|
-
|
-
|
|
2
|
1,236
|
|
3
|
457
|
|
5
|
1,693
|
Total forbearance
|
-
|
-
|
|
68
|
49,007
|
|
52
|
22,128
|
|
120
|
71,135
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
|
Stage
1
|
|
Stage
2
|
|
Stage
3
|
|
Total
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
|
Number
|
Loan
Balance
|
Group
|
|
£000
|
|
|
£000
|
|
|
£000
|
|
|
£000
|
Time for asset sale
|
-
|
-
|
|
3
|
8,836
|
|
1
|
35
|
|
4
|
8,871
|
Term extension
|
-
|
-
|
|
24
|
1,905
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
24
|
1,905
|
Time for refinance with third
party
|
-
|
-
|
|
1
|
2,360
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
1
|
2,360
|
Payment holiday
|
-
|
-
|
|
3
|
4,002
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
3
|
4,002
|
Covenant waived
|
-
|
-
|
|
3
|
28,142
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
3
|
28,142
|
Modification in term and
conditions
|
-
|
-
|
|
64
|
9,184
|
|
32
|
6,073
|
|
96
|
15,257
|
Restructure
|
-
|
-
|
|
7
|
1,567
|
|
-
|
-
|
|
7
|
1,567
|
Total forbearance
|
-
|
-
|
|
105
|
55,996
|
|
33
|
6,108
|
|
138
|
62,104
|
Concentration risk
The tables below show the
concentration in the loan book based on the most significant type
of collateral held for each loan.
|
Loans
and advances to customers
|
|
Loan
Commitments
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Concentration by product
|
|
|
|
|
|
Asset based
lending*
|
239,777
|
268,825
|
|
294,399
|
250,276
|
Asset
finance
|
257,547
|
148,788
|
|
113
|
1,312
|
Cash
collateralised
|
11,464
|
14,143
|
|
8,500
|
611
|
Commercial
lending
|
125,193
|
156,250
|
|
7,660
|
25,720
|
Investment portfolio
secured
|
16,697
|
24,485
|
|
1,458
|
2,086
|
Residential
mortgages
|
1,302,177
|
1,339,789
|
|
103,643
|
109,948
|
Mixed
collateral*
|
92,004
|
69,433
|
|
8,710
|
44,590
|
Unsecured**
|
19,358
|
14,364
|
|
26,056
|
36,535
|
At 31 December
|
2,064,217
|
2,036,077
|
|
450,539
|
471,078
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Concentration by location
|
|
|
|
|
|
East
Anglia
|
24,837
|
28,668
|
|
1,938
|
2,776
|
London
|
754,291
|
759,584
|
|
55,175
|
178,576
|
Midlands
|
102,907
|
86,442
|
|
12,433
|
4,778
|
North East
|
66,039
|
42,897
|
|
8,535
|
18
|
North West
|
84,675
|
94,341
|
|
11,342
|
3,531
|
Northern
Ireland
|
3,293
|
3,593
|
|
-
|
-
|
Scotland
|
13,555
|
20,220
|
|
50
|
-
|
South East
|
255,597
|
236,658
|
|
18,757
|
884
|
South West
|
181,286
|
179,034
|
|
9,646
|
5,273
|
Wales
|
14,621
|
15,174
|
|
2,007
|
5,001
|
Non-property
collateral
|
563,116
|
569,466
|
|
330,656
|
270,241
|
At 31 December
|
2,064,217
|
2,036,077
|
|
450,539
|
471,078
|
* Mixed collateral is where there is no single, overall
majority collateral type
** Included within
unsecured are £7.8m (2022: £9.0m) of loans which are backed by the
government guarantee scheme for BBLs.
(b) Operational risk
Operational risk is the risk that
the Group may be exposed to financial losses from conducting its
business. The Group's exposures to operational risk include its
Information Technology ("IT") and Operations platforms. There are
additional internal controls in these processes that are designed
to protect the Group from these risks. The Group's overall approach
to managing internal control and financial reporting is described
in the Corporate Governance section of the Annual
Report.
In line with further guidance
issued by the Regulator, the Bank has continued to focus on
ensuring that the design of systems and operational plans are
robust to maintain operational resilience in the face of unexpected
incidents.
Cyber risk
Cyber risk is an increasing risk
for the Group within its operational processes. It is the risk that
the Group is subject to some form of disruption arising from an
interruption to its IT and data infrastructure. The Group regularly
tests the infrastructure to ensure that it remains robust to a
range of threats and has continuity of business plans in place
including a disaster recovery plan.
Conduct risk
As a financial services provider
we face conduct risk, including selling products to customers which
do not meet their needs, failing to deal with clients' complaints
effectively, not meeting clients' expectations, and exhibiting
behaviours which do not meet market or regulatory
standards.
The Group adopts a low risk
appetite for any unfair customer outcomes. It maintains clear
compliance guidelines and provides ongoing training to all
employees. Periodic spot checks, compliance monitoring and internal
audits are performed to ensure these guidelines are followed. The
Group also has insurance policies in place to provide some cover
for any claims that may arise.
(c) Macroeconomic and competitive
environment
The Group is exposed to risks that
may arise from the macroeconomic and competitive
environment.
In recent years there have been a
number of global and domestic events which have had significant
implications on the Group's operating environment, namely: Russia's
War in the Ukraine, Coronavirus and Brexit. The culmination of
these events has led to significant turmoil in both global and
domestic markets. The most significant economic effect from these
events includes record inflation driven by high fuel costs, leading
to sharp and significant increases in the cost of borrowing.
Indicators suggest conditions have improved since the year end
however there still remains significant uncertainty around the
recovery of the UK economy which may have an impact on the group's
customers and assets.
Climate change
Climate change presents financial
and reputational risks for the banking industry. The Board consider
Climate change a material risk as per the Board approved risk
appetite framework which provides a structured approach to risk
taking within agreed boundaries. The assessment is proportional at
present but will develop over time as the Group generates further
resources and industry consensus emerges. The assessment is
maintained by the Chief Risk officer and has been informed by the
ICAAP review and workshops for employees.
Whilst it is difficult to assess
how climate change will unfold, the Group is continually assessing
various risk exposures. The UK has a legally binding target to cut
its greenhouse gas emissions to "net-zero" by 2050. There is
growing consensus that an orderly transition to a low-carbon
economy will bring substantial adjustments to the global economy
which will have financial implications while bringing risks and
opportunities.
The risk assessment process has
been integrated into existing risk frameworks and will be governed
through the various risk governance structures including review and
recommendations by the Arbuthnot Latham Risk Committee. Arbuthnot
Latham has been assessed against the Task Force on Climate-related
Financial Disclosures' ("TCFD") recommended disclosures and where
appropriate the FCA/PRA guidance as per the Supervisory
Statements.
In accordance with the
requirements of the PRA's Supervisory Statement 'Enhancing banks'
and insurers' approaches to managing the financial risks from
climate change', the Group has allocated responsibility for
identifying and managing the risks from climate change to the
relevant existing Senior Management Function. The Bank is
continuously developing a suitable strategic approach to climate
change and the unique challenges it poses.
The FCA have issued 'Climate
Change and Green Finance: summary of responses and next steps'. In
addition to the modelling of various scenarios and various
governance reviews, the Group will continue to monitor requirements
through the relationship with UK Finance.
(d) Market risk
Price risk
The Company and Group are exposed
to price risk from equity investments and derivatives held by the
Group. The Group is not exposed to commodity price risk.
Based upon the financial
investment exposure in Note 26, a stress test scenario of a 10%
(2022: 10%) decline in market prices, would result in a £Nil (2022:
£Nil) decrease in the Group's income and a decrease of £0.4m (2022:
£0.3m) in the Group's equity. The Group considers a 10% stress test
scenario appropriate after taking the current values and historic
data into account.
Based upon the financial
investment exposure given in Note 26, a stress test scenario of a
10% (2022: 10%) decline in market prices, would result in a £Nil
(2022: £Nil) decrease in the Company's income and a decrease of
£Nil (2022: £Nil) in the Company's equity.
Currency risk
The Company and Group take on
exposure to the effects of fluctuations in the prevailing foreign
currency exchange rates on its financial position and cash flows.
This is managed through the Group entering into forward foreign
exchange contracts. The Board sets limits on the level of exposure
for both overnight and intra-day positions, which are monitored
daily. The table below summarises the Group's exposure to foreign
currency exchange rate risk at 31 December 2023. Included in the
table below are the Group's assets and liabilities at carrying
amounts, categorised by currency.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GBP
(£)
|
USD
($)
|
Euro
(€)
|
Other
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
826,132
|
133
|
-
|
294
|
826,559
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
13,622
|
27,832
|
30,845
|
7,082
|
79,381
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
697,902
|
161,991
|
82,543
|
1
|
942,437
|
Assets classified as held for
sale
|
-
|
-
|
3,281
|
-
|
3,281
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
4,213
|
1
|
-
|
-
|
4,214
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
2,060,235
|
(139)
|
3,210
|
911
|
2,064,217
|
Other assets
|
19,129
|
-
|
3,232
|
-
|
22,361
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
3,942
|
-
|
-
|
3,942
|
|
3,621,233
|
193,760
|
123,111
|
8,288
|
3,946,392
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
193,410
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
193,410
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
1,020
|
1
|
-
|
11
|
1,032
|
Deposits from customers
|
3,453,720
|
190,052
|
108,053
|
7,742
|
3,759,567
|
Other liabilities
|
18,303
|
-
|
239
|
-
|
18,542
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
24,720
|
-
|
13,006
|
-
|
37,726
|
|
3,691,173
|
190,053
|
121,298
|
7,753
|
4,010,277
|
Net on-balance sheet
position
|
(69,940)
|
3,707
|
1,813
|
535
|
(63,885)
|
Credit commitments
|
450,539
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
450,539
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The table below summarises the
Group's exposure to foreign currency exchange risk at 31 December
2022:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GBP
(£)
|
USD
($)
|
Euro
(€)
|
Other
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
732,577
|
78
|
71
|
3
|
732,729
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
18,144
|
13,581
|
75,787
|
8,276
|
115,788
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
280,956
|
158,797
|
-
|
-
|
439,753
|
Assets classified as held for
sale
|
-
|
-
|
3,279
|
-
|
3,279
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
6,216
|
100
|
6
|
-
|
6,322
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
2,004,654
|
8,451
|
22,104
|
868
|
2,036,077
|
Other assets
|
13,657
|
-
|
503
|
-
|
14,160
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
3,404
|
-
|
-
|
3,404
|
|
3,056,204
|
184,411
|
101,750
|
9,147
|
3,351,512
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
236,026
|
-
|
-
|
1
|
236,027
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
7
|
107
|
8
|
13
|
135
|
Deposits from customers
|
2,814,786
|
180,483
|
87,787
|
9,494
|
3,092,550
|
Other liabilities
|
3,824
|
188
|
942
|
-
|
4,954
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
24,437
|
-
|
13,157
|
-
|
37,594
|
|
3,079,080
|
180,778
|
101,894
|
9,508
|
3,371,260
|
Net on-balance sheet
position
|
(22,876)
|
3,633
|
(144)
|
(361)
|
(19,748)
|
Credit commitments
|
471,078
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
471,078
|
Derivative financial instruments
(see Note 21) are in place to mitigate foreign currency risk on net
exposures for each currency. A 10% strengthening of the pound
against the US dollar would lead to a £11k increase (2022: £35k
decrease) in Group profits and equity, while a 10% weakening of the
pound against the US dollar would lead to the same decrease (2022:
increase) in Group profits and equity. Additionally, the Group
holds a property classified as asset held for sale and measured at
£3.3m (2022: £3.3m). The property is located in the EU and relates
to a Euro denominated loan where the property was repossessed and
is being held for sale. Including this Euro asset, the net Euro
exposure is positive £2.9m (2022: £3.3m).
The table below summarises the
Company's exposure to foreign currency exchange rate risk at 31
December 2023:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GBP
(£)
|
Euro
(€)
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
623
|
-
|
623
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
24,989
|
13,140
|
38,129
|
Other assets
|
1,391
|
-
|
1,391
|
|
27,003
|
13,140
|
40,143
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
1,796
|
-
|
1,796
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
24,720
|
13,006
|
37,726
|
|
26,517
|
13,006
|
39,522
|
Net on-balance sheet
position
|
487
|
134
|
621
|
|
|
|
|
The table below summarises the
Company's exposure to foreign currency exchange rate risk at 31
December 2022:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GBP
(£)
|
Euro
(€)
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
(4,737)
|
13,171
|
8,434
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
24,437
|
-
|
24,437
|
|
19,700
|
13,171
|
32,871
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
470
|
-
|
470
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
24,437
|
13,157
|
37,594
|
|
24,907
|
13,157
|
38,064
|
Net on-balance sheet
position
|
(5,207)
|
14
|
(5,193)
|
A 10% strengthening of the pound
against the Euro would lead to £12k increase (2022: £9k increase)
in the Company profits and equity, conversely a 10% weakening of
the pound against the Euro would lead to a £15k decrease (2022: £8k
decrease) in the Company profits and equity.
Interest rate risk
Interest rate risk is the
potential adverse impact on the Company and Group's future cash
flows from changes in interest rates, and arises from the differing
interest rate risk characteristics of the Company and Group's
assets and liabilities. In particular, fixed rate savings and
borrowing products expose the Group to the risk that a change in
interest rates could cause either a reduction in interest income or
an increase in interest expense relative to variable rate interest
flows. The Group seeks to "match" interest rate risk on both assets
and liabilities. However, this is not a perfect match and interest
rate risk is present in: Money market transactions of a fixed rate
nature, fixed rate loans, fixed rate savings accounts and floating
rate products dependent on when they re-price at a future
date.
Interest rate risk is measured
throughout the maturity bandings of the book on a parallel shift
scenario for a 200 basis points movement. The current position of
the balance sheet is such that it results in an favourable impact
on the economic value of equity of £2.8m (2022: adverse impact of
£0.3m) for a positive 200bps shift and an adverse impact of £3.3m
(2022: favourable impact of £0.3m) for a negative 200bps
movement.
The following tables summarise the
re-pricing periods for the assets and liabilities in the Company
and Group, including derivative financial instruments which are
principally used to reduce exposure to interest rate risk. Items
are allocated to time bands by reference to the earlier of the next
contractual interest rate re-price and the maturity
date.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
Within 3
months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 6 months
|
More
than 6 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
Non
interest bearing
|
Total
|
As at 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
826,559
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
826,559
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
79,381
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
79,381
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
352,617
|
220,504
|
286,309
|
83,007
|
-
|
-
|
942,437
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
4,214
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
4,214
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
1,717,677
|
19,485
|
50,758
|
256,348
|
7,120
|
12,829
|
2,064,217
|
Other assets*
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
423,090
|
423,090
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,942
|
3,942
|
|
2,980,448
|
239,989
|
337,067
|
339,355
|
7,120
|
439,861
|
4,343,840
|
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
193,410
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
193,410
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
1,032
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
1,032
|
Deposits from customers
|
2,789,024
|
420,826
|
477,639
|
66,328
|
5,750
|
-
|
3,759,567
|
Other liabilities**
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
99,665
|
99,665
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,726
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
37,726
|
Equity
|
50,236
|
8,609
|
12,275
|
121,802
|
15,051
|
44,467
|
252,440
|
|
3,071,428
|
429,435
|
489,914
|
188,130
|
20,801
|
144,132
|
4,343,840
|
Impact of derivative
instruments
|
61,220
|
-
|
-
|
(61,220)
|
-
|
-
|
|
Interest rate sensitivity
gap
|
(29,760)
|
(189,446)
|
(152,847)
|
90,005
|
(13,681)
|
295,729
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cumulative gap
|
(29,760)
|
(219,206)
|
(372,053)
|
(282,048)
|
(295,729)
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* Other assets include
all remaining assets in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
** Other liabilities include all
remaining liabilities in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
Within 3
months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 6 months
|
More
than 6 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
Non
interest bearing
|
Total
|
As at 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
732,728
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
732,728
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
115,737
|
51
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
115,788
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
334,700
|
13,301
|
85,752
|
6,000
|
-
|
-
|
439,753
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
6,322
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
6,322
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
1,814,805
|
15,785
|
38,073
|
146,119
|
5,633
|
15,662
|
2,036,077
|
Other assets
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
279,976
|
279,976
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,404
|
3,404
|
|
3,004,292
|
29,137
|
123,825
|
152,119
|
5,633
|
299,042
|
3,614,048
|
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
236,027
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
236,027
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
135
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
135
|
Deposits from customers
|
2,306,952
|
353,107
|
240,934
|
188,556
|
3,000
|
-
|
3,092,549
|
Other liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
35,764
|
35,764
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,594
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
37,594
|
Equity
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
211,979
|
211,979
|
|
2,580,708
|
353,107
|
240,934
|
188,556
|
3,000
|
247,743
|
3,614,048
|
Impact of derivative
instruments
|
51,376
|
-
|
-
|
(51,376)
|
-
|
-
|
|
Interest rate sensitivity
gap
|
474,960
|
(323,970)
|
(117,109)
|
(87,813)
|
2,633
|
51,299
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cumulative gap
|
474,960
|
150,990
|
33,881
|
(53,932)
|
(51,299)
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* Other assets include
all remaining assets in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
** Other liabilities include all
remaining liabilities in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Company
|
Within 3
months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 6 months
|
More
than 6 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
Non
interest bearing
|
Total
|
As at 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
7
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
7
|
Loans and advances to banks - due
from subsidiary
|
580
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
36
|
616
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
38,129
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
38,129
|
Other assets*
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
166,453
|
166,453
|
|
38,716
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
166,489
|
205,205
|
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities**
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
8,176
|
8,176
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,726
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
37,726
|
Equity
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
159,303
|
159,303
|
|
37,726
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
167,479
|
205,205
|
Interest rate sensitivity
gap
|
990
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(990)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cumulative gap
|
990
|
990
|
990
|
990
|
990
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* Other assets include
all remaining assets in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
** Other liabilities include all
remaining liabilities in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Company
|
Within 3
months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 6 months
|
More
than 6 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
Non
interest bearing
|
Total
|
As at 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
6
|
|
|
|
|
|
6
|
Loans and advances to banks - due
from subsidiary
|
8,377
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
50
|
8,427
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
24,437
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
24,437
|
Other assets*
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
160,081
|
160,081
|
|
32,820
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
160,131
|
192,951
|
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities**
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
4,369
|
4,369
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,594
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
37,594
|
Equity
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
150,988
|
150,988
|
|
37,594
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
155,357
|
192,951
|
Interest rate sensitivity
gap
|
(4,774)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
4,774
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cumulative gap
|
(4,774)
|
(4,774)
|
(4,774)
|
(4,774)
|
(4,774)
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* Other assets include
all remaining assets in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
** Other liabilities include all
remaining liabilities in the Statement of Financial Position, which
are not shown separately above.
|
(e) Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that
the Group, although solvent, either does not have sufficient
financial resources to enable it to meet its obligations as they
fall due, or can only secure such resources at excessive
cost.
The Group's approach to managing
liquidity is to ensure, as far as possible, that it will always
have sufficient liquidity to meet its liabilities when due, under
both normal and stressed conditions, without incurring unacceptable
losses or risking damage to the Group's reputation. The liquidity
requirements of the Group are met through withdrawing funds from
its Bank of England Reserve Account to cover any short-term
fluctuations and longer term funding to address any structural
liquidity requirements.
The Group has formal governance
structures in place to manage and mitigate liquidity risk on a day
to day basis. The Board of AL sets and approves the liquidity risk
management strategy. The Assets and Liabilities Committee ("ALCO"),
comprising senior executives of the Group, monitors liquidity risk.
Key liquidity risk management information is reported by the
finance teams and monitored by the Chief Executive Officer, Finance
Director and Deputy CEO on a daily basis. The ALCO meets monthly to
review liquidity risk against set thresholds and risk indicators
including early warning indicators, liquidity risk tolerance levels
and Internal Liquidity Adequacy Assessment Process ("ILAAP")
metrics.
The PRA requires the Board to
ensure that the Group has adequate levels of liquidity resources
and a prudent funding profile, and that it comprehensively manages
and controls liquidity and funding risks. The Group maintains
deposits placed at the Bank of England and highly liquid
unencumbered assets that can be called upon to create sufficient
liquidity to meet liabilities on demand, particularly in a period
of liquidity stress.
Arbuthnot Latham & Co.,
Limited ("AL") has a Board approved ILAAP, and maintains liquidity
buffers in excess of the minimum requirements. The ILAAP is
embedded in the risk management framework of the Group and is
subject to ongoing updates and revisions when necessary. At a
minimum, the ILAAP is updated annually. The Liquidity Coverage
Ratio ("LCR") regime has applied to the Group from 1 October 2015,
requiring management of net 30 day cash outflows as a proportion of
high quality liquid assets. The LCR has exceeded the regulatory
minimum of 100% throughout the year. There has been an increase in
deposits of 20%, which has accordingly improved the Bank's
liquidity.
The Group is exposed to daily
calls on its available cash resources from current accounts,
maturing deposits and loan draw-downs. The Group maintains
significant cash resources to meet all of these needs as they fall
due. The matching and controlled mismatching of the maturities and
interest rates of assets and liabilities is fundamental to the
management of the Group. It is unusual for banks to be completely
matched, as transacted business is often of uncertain term and of
different types.
The maturities of assets and
liabilities and the ability to replace, at an acceptable cost,
interest bearing liabilities as they mature are important factors
in assessing the liquidity of the Group and its exposure to changes
in interest rates.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The tables below show the
undiscounted contractual cash flows of the Group's financial
liabilities and assets as at 31 December 2023:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial liability by
type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
193,410
|
(212,267)
|
(5,904)
|
(7,481)
|
(198,882)
|
-
|
Deposits from customers
|
3,759,567
|
(3,831,717)
|
(2,877,406)
|
(879,887)
|
(68,351)
|
(6,073)
|
Other liabilities
|
18,542
|
(20,085)
|
(18,542)
|
-
|
-
|
(1,543)
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,726
|
(50,223)
|
(1,077)
|
(26,238)
|
(3,575)
|
(19,333)
|
Issued financial guarantee
contracts
|
-
|
(2,051)
|
(2,051)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Unrecognised loan
commitments
|
-
|
(450,539)
|
(450,539)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
|
4,009,245
|
(4,566,882)
|
(3,355,519)
|
(913,606)
|
(270,808)
|
(26,949)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Risk management:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- Outflows
|
1,032
|
(1,032)
|
(66)
|
-
|
(966)
|
-
|
|
1,032
|
(1,032)
|
(66)
|
-
|
(966)
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial asset by type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
826,559
|
826,559
|
826,559
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
79,381
|
79,381
|
79,381
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
942,437
|
954,382
|
356,957
|
513,922
|
83,503
|
-
|
Assets classified as held for
sale
|
3,281
|
3,281
|
-
|
3,281
|
-
|
-
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
2,064,217
|
2,497,314
|
477,308
|
281,451
|
1,595,366
|
143,189
|
Other assets
|
22,361
|
22,361
|
22,361
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Financial investments
|
3,942
|
3,942
|
3,942
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
|
3,942,178
|
4,387,220
|
1,766,508
|
798,654
|
1,678,869
|
143,189
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Risk management:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- Inflows
|
4,214
|
4,214
|
4
|
-
|
4,210
|
-
|
|
4,214
|
4,214
|
4
|
-
|
4,210
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The tables below show the
undiscounted contractual cash flows of the Group's financial
liabilities and assets as at 31 December 2022:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial liability by
type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks*
|
236,027
|
(236,027)
|
(11,027)
|
-
|
(225,000)
|
-
|
Deposits from
customers*
|
3,092,549
|
(3,164,453)
|
(2,329,095)
|
(758,870)
|
(76,488)
|
-
|
Other liabilities
|
4,954
|
(4,965)
|
(4,954)
|
-
|
-
|
(11)
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,594
|
(64,898)
|
(892)
|
(2,719)
|
(14,540)
|
(46,747)
|
Issued financial guarantee
contracts
|
-
|
(3,253)
|
(3,253)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Unrecognised loan
commitments
|
-
|
(470,870)
|
(470,870)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
|
3,371,124
|
(3,944,466)
|
(2,820,091)
|
(761,589)
|
(316,028)
|
(46,758)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Risk management:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- Outflows
|
135
|
(135)
|
(135)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
|
135
|
(135)
|
(135)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
* Prior year figures have been restated to present cash flows
on the same basis as maturity analysis in Note 5.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial asset by type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
732,728
|
732,728
|
732,728
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
115,788
|
115,788
|
115,788
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
439,753
|
443,409
|
336,299
|
101,110
|
6,000
|
-
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
2,036,077
|
2,520,811
|
505,691
|
276,657
|
1,285,151
|
453,312
|
Other assets
|
14,161
|
14,161
|
14,161
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Financial investments
|
3,404
|
3,404
|
3,404
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
|
3,341,911
|
3,830,301
|
1,708,071
|
377,767
|
1,291,151
|
453,312
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Risk management:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
- Inflows
|
6,322
|
6,322
|
113
|
-
|
6,209
|
-
|
|
6,322
|
6,322
|
113
|
-
|
6,209
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The table below sets out the
components of the Group's liquidity reserves:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31
December 2023
|
31
December 2022
|
|
|
|
Amount
|
Fair
value
|
Amount
|
Fair
value
|
Liquidity reserves
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
|
|
826,559
|
826,559
|
732,729
|
732,729
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
|
|
79,381
|
79,381
|
115,787
|
115,787
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
|
|
942,437
|
943,231
|
439,753
|
439,389
|
|
|
|
1,848,377
|
1,849,171
|
1,288,269
|
1,287,905
|
Assets pledged as collateral or
encumbered
The total financial assets
recognised in the statement of financial position that had been
pledged as collateral for liabilities at 31 December 2023 were
£253m (2022: £225m). Assets are encumbered due to the Term Funding
Scheme (Note 32).
Financial assets can be pledged as
collateral as part of repurchases transactions under terms that are
usual and customary for such activities.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The table below analyses the
contractual cash flows of the Company's financial liabilities and
assets as at 31 December 2023:
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial liability by
type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
1,796
|
(1,796)
|
(256)
|
-
|
-
|
(1,540)
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,726
|
(50,223)
|
(1,077)
|
(26,238)
|
(3,575)
|
(19,333)
|
|
39,522
|
(52,019)
|
(1,333)
|
(26,238)
|
(3,575)
|
(20,873)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial asset by type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
623
|
623
|
623
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
38,129
|
50,356
|
1,080
|
26,247
|
3,632
|
19,397
|
|
38,752
|
50,979
|
1,703
|
26,247
|
3,632
|
19,397
|
The table below analyses the
contractual cash flows of the Company's financial liabilities and
assets as at 31 December 2022:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial liability by
type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
470
|
(470)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(470)
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,594
|
(64,898)
|
(892)
|
(2,719)
|
(14,540)
|
(46,747)
|
|
38,064
|
(65,368)
|
(892)
|
(2,719)
|
(14,540)
|
(47,217)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying
amount
|
Gross
inflow/ (outflow)
|
Not more
than 3 months
|
More
than 3 months but less than 1 year
|
More
than 1 year but less than 5 years
|
More
than 5 years
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Financial asset by type
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-derivative assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
8,433
|
8,433
|
8,433
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
24,437
|
43,404
|
732
|
2,238
|
11,975
|
28,459
|
|
32,870
|
51,837
|
9,165
|
2,238
|
11,975
|
28,459
|
The maturities of assets and
liabilities and the ability to replace, at an acceptable cost,
interest-bearing liabilities as they mature are important factors
in assessing the liquidity of the Group and its exposure to changes
in interest rates and exchange rates.
Fiduciary activities
The Group provides investment
management and advisory services to third parties, which involve
the Group making allocation and purchase and sale decisions in
relation to a wide range of financial instruments. Those assets
that are held in a fiduciary capacity are not included in these
financial statements, because the assets do not meet the
recognition criteria. These services give rise to the risk that the
Group may be accused of maladministration or underperformance. At
the balance sheet date, the Group had investment management
accounts amounting to approximately £1.7bn (2022: £1.3bn).
Additionally, the Group provides investment advisory
services.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(f) Financial assets and liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The tables below set out the
Group's financial assets and financial liabilities into their
respective classifications:
|
|
|
|
|
|
FVPL
|
FVOCI
|
Amortised cost
|
Total
carrying amount
|
Fair
value
|
At 31 December 2023
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
826,559
|
826,559
|
826,559
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
79,381
|
79,381
|
79,381
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
942,437
|
942,437
|
943,231
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
|
|
|
|
4,214
|
-
|
-
|
4,214
|
4,214
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
2,064,217
|
2,064,217
|
2,058,780
|
Other assets
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
22,361
|
22,361
|
22,361
|
Financial investments
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
3,942
|
-
|
3,942
|
3,942
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,214
|
3,942
|
3,934,955
|
3,943,111
|
3,938,468
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
193,410
|
193,410
|
193,410
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
|
|
|
|
1,032
|
-
|
-
|
1,032
|
1,032
|
Deposits from customers
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
3,759,567
|
3,759,567
|
3,759,567
|
Other liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
18,542
|
18,542
|
18,542
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,032
|
-
|
4,009,245
|
4,010,277
|
4,010,277
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FVPL
|
FVOCI
|
Amortised cost
|
Total
carrying amount
|
Fair
value
|
At 31 December 2022
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
732,729
|
732,729
|
732,729
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
115,787
|
115,787
|
115,788
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
439,753
|
439,753
|
439,389
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
|
|
|
|
6,322
|
-
|
-
|
6,322
|
6,322
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
2,036,077
|
2,036,077
|
1,996,966
|
Other assets
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
14,160
|
14,160
|
14,160
|
Financial investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,404
|
-
|
3,404
|
3,404
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,322
|
3,404
|
3,338,506
|
3,348,232
|
3,308,758
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
236,027
|
236,027
|
236,027
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
|
|
|
|
135
|
-
|
-
|
135
|
135
|
Deposits from customers
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
3,092,549
|
3,092,549
|
3,092,549
|
Other liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
4,954
|
4,954
|
4,954
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
|
|
|
|
|
135
|
-
|
3,371,124
|
3,371,259
|
3,371,259
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The tables below set out the
Company's financial assets and financial liabilities into their
respective classifications:
|
|
|
|
|
|
FVPL
|
FVOCI
|
Amortised cost
|
Total
carrying amount
|
Fair
value
|
At 31 December 2023
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
623
|
623
|
623
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
38,129
|
38,129
|
38,129
|
Other assets
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
1,391
|
1,391
|
1,391
|
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
40,143
|
40,143
|
40,143
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
1,796
|
1,796
|
1,796
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
39,522
|
39,522
|
39,522
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FVPL
|
FVOCI
|
Amortised cost
|
Total
carrying amount
|
Fair
value
|
At 31 December 2022
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
8,433
|
8,433
|
8,433
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
24,437
|
24,437
|
24,437
|
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
32,870
|
32,870
|
32,870
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
470
|
470
|
470
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
|
|
|
|
|
-
|
-
|
38,064
|
38,064
|
38,064
|
Valuation of financial instruments
The Group measures the fair value
of an instrument using quoted prices in an active market for that
instrument. A market is regarded as active if quoted prices are
readily and regularly available and represent actual and regularly
occurring market transactions. If a market for a financial
instrument is not active, the Group establishes fair value using a
valuation technique. These include the use of recent arm's length
transactions, reference to other instruments that are substantially
the same for which market observable prices exist, net present
value and discounted cash flow analysis. The objective of valuation
techniques is to determine the fair value of the financial
instrument at the reporting date as the price that would be
received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an
orderly transaction between market participants.
The Group measures fair value
using the following fair value hierarchy that reflects the
significance of the inputs used in making measurements:
•
Level 1: Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or
liabilities.
•
Level 2: Inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1
that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly
(i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices). This
category includes instruments valued using: quoted market prices in
active markets for similar instruments; quoted prices for identical
or similar instruments in markets that are considered less than
active; or other valuation techniques in which all significant
inputs are directly or indirectly observable from market
data.
•
Level 3: Inputs that are unobservable. This category includes all
instruments for which the valuation technique includes inputs not
based on observable data and the unobservable inputs have a
significant effect on the instrument's valuation. This category
includes instruments that are valued based on quoted prices for
similar instruments for which significant unobservable adjustments
or assumptions are required to reflect differences between the
instruments.
The consideration of factors such
as the magnitude and frequency of trading activity, the
availability of prices and the size of bid/offer spreads assists in
the judgement as to whether a market is active. If, in the opinion
of management, a significant proportion of the instrument's
carrying amount is driven by unobservable inputs, the instrument in
its entirety is classified as valued using significant unobservable
inputs. 'Unobservable' in this context means that there is little
or no current market data available from which to determine the
level at which an arm's length transaction would be likely to
occur. It generally does not mean that there is no market data
available at all upon which to base a determination of fair value
(consensus pricing data may, for example, be used).
The tables below
analyse assets and liabilities measured at
fair value by the level in the fair value hierarchy into which the
measurement is categorised:
|
Level
1
|
Level
2
|
Level
3
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
-
|
4,214
|
-
|
4,214
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
-
|
3,942
|
3,942
|
|
-
|
4,214
|
3,942
|
8,156
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
-
|
1,032
|
-
|
1,032
|
|
-
|
1,032
|
-
|
1,032
|
|
Level
1
|
Level
2
|
Level
3
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
-
|
6,322
|
-
|
6,322
|
Financial investments
|
-
|
-
|
3,404
|
3,404
|
|
-
|
6,322
|
3,404
|
9,726
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
-
|
135
|
-
|
135
|
|
-
|
135
|
-
|
135
|
There were no transfers between
level 1 and level 2 during the year.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For assets which are accounted at
fair value under Level 3 the valuations are primarily based on Fund
Manager valuations and are based on reasonable estimates. Applying
reasonable alternative valuations would not lead to a significantly
different fair value. The following table reconciles the movement
in level 3 financial instruments measured at fair value during the
year:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Movement in level 3
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January
|
|
|
3,404
|
3,169
|
Purchases
|
|
|
177
|
53
|
Disposals
|
|
|
(51)
|
(640)
|
Movements recognised in Other
Comprehensive Income
|
|
|
412
|
822
|
At 31 December
|
|
|
3,942
|
3,404
|
Visa Inc. investment
Arbuthnot Latham currently holds
preference shares in Visa Inc., valued at £2.4m (2022: £2.0m) as at
31 December 2023. These shares have been valued at their future
conversion value into Visa Inc. common stock.
In 2020, as part of the fourth
anniversary of the closing of the Visa Europe transaction, an
assessment was performed of the ongoing risk of liability to Visa.
As part of the adjustment, Visa awarded the Group 59 preference
shares with a carrying value of £920k. In 2022 Visa awarded the
Group extra 28 preference shares with a carrying value of £501k.
These can be automatically converted into freely tradeable Class A
common stock.
There is a haircut of 31% on the
original shares comprising 25% due to a contingent liability
disclosed in Visa Europe's accounts in relation to litigation and
6% based on a liquidity discount.
The haircut is classified as a
significant unobservable input. Management have assessed that
should the haircut increase by 5 percentage points this would
impact equity by £46k and an increase of 10 percentage points would
impact equity by £92k.
Hetz Ventures, L.P.
Arbuthnot Latham currently holds
an equity investment in Hetz Ventures, L.P. which was launched in
January 2018. The primary objective was to generate attractive
risk-adjusted returns for its Partners, principally through
long-term capital appreciation, by making, holding and disposing of
equity and equity-related investments in early stage revenue
generating Israeli technology companies, primarily in cyber,
fin-tech and the disruptive software sectors. The company has
committed to a capital contribution of USD2.5m of the total closing
fund capital of USD132.5m. At 31 December 2023 Arbuthnot Latham
& Co., Ltd had made capital contributions into the Fund of
USD2.0m (2022: USD1.8m).
The investment is classified as
FVOCI and is valued at fair value by Hetz Ventures, L.P. at £1.5m
(2022: £1.4m). As at year end the fair value is deemed to be the
Group's share of the fund based on what a third party would pay for
the underlying investments.
The fair values provided by the
Hetz Ventures funds are classified as significant unobservable
inputs. Management have assessed that should the fund valuation
decrease by 5% this would impact equity by £77k and a reduction of
10% would impact equity by £153k.
The tables below show the fair
value of financial instruments carried at amortised cost by the
level in the fair value hierarchy:
Group
|
Level
1
|
Level
2
|
Level
3
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
-
|
826,559
|
-
|
826,559
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
-
|
79,381
|
-
|
79,381
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
943,231
|
-
|
943,231
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
-
|
-
|
2,058,780
|
2,058,780
|
Other assets
|
-
|
-
|
22,361
|
22,361
|
|
-
|
1,849,171
|
2,081,141
|
3,930,312
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
-
|
193,410
|
-
|
193,410
|
Deposits from customers
|
-
|
3,759,567
|
-
|
3,759,567
|
Other liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
18,542
|
18,542
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
-
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
|
-
|
3,952,977
|
56,268
|
4,009,245
|
Group
|
Level
1
|
Level
2
|
Level
3
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
-
|
732,729
|
-
|
732,729
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
-
|
115,788
|
-
|
115,788
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
439,389
|
-
|
439,389
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
-
|
-
|
1,996,966
|
1,996,966
|
Other assets
|
-
|
-
|
14,160
|
14,160
|
|
-
|
1,287,906
|
2,011,126
|
3,299,032
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
-
|
236,027
|
-
|
236,027
|
Deposits from customers
|
-
|
3,092,549
|
-
|
3,092,549
|
Other liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
4,954
|
4,954
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
-
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
|
-
|
3,328,576
|
42,548
|
3,371,124
|
|
|
|
|
|
Company
|
Level
1
|
Level
2
|
Level
3
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
-
|
7
|
616
|
623
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
38,129
|
-
|
38,129
|
|
-
|
38,136
|
616
|
38,752
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
1,796
|
1,796
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
-
|
37,726
|
37,726
|
|
-
|
-
|
39,522
|
39,522
|
Company
|
Level
1
|
Level
2
|
Level
3
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
-
|
6
|
8,427
|
8,433
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
-
|
24,437
|
-
|
24,437
|
|
-
|
24,443
|
8,427
|
32,870
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Other liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
470
|
470
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
-
|
-
|
37,594
|
37,594
|
|
-
|
-
|
38,064
|
38,064
|
All above assets and liabilities
are carried at amortised cost. Therefore for these assets, the fair
value hierarchy noted above relates to the disclosure in this note
only.
Cash and balances at central banks
The fair value of cash and
balances at central banks was calculated based upon the present
value of the expected future principal and interest cash flows. The
rate used to discount the cash flows was the market rate of
interest at the balance sheet date.
At the end of each year, the fair
value of cash and balances at central banks was calculated to be
equivalent to their carrying value.
Loans and advances to banks
The fair value of loans and
advances to banks was calculated based upon the present value of
the expected future principal and interest cash flows. The rate
used to discount the cash flows was the market rate of interest at
the balance sheet date.
Loans and advances to customers
The fair value of loans and
advances to customers was calculated based upon the present value
of the expected future principal and interest cash flows. The rate
used to discount the cash flows was the market rate of interest at
the balance sheet date, and the same assumptions regarding the risk
of default were applied as those used to derive the carrying
value.
The Group provides loans and
advances to commercial, corporate and personal customers at both
fixed and variable rates. To determine the fair value of loans and
advances to customers, loans are segregated into portfolios of
similar characteristics. A number of techniques are used to
estimate the fair value of fixed rate lending; these take account
of expected credit losses based on historic trends and expected
future cash flows.
For the acquired loan book, the
discount on acquisition is used to determine the fair value in
addition to the expected credit losses and expected future cash
flows.
Debt securities at amortised cost
The fair value of debt securities
is based on the quoted mid-market share price.
Derivatives
Where derivatives are traded on an
exchange, the fair value is based on prices from the
exchange.
Deposits from banks
The fair value of amounts due to
banks was calculated based upon the present value of the expected
future principal and interest cash flows. The rate used to discount
the cash flows was the market rate of interest at the balance sheet
date.
At the end of each year, the fair
value of amounts due to banks was calculated to be equivalent to
their carrying value due to the short maturity term of the amounts
due.
Deposits from customers
The fair value of deposits from
customers was calculated based upon the present value of the
expected future principal and interest cash flows. The rate used to
discount the cash flows was the market rate of interest at the
balance sheet date for the notice deposits and deposit bonds. The
fair value of instant access deposits is equal to book value as
they are repayable on demand.
Financial liabilities
The fair value of other financial
liabilities was calculated based upon the present value of the
expected future principal cash flows.
At the end of each year, the fair
value of other financial liabilities was calculated to be
equivalent to their carrying value due to their short maturity. The
other financial liabilities include all other liabilities other
than non-interest accruals.
Debt Securities in Issue
The fair value of debt securities
in issue was calculated based upon the present value of the
expected future principal cash flows.
7. Capital management (unaudited)
The Group's capital management
policy is focused on optimising shareholder value. There is a clear
focus on delivering organic growth and ensuring capital resources
are sufficient to support planned levels of growth. The Board
regularly reviews the capital position.
The Group and the individual
banking operation, are authorised by the Prudential Regulation
Authority ("PRA") and regulated by the Financial Conduct Authority
and the Prudential Regulation Authority and are subject to the
Capital Requirement Regulation (EU No.575/2013) ("CRR"), which
forms part of the retained EU legislation, and the PRA Rulebook for
CRR firms. One of the requirements for the Group and the individual
banking operation is that capital resources must be in excess of
capital requirements at all times.
In accordance with the parameters
set out in the PRA Rulebook, the Internal Capital Adequacy
Assessment Process ("ICAAP") is embedded in the risk management
framework of the Group. The ICAAP identifies and assesses the risks
to the Group, considers how these risks can be mitigated and
demonstrates that the Group has sufficient resources, after
mitigating actions, to withstand all reasonable
scenarios.
Not all material risks can be
mitigated by capital, but where capital is appropriate the Board
has adopted a "Pillar 1 plus" approach to determine the level of
capital the Group needs to hold. This method takes the Pillar 1
capital requirement for credit, market and operational risk as a
starting point, and then considers whether each of the calculations
delivers a sufficient amount of capital to cover risks to which the
Group is, or could be, exposed. Where the Board considers that the
Pillar 1 calculations do not adequately cover the risks, an
additional Pillar 2A capital requirement is applied. The PRA will
set a Pillar 2A capital requirement in light of the calculations
included within the ICAAP. The Group's Total Capital Requirement,
as issued by the PRA, is the sum of the Pillar 1 and the Pillar 2A
capital requirements. The current Total Capital Requirement of the
Group is 8.32%.
The Group's regulatory capital is
divided into two tiers:
• Common equity Tier 1 which
comprises shareholder funds less regulatory deductions for
intangible assets, including goodwill, and deferred tax assets that
do not arise from temporary differences.
• Tier 2
comprises qualifying subordinated loans.
The following table shows the
regulatory capital resources as managed by the Group:
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
CET1 Capital
|
|
|
Share capital
|
167
|
154
|
Share premium
|
11,606
|
-
|
Capital redemption
reserve
|
19
|
19
|
Treasury shares
|
(1,299)
|
(1,299)
|
Retained earnings*
|
240,606
|
212,037
|
IFRS 9 - Transitional add
back
|
265
|
523
|
Fair value reserve
|
1,341
|
1,067
|
Deduction for goodwill
|
(5,202)
|
(5,202)
|
Deduction for other
intangibles
|
(24,385)
|
(27,347)
|
Deduction for deferred tax asset
that do not arise from temporary differences
|
(818)
|
(4,567)
|
Deduction for Prudent
valuation
|
(9)
|
(10)
|
CET1 capital resources
|
222,291
|
175,375
|
Tier 2 Capital
|
|
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
37,726
|
37,594
|
Total Tier 2 capital
resources
|
37,726
|
37,594
|
|
|
|
Own Funds (sum of Tier 1 and Tier
2)
|
260,017
|
212,969
|
|
|
|
CET1 Capital Ratio (CET1
Capital/Total Risk Exposure)*
|
13.0%
|
11.6%
|
Total Capital Ratio (Own
Funds/Total Risk Exposure)*
|
15.2%
|
14.0%
|
*
Includes current year audited profit.
Capital ratios are reviewed on a
monthly basis to ensure that external requirements are adhered to.
During the period all regulated entities have complied with all of
the externally imposed capital requirements to which they are
subject.
Pillar 3 complements the minimum
capital requirements (Pillar 1) and the supervisory review process
(Pillar 2). Its aim is to encourage market discipline by developing
a set of disclosure requirements which will allow market
participants to assess key pieces of information on a firm's
capital resources, risk exposures and risk assessment processes.
Our Pillar 3 disclosures for the year ended 31 December
2023 are published as a
separate document on the Group's website under Investor
Relations.
8. Net interest income
Interest income and expense are
recognised in the Statement of Comprehensive Income for all
instruments measured at amortised cost using the effective interest
rate ("EIR") method.
The effective interest rate is the
rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash payments or
receipts through the expected life of the financial instrument
to:
•
the gross carrying amount of the financial asset; or
•
the amortised cost of the financial liability.
The 'gross carrying amount of a
financial asset' is the amortised cost of a financial asset before
adjusting for any expected credit loss allowance. When calculating
the effective interest rate, the Group takes into account all
contractual terms of the financial instrument but does not consider
expected credit losses.
The calculation includes all fees
paid or received between parties to the contract that are an
integral part of the effective interest rate, transaction costs and
all other premiums or discounts. The carrying amount of the
financial asset or financial liability is adjusted if the Group
revises its estimates of payments or receipts. The adjusted
carrying amount is calculated based on the original effective
interest rate and the change in carrying amount is recorded as
interest income or expense.
For financial assets that have
become credit impaired following initial recognition, interest
income is calculated by applying the effective interest rate to the
amortised cost of the financial asset. If the asset is no longer
credit impaired, then the calculation of interest income reverts to
the gross basis.
The Group monitors the actual cash
flows for each acquired book and where they diverge significantly
from expectation, the future cash flows are reset. Expectation may
diverge due to factors such as one-off payments or expected credit
losses. In assessing whether to adjust future cash flows on an
acquired portfolio, the Group considers the cash variance on an
absolute and percentage basis. The Group also considers the total
variance across all acquired portfolios. Where cash flows for an
acquired portfolio are reset, they are discounted at the EIR to
derive a new carrying value, with changes taken to the Statement of
Comprehensive Income as interest income. The EIR rate is adjusted
for events where there is a change to the reference interest rate
(e.g. Bank of England base rate) affecting portfolios with a
variable interest rate which will impact future cash flows. The
revised EIR is the rate which exactly discounts the revised cash
flows to the net carrying value of the loan portfolio.
Net interest income is analysed as
follows.
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
|
|
34,275
|
8,681
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
|
|
4,990
|
6
|
Debt securities at amortised
cost
|
|
|
29,929
|
6,374
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
|
|
162,642
|
104,952
|
Total interest income
|
|
|
231,836
|
120,013
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks
|
|
|
(9,032)
|
(3,334)
|
Deposits from customers
|
|
|
(80,413)
|
(14,243)
|
Debt securities in
issue
|
|
|
(4,506)
|
(2,723)
|
Interest on lease
liabilities
|
|
|
(1,266)
|
(632)
|
Total interest expense
|
|
|
(95,217)
|
(20,932)
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net interest income
|
|
|
136,619
|
99,081
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9. Fee and commission income
Fee and commission income which is
integral to the EIR of a financial asset are included in the
effective interest rate (see Note 8).
All other fee and commission
income is recognised as the related services are performed, under
IFRS 15, revenues from Contracts with Customers. Fee and commission
income is reported in the below segments.
Types of fee
|
Description
|
Banking commissions
|
- Banking Tariffs are charged
monthly for services provided.
|
Investment management
fees
|
- Annual asset management fees
relate to a single performance
obligation that is
continuously provided over an extended
period of time.
|
Wealth planning fees
|
- Provision of bespoke,
independent Wealth Planning
solutions to Arbuthnot
Latham's clients. Fees are recognised
as the service is
performed.
|
Foreign exchange fees
|
- Provides foreign currencies for
our clients to purchase/sell.
|
The principles in applying IFRS 15
to fee and commission use the following 5 step model:
•
identify the contract(s) with a customer;
•
identify the performance obligations in the contract;
•
determine the transaction price;
•
allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations in
the contract; and
•
recognise revenue when or as the Group satisfies its performance
obligations.
Asset and other management,
advisory and service fees are recognised, under IFRS 15, as the
related services are performed. The same principle is applied for
wealth planning services that are continuously provided over an
extended period of time.
The Group includes the transaction
price of variable consideration only when it is highly probable
that a significant reversal in the amount recognised will not occur
or when the variable element becomes certain.
Fee and commission income is
disaggregated below and includes a total for fees in scope of IFRS
15:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
Banking
|
Wealth
Management
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
All
other divisions
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Banking commissions
|
1,621
|
-
|
45
|
6,911
|
13
|
1,022
|
9,612
|
Foreign exchange fees
|
1,307
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
886
|
2,193
|
Investment management
fees
|
-
|
10,909
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
10,909
|
Wealth planning fees
|
-
|
456
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
456
|
Total fee and commission
income
|
2,928
|
11,365
|
45
|
6,911
|
13
|
1,908
|
23,170
|
Group
|
Banking
|
Wealth
Management
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
All
other divisions
|
Total
|
At 31 December 2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Banking and services
fees
|
2,233
|
-
|
32
|
6,178
|
10
|
405
|
8,858
|
Foreign exchange fees
|
1,296
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
840
|
2,136
|
Investment management
fees
|
-
|
10,285
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
10,285
|
Wealth planning fees
|
-
|
307
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
307
|
Total fee and commission
income
|
3,529
|
10,592
|
32
|
6,178
|
10
|
1,245
|
21,586
|
10. Gross profit from leasing
activities
Accounting for operating lease and related
income:
The statement of comprehensive
income is credited with:
•
Income from operating leases recognised on a straight-line basis
over the period of the lease.
•
The sales proceeds from the sale of vehicles at the end of
operating lease agreements, when a vehicle is transferred to a
buyer, and the buyer obtains control of the vehicle.
•
Income from service and maintenance contracts recognised on a
straight-line method.
Revenue from service and
maintenance contracts is recognised in accordance with the
principles of IFRS 15, Revenue from contracts with customers.
Payments from customers for service and maintenance contracts are
deferred on the balance sheet until the point they are recognised
and when the performance obligations are met.
Revenue is the aggregate of
operating lease income and service and maintenance contracts.
Revenue also includes the sales proceeds from the sale of vehicles
at the end of operating lease agreements and other returned
vehicles. Amounts recognised within gross profit from leasing
activities in the statement of comprehensive income are set out
below:
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
|
|
Income from lease or rental of
commercial vehicles
|
57,529
|
42,456
|
Sale of commercial
vehicles
|
31,440
|
44,385
|
Income from service and
maintenance contracts
|
11,244
|
12,088
|
Other income
|
739
|
438
|
Revenue
|
100,952
|
99,367
|
|
|
|
Depreciation and rental costs of
commercial vehicles held for lease or rent
|
(40,367)
|
(31,218)
|
Carrying amount of vehicles
disposed
|
(29,772)
|
(38,259)
|
Service & maintenance
cost
|
(10,935)
|
(12,632)
|
Cost of goods sold
|
(81,074)
|
(82,109)
|
|
|
|
Gross profit from leasing
activities
|
19,878
|
17,258
|
|
|
|
11. Net impairment loss on financial
assets
(a) Assets carried at amortised cost
The Group recognises loss
allowances on an expected credit loss basis for all financial
assets measured at amortised cost, including loans and advances,
debt securities and loan commitments.
Credit loss allowances are
measured as an amount equal to lifetime ECL, except for the
following assets, for which they are measured as 12 month
ECL:
•
Financial assets determined to have a low credit risk at the
reporting date. The assets, to which the low credit risk exemption
applies, include cash and balances at central banks (Note 17),
loans and advances to banks (Note 18) and debt securities at
amortised cost (Note 19). These assets are all considered
investment grade.
•
Financial assets which have not experienced a significant increase
in credit risk since their initial recognition.
Impairment model
The IFRS 9 impairment model adopts
a three stage approach based on the extent of credit deterioration
since origination:
•
Stage 1: 12‐month ECL applies to all financial assets that have not
experienced a significant increase in credit risk ("SICR") since
origination and are not credit impaired. The ECL will be computed
based on the probability of default events occurring over the next
12 months. Stage 1 includes the current performing loans (up to
date and in arrears of less than 10 days) and those within
Heightened Business Monitoring ("HBM"). Accounts requiring HBM are
classified as a short-term deterioration in financial circumstances
and are tightly monitored with additional proactive client
engagement, but not deemed SICR.
• Stage 2: When a financial asset experiences a SICR subsequent
to origination, but is not in default, it is considered to be in
Stage 2. This requires the computation of ECL based on the
probability of all possible default events occurring over the
remaining life of the financial asset. Provisions are higher in
this stage (except where the value of charge against the financial
asset is sufficient to enable recovery in full) because of an
increase in credit risk and the impact of a longer time horizon
being considered (compared to 12 months in Stage 1).
Evidence that a financial asset
has experienced a SICR includes the following
considerations:
• A
loan is in arrears between 31 and 90 days;
•
Forbearance action has been undertaken;
•
Any additional reasons whereby the Probability of Default is
considered to have increased significantly since inception of the
facility.
•
Stage 3: Financial assets that are credit impaired are included in
this stage. Similar to Stage 2, the allowance for credit losses
will continue to capture the lifetime expected credit losses. At
each reporting date, the Group will assess whether financial assets
carried at amortised cost are in default. A financial asset will be
considered to be in default when an event(s) that has a detrimental
impact on estimated future cash flows have occurred.
Evidence that a financial asset is
within Stage 3 includes the following data:
• A
loan is in arrears in excess of 90 days;
•
Breach of terms of forbearance;
•
Recovery action is in hand; or
•
Bankruptcy proceedings or similar insolvency process of a client,
or director of a company.
The credit risk of financial
assets that become credit impaired are not expected to improve,
beyond the extent that they are no longer considered to be credit
impaired.
A borrower will move back into
Stage 1 conditional upon both a minimum of six months' good account
conduct and the improvement of the Client's situation to the extent
that the credit risk has receded sufficiently and a full repayment
of the loan, without recourse to the collateral, is
likely.
Presentation of allowance for ECL in the statement of
financial position
For financial assets measured at
amortised cost, these are presented as the gross carrying amount of
the assets minus a deduction for the ECL.
Write-off
Loans and debt securities are
written off (either partially or in full) when there is no
realistic prospect of recovery. This is the case when the Group
determines that the borrower does not have assets or sources of
income that could generate sufficient cash flows to repay the
outstanding amount due.
(b) Renegotiated loans
Renegotiated loans are
derecognised if the new terms are significantly different to the
original agreement. Loans that have been modified to such an extent
the renegotiated loan is a substantially different to the original
loan, are no longer considered to be past due and are treated as
new loans.
(c) Forbearance
Under certain circumstances, the
Group may use forbearance measures to assist borrowers who are
experiencing significant financial hardship. Any forbearance
support is assessed on a case by case basis in line with best
practice and subject to regular monitoring and review. The Group
seeks to ensure that any forbearance results in a fair outcome for
both the customer and the Group.
(d) Assets classified as financial
investments
Equity instruments at fair value through other comprehensive
income
Equity investments are not subject
to impairment charges recognised in the income statement. Any fair
value gains and losses are recognised in OCI which are not subject
to reclassification to the income statement on
derecognition.
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Net Impairment losses /
(reversals) on financial assets
|
3,191
|
5,503
|
|
|
|
Of which:
|
|
|
Stage 1
|
(279)
|
1,078
|
Stage 2
|
299
|
53
|
Stage 3
|
3,301
|
4,231
|
Impairment losses /
(reversals) on financial investments
|
(130)
|
142
|
|
3,191
|
5,503
|
|
|
|
During the year, the Group
recovered £24k (2022: £55k) of loans which had previously been
written off.
|
12. Other income
Included in other income is £0.9m
recognised on a non-refundable deposit from a property owned by the
Group and £0.4m in relation to a negligent property
valuation.
Other items reflected in other
income include rental income from the investment property of £0.7m
(2022: £0.9m).
Accounting for rental income
Rental income is recognised on a
straight line basis over the term of the lease. Lease incentives
granted are recognised as an integral part of the total rental
income over the term of the lease.
13. Operating expenses
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Operating expenses
comprise:
|
£000
|
£000
|
Staff costs, including
Directors:
|
|
|
Wages, salaries and
bonuses
|
68,414
|
61,359
|
Social security
costs
|
7,960
|
7,534
|
Pension costs
|
3,335
|
2,861
|
Share based payment
transactions (Note 40)
|
222
|
(18)
|
Amortisation of intangibles (Note
28)
|
4,924
|
4,026
|
Depreciation (Note 29,
30)
|
4,635
|
1,772
|
Profit on disposals of property,
plant and equipment
|
(15)
|
(9)
|
Financial Services Compensation
Scheme Levy
|
240
|
174
|
Charitable donations
|
70
|
118
|
Expenses relating to short-term
leases
|
635
|
550
|
Write down of repossessed and
commercial properties
|
2,616
|
647
|
Other administrative
expenses
|
38,077
|
30,017
|
Total operating expenses from
continuing operations
|
131,113
|
109,031
|
Details on Directors remuneration
are disclosed in the Remuneration Report on page 56.
|
2023
|
2022
|
Remuneration of the auditor and
its associates, excluding VAT, was as follows:
|
£000
|
£000
|
Fees payable to the Company's
auditor for the audit of the Company's annual accounts
|
131
|
123
|
Audit of the accounts of
subsidiaries
|
591
|
564
|
Audit related assurance
services
|
121
|
116
|
Total fees payable
|
843
|
803
|
14. Income tax expense
Current income tax which is
payable on taxable profits is recognised as an expense in the
period in which the profits arise. Income tax recoverable on tax
allowable losses is recognised as an asset only to the extent that
it is regarded as recoverable by offset against current or future
taxable profits.
|
2023
|
2022
|
United Kingdom corporation tax at
23.5% (2022: 19%)
|
£000
|
£000
|
Current taxation
|
|
|
Corporation tax charge - current
year
|
4,650
|
3,769
|
Corporation tax charge -
adjustments in respect of prior years
|
25
|
246
|
|
4,675
|
4,015
|
Deferred taxation
|
|
|
Origination and reversal of
temporary differences
|
7,152
|
286
|
Adjustments in respect of prior
years
|
(89)
|
(750)
|
|
7,063
|
(464)
|
Income tax expense
|
11,738
|
3,551
|
Tax reconciliation
|
|
|
Profit before tax
|
47,117
|
20,009
|
Tax at 23.5% (2022:
19%)
|
11,073
|
3,802
|
Other permanent
differences
|
297
|
(225)
|
Tax rate change
|
433
|
477
|
Prior period
adjustments
|
(65)
|
(503)
|
Corporation tax charge for the
year
|
11,738
|
3,551
|
Prior year permanent differences
predominantly due to the disallowed costs on the sale of the King
Street property and Super Deduction allowances.
In the Budget speech on 3 March
2021, the Chancellor of the Exchequer, announced the increase of
corporation tax from 19% to 25% from 1 April 2023, which was
enacted on 10 June 2021.
15. Average number of employees
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Banking
|
254
|
251
|
RAF
|
47
|
37
|
ACABL
|
31
|
28
|
ASFL
|
1
|
9
|
AAG
|
138
|
125
|
All Other Divisions
|
310
|
250
|
Group Centre
|
18
|
18
|
|
799
|
718
|
Accounting for employee benefits
(a) Post-retirement obligations
The Group contributes to a defined
contribution scheme and to individual defined contribution schemes
for the benefit of certain employees. The schemes are funded
through payments to insurance companies or trustee-administered
funds at the contribution rates agreed with individual
employees.
The Group has no further payment
obligations once the contributions have been paid. The
contributions are recognised as an employee benefit expense when
they are due. Prepaid contributions are recognised as an asset to
the extent that a cash refund or a reduction in the future payments
is available.
There are no post-retirement
benefits other than pensions.
(b) Share-based compensation - cash settled
The Group adopts a Black-Scholes
valuation model in calculating the fair value of the share options
as adjusted for an attrition rate for members of the scheme and a
probability of pay-out reflecting the risk of not meeting the terms
of the scheme over the vesting period. The number of share options
that are expected to vest are reviewed at least
annually.
The fair value of cash settled
share-based payments is recognised as personnel expenses in the
profit or loss with a corresponding increase in liabilities over
the vesting period. The liability is remeasured at each reporting
date and at settlement date based on the fair value of the options
granted, with a corresponding adjustment to personnel
expenses.
(c) Deferred cash bonus scheme
The Bank has a deferred cash bonus
scheme for senior employees. The cost of the award is recognised to
the income statement over the period to which the performance
relates.
(d) Short-term incentive plan
The Group has a short-term
incentive plan payable to employees of one of its subsidiary
companies. The award of a profit share is based on a percentage of
the net profit of a Group subsidiary.
16. Earnings per ordinary share
Basic
Basic earnings per ordinary share
are calculated by dividing the profit after tax attributable to
equity holders of the Company by the weighted average number of
ordinary shares 15,879,200 (2022: 15,022,629) in issue during the
year (this includes Ordinary shares and Ordinary Non-Voting
shares).
Diluted
There are no convertible
instruments, conditional ordinary shares or options or warrants
that would create diluted earnings per share. Therefore the diluted
earnings per share is equal to basic earnings per share.
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Profit after tax attributable to
equity holders of the Company
|
35,379
|
16,458
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
p
|
p
|
Basic Earnings per
share
|
222.8
|
109.6
|
|
|
|
17. Cash and balances at central
banks
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cash and balances at central
banks
|
826,559
|
732,729
|
ECL has been assessed to be
insignificant.
Surplus funds are mainly held in
the Bank of England reserve account, with the remainder held in
certificates of deposit, fixed and floating rate notes and money
market deposits in investment grade banks.
18. Loans and advances to banks
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Placements with banks included in
cash and cash equivalents (Note 42)
|
79,381
|
115,787
|
|
|
|
The table below presents an
analysis of loans and advances to banks by rating agency
designation as at 31 December, based on Moody's short and long term
ratings:
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
A1
|
79,381
|
115,595
|
A3
|
-
|
193
|
|
79,381
|
115,788
|
|
|
|
None of the loans and advances to
banks are past due (2022: nil). ECL has been assessed as
insignificant.
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Placements with banks included in
cash and cash equivalents (Note 42)
|
623
|
8,434
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to banks
include bank balances of £Nil (2022: £11.5m) with Arbuthnot Latham
& Co., Ltd. ECL has been assessed as insignificant.
|
19. Debt securities at amortised cost
Debt securities represent
certificates of deposit.
The movement in debt securities
may be summarised as follows:
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January
|
439,753
|
301,052
|
Exchange difference
|
(8,973)
|
9,524
|
Additions
|
1,582,889
|
799,341
|
Redemptions
|
(1,071,232)
|
(670,164)
|
At 31 December
|
942,437
|
439,753
|
The table below presents an
analysis of debt securities by rating agency designation at 31
December, based on Moody's long term ratings:
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Aaa
|
401,524
|
41,907
|
Aa1
|
76,543
|
89,805
|
Aa2
|
94,759
|
44,902
|
Aa3
|
294,471
|
50,000
|
A1
|
75,140
|
213,139
|
|
942,437
|
439,753
|
|
|
|
None of the debt securities are
past due (2022: nil). ECL has been assessed as
immaterial.
|
|
|
|
The movement in debt securities
for the Company may be summarised as follows:
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January
|
24,437
|
24,367
|
Additions
|
16,801
|
2,396
|
Redemptions
|
(3,109)
|
(2,326)
|
At 31 December
|
38,129
|
24,437
|
|
|
|
The exposure relates to Arbuthnot
Latham & Co., Limited, which is unrated. The £25m subordinated
loan notes were issued on 3 June 2019 and are denominated in Pound
Sterling. The principal amount outstanding at 31 December 2023 was
£25m (2022: £25m). The notes carry interest at 7.75% over 3 month
average SONIA and are repayable at par in June 2029 unless redeemed
or repurchased earlier by the Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Limited.
On 24 May 2023 an additional €15m subordinated loan notes were
issued and denominated in EURO. The principal amount outstanding at
31 December 2023 was €15m / £13m (2022: £nil). The notes carry
interest at 3% over 3 Month EURIBOR and are repayable at par in
August 2035. ECL has been assessed as immaterial.
|
20. Assets classified as held for
sale
Assets, or disposal groups
comprising assets and liabilities, that are expected to be
recovered primarily through sale rather than through continuing
use, are classified as held for sale.
The criteria that the Group uses
to determine whether an asset is held for sale under IFRS 5
include, but are not limited to the following:
•
Management is committed to a plan to sell
•
The asset is available for immediate sale
• An
active programme to locate a buyer is initiated
•
The sale is highly probable, within 12 months of classification as
held for sale
•
The asset is being actively marketed for sale at a sales price
reasonable in relation to its fair value
Non-current assets held for sale
are measured at the lower of their carrying amount and fair value
less costs to sell in accordance with IFRS 5. Where investments
that have initially been recognised as non-current assets held for
sale, because the Group has been deemed to hold a controlling
stake, are subsequently disposed of or diluted such that the
Group's holding is no longer deemed a controlling stake, the
investment will subsequently be reclassified as fair value through
profit or loss or fair value through other comprehensive income
investments in accordance with IFRS 9. Subsequent movements will be
recognised in accordance with the Group's accounting policy for the
newly adopted classification.
Once classified as held for sale,
intangible assets and property, plant and equipment are no longer
amortised or depreciated.
|
Group
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Repossessed property held for
sale
|
3,281
|
3,279
|
|
3,281
|
3,279
|
Repossessed
property held for sale
The repossessed property is expected to be
sold within 12 months and can therefore be recognised as held for
sale under IFRS 5.
21. Derivative financial instruments
All derivatives are recognised at
their fair value. Fair values are obtained using recent arm's
length transactions or calculated using valuation techniques such
as discounted cash flow models at the prevailing interest rates,
and for structured notes classified as financial instruments fair
values are obtained from quoted market prices in active markets.
Derivatives are shown in the Statement of Financial Position as
assets when their fair value is positive and as liabilities when
their fair value is negative.
|
2023
|
|
2022
|
|
Contract/ notional amount
|
Fair
value assets
|
Fair
value liabilities
|
|
Contract/ notional amount
|
Fair
value assets
|
Fair
value liabilities
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Currency swaps
|
4,670
|
4
|
66
|
|
3,049
|
113
|
135
|
Interest rate swaps
|
61,220
|
4,210
|
966
|
|
51,376
|
6,209
|
-
|
|
65,890
|
4,214
|
1,032
|
|
54,425
|
6,322
|
135
|
The principal derivatives used by
the Group are over the counter exchange rate contracts. Exchange
rate related contracts include currency swaps and interest rate
swaps.
A forward foreign exchange
contract is an agreement to buy or sell a specified amount of
foreign currency on a specified future date at an agreed rate.
Currency swaps generally involve the exchange of interest payment
obligations denominated in different currencies; exchange of
principal can be notional or actual. The currency swaps are settled
net and therefore the fair value is small in comparison to the
contract/notional amount. Interest rate swaps are used to hedge
against the Profit or Loss impact resulting from the movement in
interest rates, due to some exposures having fixed rate
terms.
The Group primarily uses
investment graded banks as counterparties for derivative financial
instruments.
The table below presents an
analysis of derivative financial instruments contract/notional
amounts by rating agency designation of
|
counterparty bank at 31 December,
based on Moody's long term ratings:
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Aa1
|
-
|
250
|
A1
|
65,890
|
52,840
|
Unrated
|
-
|
1,335
|
|
65,890
|
54,425
|
22. Derivatives held for risk management and hedge
accounting
See accounting policy in Note
3.
Derivatives held for risk
management
The following table describes the
fair values of derivatives held for risk management purposes by
type of risk exposure.
|
2023
|
|
2022
|
|
Fair
value assets
|
Fair
value liabilities
|
|
Fair
value assets
|
Fair
value liabilities
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Interest rate - Designated fair
value hedges
|
4,220
|
976
|
|
6,184
|
-
|
Total interest rate
derivatives
|
4,220
|
976
|
|
6,184
|
-
|
Details of derivatives designated
as hedging instruments in qualifying hedging relationships are
provided in the hedge accounting section below. The instruments
used principally include interest rate swaps.
For more information about how the
Group manages its market risks, see Note 6.
Hedge accounting
Fair value hedges of interest rate risk
The Group uses interest rate swaps
to hedge its exposure to changes in the fair values of fixed rate
pound sterling loans to customers in respect of the SONIA (The
Sterling Overnight Index Average) benchmark interest rate.
Pay-fixed/receive-floating interest rate swaps are matched to
specific fixed-rate loans and advances with terms that closely
align with the critical terms of the hedged item.
The Group's approach to managing
market risk, including interest rate risk, is discussed in Note 6.
The Group's exposure to interest rate risk is disclosed in Note 6.
Interest rate risk to which the Group applies hedge accounting
arises from fixed-rate loans and advances, whose fair value
fluctuates when benchmark interest rates change. The Group hedges
interest rate risk only to the extent of benchmark interest rates
because the changes in fair value of a fixed-rate loan are
significantly influenced by changes in the benchmark interest rate
(SONIA). Hedge accounting is applied where economic hedging
relationships meet the hedge accounting criteria.
By using derivative financial
instruments to hedge exposures to changes in interest rates, the
Group also exposes itself to credit risk of the derivative
counterparty, which is not offset by the hedged item. The Group
minimises counterparty credit risk in derivative instruments by
entering into transactions with high-quality counterparties whose
credit rating is not lower than A.
Before fair value hedge accounting
is applied by the Group, the Group determines whether an economic
relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument
exists based on an evaluation of the qualitative characteristics of
these items and the hedged risk that is supported by quantitative
analysis. The Group considers whether the critical terms of the
hedged item and hedging instrument closely align when assessing the
presence of an economic relationship. The Group evaluates whether
the fair value of the hedged item and the hedging instrument
respond similarly to similar risks. The Group further supports this
qualitative assessment by using regression analysis to assess
whether the hedging instrument is expected to be and has been
highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value of the
hedged item.
The Group establishes a hedge
ratio by aligning the par amount of the fixed-rate loan and the
notional amount of the interest rate swap designated as a hedging
instrument. Under the Group policy, in order to conclude that a
hedging relationship is effective, all of the following criteria
should be met.
• The
regression co-efficient (R squared), which measures the correlation
between the variables in the regression, is at least
0.8.
• The
slope of the regression line is within a 0.8-1.25 range.
• The
confidence level of the slope is at least 95%.
In these hedging relationships,
the main sources of ineffectiveness are:
• the
effect of the counterparty and the Group's own credit risk on the
fair value of the interest rate swap, which is not reflected in the
fair value of the hedged item attributable to the change in
interest rate; and
• differences in payable/receivable fixed rates of the interest
rate swap and the loans.
There were no other sources of
ineffectiveness in these hedging relationships.
The effective portion of fair
value gains on derivatives held in qualifying fair value hedging
relationships and the hedging gain or loss on the hedged items are
included in net interest income.
At 31 December 2023 and 31
December 2022, the Group held the following interest rate swaps as
hedging instruments in fair value hedges of interest
risk.
|
Maturity 2023
|
|
Maturity 2022
|
Group
|
Less than 1 year
|
1-5 years
|
More than 5 years
|
|
Less than 1 year
|
1-5 years
|
More than 5 years
|
Risk category: Interest rate risk
- Hedge of loans and advances
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Nominal amount (in
£000)
|
-
|
61,220
|
-
|
|
-
|
48,120
|
-
|
Average fixed interest
rate
|
-
|
2.51%
|
-
|
|
-
|
1.79%
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The amounts relating to items
designated as hedging instruments and hedge ineffectiveness at 31
December 2023 were as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
|
|
|
|
|
Nominal amount
|
Carrying amount
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
Liabilities
|
Group
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Interest rate risk
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest rate swaps - hedge of
loans and advances
|
|
|
|
|
61,220
|
4,220
|
976
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The amounts relating to items
designated as hedging instruments and hedge ineffectiveness at 31
December 2022 were as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
|
|
|
|
|
Nominal amount
|
Carrying amount
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
Liabilities
|
Group
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Interest rate risk
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest rate swaps - hedge of
loans and advances
|
|
|
|
|
48,120
|
6,184
|
-
|
The amounts relating to items
designated as hedged items at 31 December 2023 were as
follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying amount
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
Liabilities
|
Group
|
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Loans and advances
|
|
|
|
|
|
58,323
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The amounts relating to items
designated as hedged items at 31 December 2022 were as
follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Carrying amount
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
Liabilities
|
Group
|
|
|
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Loans and advances
|
|
|
|
|
|
42,383
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
2023
|
Line item in the statement of
financial position where the hedging instrument is
included
|
Change in fair value used for
calculating hedge ineffectiveness
|
Ineffectiveness recognised in
profit or loss
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Line item in profit or loss that
includes hedge ineffectiveness
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
(2,940)
|
(100)
|
Net interest income
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
2022
|
Line item in the statement of
financial position where the hedging instrument is
included
|
Change in fair value used for
calculating hedge ineffectiveness
|
Ineffectiveness recognised in
profit or loss
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Line item in profit or loss that
includes hedge ineffectiveness
|
Derivative financial
instruments
|
4,549
|
303
|
Net interest income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
2023
|
|
|
Change in value used for
calculating hedge ineffectiveness
|
|
Accumulated amount of fair value
hedge adjustments on the hedged item included in the carrying
amount of the hedged item
|
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
Liabilities
|
|
Line item in the statement of
financial position in which the hedged item is included
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
2,840
|
|
(3,839)
|
942
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
2022
|
|
|
Change in value used for
calculating hedge ineffectiveness
|
|
Accumulated amount of fair value
hedge adjustments on the hedged item included in the carrying
amount of the hedged item
|
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
Liabilities
|
|
Line item in the statement of
financial position in which the hedged item is included
|
£000
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
(4,246)
|
|
(5,737)
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23. Loans and advances to customers
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Analyses of loans and advances to
customers:
|
|
|
2023
|
|
|
Stage
1
|
Stage
2
|
Stage
3
|
Total
|
Group
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross loans and advances at 1
January 2023
|
|
1,917,907
|
74,514
|
50,258
|
2,042,679
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Originations and
repayments
|
|
85,665
|
(42,029)
|
(14,067)
|
29,569
|
Write-offs
|
|
-
|
-
|
(1,223)
|
(1,223)
|
Transfer to Stage 1
|
|
2,420
|
(2,185)
|
(235)
|
-
|
Transfer to Stage 2
|
|
(66,605)
|
66,895
|
(290)
|
-
|
Transfer to Stage 3
|
|
(30,445)
|
(14,443)
|
44,888
|
-
|
Gross loans and advances at 31
December 2023
|
|
1,908,942
|
82,752
|
79,331
|
2,071,025
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Less allowances for ECLs (see Note
24)
|
|
(900)
|
(429)
|
(5,479)
|
(6,808)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net loans and advances at 31
December 2023
|
|
1,908,042
|
82,323
|
73,852
|
2,064,217
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
|
|
Stage
1
|
Stage
2
|
Stage
3
|
Total
|
Group
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross loans and advances at 1
January 2022
|
|
1,737,909
|
95,463
|
43,977
|
1,877,349
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Originations
|
|
217,525
|
(36,398)
|
(10,823)
|
170,304
|
Repayments and
write-offs
|
|
-
|
-
|
(4,974)
|
(4,974)
|
Transfer to Stage 1
|
|
30,323
|
(29,720)
|
(603)
|
-
|
Transfer to Stage 2
|
|
(57,245)
|
59,912
|
(2,667)
|
-
|
Transfer to Stage 3
|
|
(10,605)
|
(14,743)
|
25,348
|
-
|
Gross loans and advances at 31
December 2022
|
|
1,917,907
|
74,514
|
50,258
|
2,042,679
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Less allowances for ECLs (see Note
24)
|
|
(1,147)
|
(130)
|
(5,325)
|
(6,602)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net loans and advances at 31
December 2022
|
|
1,916,760
|
74,384
|
44,933
|
2,036,077
|
*Originations include further
advances and drawdowns on existing commitments.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| |
For a maturity profile of loans
and advances to customers, refer to Note 6.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to customers by
division (net of ECL):
|
|
2023
|
|
Banking
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
AAG
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Total
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Stage 1
|
1,332,535
|
95,218
|
194,423
|
223,865
|
3,078
|
58,923
|
-
|
1,908,042
|
Stage 2
|
59,472
|
10,063
|
2,146
|
10,355
|
-
|
287
|
-
|
82,323
|
Stage 3
|
47,607
|
18,466
|
2,221
|
5,558
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
73,852
|
At 31 December 2023
|
1,439,614
|
123,747
|
198,790
|
239,778
|
3,078
|
59,210
|
-
|
2,064,217
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2022
|
|
Banking
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
AAG
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Total
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Stage 1
|
1,362,950
|
126,713
|
128,594
|
267,812
|
13,675
|
17,016
|
-
|
1,916,760
|
Stage 2
|
59,844
|
10,767
|
2,394
|
-
|
1,001
|
376
|
-
|
74,382
|
Stage 3
|
29,855
|
11,037
|
2,837
|
1,013
|
193
|
-
|
-
|
44,935
|
At 31 December 2022
|
1,452,649
|
148,517
|
133,825
|
268,825
|
14,869
|
17,392
|
-
|
2,036,077
|
Analyses of past due loans and
advances to customers by division:
|
|
2023
|
|
Banking
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Total
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Up to 30 days
|
77,211
|
3,902
|
1,969
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
83,082
|
Stage 1
|
56,487
|
3,476
|
1,872
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
61,835
|
Stage 2
|
20,678
|
261
|
53
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
20,992
|
Stage 3
|
46
|
165
|
44
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
255
|
30 - 60 days
|
1,815
|
4,687
|
246
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
6,748
|
Stage 2
|
1,797
|
4,508
|
225
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
6,530
|
Stage 3
|
18
|
179
|
21
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
218
|
60 - 90 days
|
421
|
3,030
|
180
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,631
|
Stage 2
|
50
|
3,030
|
151
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,231
|
Stage 3
|
371
|
-
|
29
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
400
|
Over 90 days
|
50,258
|
19,992
|
3,256
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
73,506
|
Stage 2
|
3,969
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,969
|
Stage 3
|
46,289
|
19,992
|
3,256
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
69,537
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At 31 December 2023
|
129,705
|
31,611
|
5,651
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
166,967
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Analyses of past due loans and
advances to customers by division:
|
|
2022
|
|
Banking
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Total
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Up to 30 days
|
119,113
|
9,216
|
2,240
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
130,569
|
Stage 1
|
113,121
|
8,056
|
1,858
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
123,035
|
Stage 2
|
5,626
|
1,013
|
215
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
6,854
|
Stage 3
|
366
|
147
|
167
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
680
|
30 - 60 days
|
1,633
|
2,277
|
43
|
-
|
1,001
|
-
|
4,954
|
Stage 2
|
1,625
|
2,147
|
43
|
-
|
1,001
|
-
|
4,816
|
Stage 3
|
8
|
130
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
138
|
60 - 90 days
|
5,555
|
1,135
|
116
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
6,806
|
Stage 2
|
5,044
|
898
|
52
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
5,994
|
Stage 3
|
511
|
237
|
64
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
812
|
Over 90 days
|
37,564
|
8,302
|
3,214
|
-
|
193
|
-
|
49,273
|
Stage 2
|
9,524
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
9,524
|
Stage 3
|
28,040
|
8,302
|
3,214
|
-
|
193
|
-
|
39,749
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At 31 December 2022
|
163,865
|
20,930
|
5,613
|
-
|
1,194
|
-
|
191,602
|
Loans and advances to customers
include finance lease receivables as follows:
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Gross investment in finance lease
receivables:
|
|
|
- No later than 1
year
|
99,863
|
54,086
|
- Later than 1 year and no
later than 5 years
|
195,538
|
117,179
|
- Later than 5
years
|
394
|
748
|
|
295,795
|
172,013
|
Unearned future finance income on
finance leases
|
(37,795)
|
(20,798)
|
Net investment in finance
leases
|
258,000
|
151,215
|
The net investment in finance
leases may be analysed as follows:
|
|
|
- No later than 1
year
|
78,509
|
43,537
|
- Later than 1 year and no
later than 5 years
|
179,108
|
106,979
|
- Later than 5
years
|
383
|
699
|
|
258,000
|
151,215
|
(b) Loans and advances renegotiated
Restructuring activities include
external payment arrangements, modification and deferral of
payments. Following restructuring, a previously overdue customer
account is reset to a normal status and managed together with other
similar accounts. Restructuring policies and practices are based on
indicators or criteria which, in the judgement of management,
indicate that payment will most likely continue. These policies are
kept under continuous review. Renegotiated loans that would
otherwise be past due or impaired totalled £Nil (2022:
£Nil).
(c) Collateral held
Collateral is measured at fair
value less costs to sell. Most of the loans are secured by
property. The fair value of the collateral held against loans and
advances in Stage 3 is £125.8m (2022: £69.2m), against loans of
£79.3m (2022: £50.3m). The weighted average loan-to-value of loans
and advances in Stage 3 is 63.0% (2022: 73%).
|
|
|
|
|
|
24. Allowances for impairment of loans and
advances
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An analysis of movements in the
allowance for ECLs (2023):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stage
1
|
Stage
2
|
Stage
3
|
Total
|
Group
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January 2023
|
|
1,147
|
130
|
5,324
|
6,601
|
Transfer to Stage 2
|
|
(241)
|
241
|
-
|
-
|
Transfer to Stage 3
|
|
(23)
|
(14)
|
37
|
-
|
Current year charge
|
|
(29)
|
90
|
3,510
|
3,571
|
Change in assumptions
|
|
48
|
1
|
(162)
|
(113)
|
Repayments and
write-offs
|
|
-
|
(21)
|
(3,230)
|
(3,251)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
|
902
|
427
|
5,479
|
6,808
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An analysis of movements in the
allowance for ECLs (2022):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stage
1
|
Stage
2
|
Stage
3
|
Total
|
Group
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January 2022
|
|
388
|
77
|
5,922
|
6,387
|
Transfer to Stage 1
|
|
15
|
(15)
|
-
|
-
|
Transfer to Stage 2
|
|
(57)
|
57
|
-
|
-
|
Transfer to Stage 3
|
|
(8)
|
(70)
|
78
|
-
|
Current year charge
|
|
208
|
18
|
4,080
|
4,306
|
Change in assumptions
|
|
601
|
63
|
218
|
882
|
Repayments and
write-offs
|
|
-
|
-
|
(4,974)
|
(4,974)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
|
1,147
|
130
|
5,324
|
6,601
|
25. Other assets
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Trade receivables
|
22,361
|
14,160
|
Inventory
|
24,917
|
29,210
|
Prepayments and accrued
income
|
9,872
|
8,815
|
|
57,150
|
52,185
|
|
|
|
Trade receivables
|
|
|
Gross balance
|
22,511
|
14,506
|
Allowance for bad debts
|
(150)
|
(346)
|
Net receivables
|
22,361
|
14,160
|
Inventory
Inventory is measured at the lower
of cost or net realisable value. The cost of inventories comprises
all costs of purchase, costs of conversion and other costs incurred
in bringing the inventories to their present location and
condition. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in
the ordinary course of business less the estimated costs of
completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the
sale.
Pinnacle Universal is a special
purpose vehicle, 100% owned by the Bank, which owns land that is
currently in the process of being redeveloped with a view to
selling off as individual residential plots.
Land acquired through repossession
of collateral which is subsequently held in the ordinary course of
business with a view to develop and sell is accounted for as
inventory.
The Group's intention is to
develop and sell the property and this has therefore been
recognised as inventory. The value of inventory for repossessed
collateral at 31 December 2023 is £4.8m (2022: £9.4m).
In 2019 two properties were
reclassified from investment property to inventory due to being
under development with a view to sell. The Group has sold its King
Street property in 2022. At 31 December 2023 the remaining property
was valued at net realisable value less costs to sell of £9.9m
(2022: the remaining property valued at cost of £10.2m).
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Trade receivables
|
1,391
|
-
|
Prepayments and accrued
income
|
58
|
74
|
|
1,449
|
74
|
|
|
|
26. Financial investments
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Designated at fair value through
other comprehensive income
|
|
|
- Unlisted
securities
|
3,942
|
3,404
|
Total financial
investments
|
3,942
|
3,404
|
Unlisted securities
On 23 June 2016 Arbuthnot Latham
received €1.3m cash consideration following Visa Inc.'s completion
of the acquisition of Visa Europe. As part of the deal Arbuthnot
Latham also received preference shares in Visa Inc., these have
been valued at their future conversion value into Visa Inc. common
stock.
During 2020, as part of the fourth
anniversary of the closing of the Visa Europe transaction, an
assessment was performed of the ongoing risk of liability to Visa.
As part of the adjustment, Visa awarded the Group 59 preference
shares with a carrying value of £920k. In 2022 Visa awarded the
Group extra 28 preference shares with a carrying value of £501k.
These can be automatically converted into freely tradeable Class A
common stock.
Management have assessed the sum
of the fair value of the Group's investment as £2.4m (2022: £2.0m).
This valuation includes a 31% haircut on the original preference
shares.
The Group has designated its
investment in the security as FVOCI. Dividends received during the
year amounted to £12k (2022: £Nil).
A further investment in an
unlisted investment vehicle was made in 2023. The carrying value at
year end is £1.5m (2022: £1.4m) and the Group received a
distribution of £0.1m (2022: £0.6m) which included a gain of £0.1m
(2022: £0.5m) in the year.
All unlisted securities have been
designated as FVOCI as they are held for strategic reasons. These
securities are measured at fair value in the Statement of Financial
Position with fair value gains/losses recognised in OCI.
27. Deferred taxation
Deferred tax is provided in full
on temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets
and liabilities and their carrying amounts in the consolidated
financial statements. However, deferred tax is not accounted for if
it arises from the initial recognition of goodwill, the initial
recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction other than a
business combination that at the time of the transaction affects
neither accounting nor taxable profit or loss, and differences
relating to investments in subsidiaries to the extent that they
probably will not reverse in the foreseeable future. Deferred tax
is determined using tax rates (and laws) that have been enacted or
substantively enacted by the Statement of Financial Position date
and are expected to apply when the related deferred tax asset is
realised or the deferred tax liability is settled.
Deferred tax assets and
liabilities are offset if there is a legally enforceable right to
offset current tax liabilities and assets, and they relate to taxes
levied by the same tax authority on the same taxable entity, or on
different tax entities, when they intend to settle current tax
liabilities and assets on a net basis or the tax assets and
liabilities will be realised simultaneously.
Deferred tax assets are recognised
where it is probable that future taxable profits will be available
against which the temporary differences can be utilised.
The deferred tax asset
comprises:
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Accelerated capital allowances and
other short-term timing differences
|
(5,639)
|
(2,196)
|
Movement in fair value of
financial investments FVOCI
|
(300)
|
(209)
|
Unutilised tax losses
|
819
|
4,567
|
IFRS 9 adjustment*
|
210
|
263
|
Deferred tax
(liability)/asset
|
(4,910)
|
2,425
|
|
|
|
At 1 January
|
2,425
|
2,562
|
Other Comprehensive Income -
FVOCI
|
(91)
|
(57)
|
Profit and loss account -
accelerated capital allowances and other short-term timing
differences
|
(3,443)
|
(2,233)
|
Profit and loss account - tax
losses
|
(3,748)
|
2,198
|
IFRS 9 adjustment*
|
(53)
|
(45)
|
Deferred tax (liability)/asset at
31 December
|
(4,910)
|
2,425
|
* This relates to the timing
difference on the adoption of IFRS 9 spread over 10 years for tax
purposes.
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Accelerated capital allowances and
other short-term timing differences
|
7
|
10
|
Movement in fair value of
financial investments
|
147
|
147
|
Unutilised tax losses
|
366
|
366
|
Deferred tax asset
|
520
|
523
|
|
|
|
At 1 January
|
523
|
523
|
Profit and loss account -
accelerated capital allowances and other short-term timing
differences
|
(3)
|
|
Deferred tax asset at 31
December
|
520
|
523
|
Deferred tax assets are recognised
for tax losses to the extent that the realisation of the related
tax benefit through future taxable profits is probable.
28. Intangible assets
(a) Goodwill
Goodwill represents the excess of
the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the Group's share
of the net identifiable assets of the acquired subsidiary at the
date of acquisition. Goodwill on acquisitions of subsidiaries is
included in 'intangible assets'. Gains and losses on the disposal
of an entity include the carrying amount of goodwill relating to
the entity sold.
The Group reviews the goodwill for
impairment at least annually or more frequently when events or
changes in economic circumstances indicate that impairment may have
taken place and carries goodwill at cost less accumulated
impairment losses. Assets are grouped together in the smallest
group of assets that generates cash inflows from continuing use
that are largely independent of the cash inflows of other assets or
groups of assets (the "cash-generating unit" or "CGU"). For
impairment testing purposes goodwill cannot be allocated to a CGU
that is greater than a reported operating segment. CGUs to which
goodwill has been allocated are aggregated so that the level at
which impairment is tested reflects the lowest level at which
goodwill is monitored for internal reporting purposes. Goodwill
acquired in a business combination is allocated to groups of CGUs
that are expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination.
The test for impairment involves comparing the carrying value of
goodwill with the present value of pre-tax cash flows, discounted
at a rate of interest that reflects the inherent risks of the CGU
to which the goodwill relates, or the CGU's fair value if this is
higher.
(b) Computer software
Acquired computer software
licences are capitalised on the basis of the costs incurred to
acquire and bring to use the specific software. These costs are
amortised on a straight line basis over the expected useful lives
(three to fifteen years).
Costs associated with maintaining
computer software programs are recognised as an expense as
incurred.
Costs associated with developing
computer software which are assets in the course of construction,
which management has assessed to not be available for use, are not
amortised.
Expenditure on internally
developed software is recognised as an asset when the Group is able
to demonstrate: that the product is technically and commercially
feasible, its intention and ability to complete the development and
use the software in a manner that will generate future economic
benefits, and that it can reliably measure the costs to complete
the development. The capitalised costs of internally developed
software include all costs directly attributable to developing the
software, and are amortised over its useful life.
(c) Other intangibles
Other intangibles include
trademarks, customer relationships, broker relationships,
technology and banking licences acquired. These costs are amortised
on a straight line basis over the expected useful lives (three to
fourteen years).
|
|
|
|
|
|
Goodwill
|
Computer
software
|
Other intangibles
|
Total
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cost
|
|
|
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
5,202
|
30,486
|
6,978
|
42,666
|
Additions
|
-
|
6,524
|
-
|
6,524
|
Disposals
|
-
|
-
|
(687)
|
(687)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
5,202
|
37,010
|
6,291
|
48,503
|
Additions
|
-
|
985
|
888
|
1,873
|
Disposals
|
-
|
-
|
(350)
|
(350)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
5,202
|
37,995
|
6,829
|
50,026
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated
amortisation
|
|
|
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
-
|
(11,103)
|
(1,699)
|
(12,802)
|
Amortisation charge
|
-
|
(2,964)
|
(188)
|
(3,152)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
-
|
(14,067)
|
(1,887)
|
(15,954)
|
Amortisation charge
|
-
|
(3,906)
|
(579)
|
(4,485)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
-
|
(17,973)
|
(2,466)
|
(20,439)
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net book amount
|
|
|
|
|
At 31 December 2022
|
5,202
|
22,943
|
4,404
|
32,549
|
At 31 December 2023
|
5,202
|
20,022
|
4,363
|
29,587
|
Significant management judgements
are made in estimations, to evaluate whether an impairment of
goodwill is necessary. Impairment testing is performed at CGU level
and the following two items, with judgements surrounding them, have
a significant impact on the estimations used in determining the
necessity of an impairment charge:
• Future cash flows - Cash flow
forecasts reflect management's view of future business forecasts at
the time of the assessment. A detailed three year budget is done
every year and management also uses judgement in applying a growth
rate. The accuracy of future cash flows is subject to a high degree
of uncertainty in volatile market conditions. During such
conditions, management would perform impairment testing more
frequently than annually to ensure that the assumptions applied are
still valid in the current market conditions.
• Discount rate - Management also
apply judgement in determining the discount rate used to discount
future expected cash flows. The discount rate is derived from the
cost of capital for each CGU.
The recoverable amount of an asset
or CGU is the greater of its value in use and its fair value less
costs to sell. There are currently two CGUs (2022: two) with
goodwill attached; the core Arbuthnot Latham CGU (£1.7m) and RAF
CGU (£3.5m).
Management considers the value in
use for the Arbuthnot Latham CGU to be the discounted cash flows
over 3 years with a terminal value (2022: 3 years with a terminal
value). The 3 year discounted cash flows with a terminal value are
considered to be appropriate as the goodwill relates to an ongoing
well established business and not underlying assets with finite
lives. The terminal value is calculated by applying a discounted
perpetual growth model to the profit expected in 2024 as per the
approved 3 year plan. A growth rate of 4.6% (2022: 3.1%) was used
for income and 7.4% (2022: 8.1%) for expenditure from 2023 to 2025
(these rates were the best estimate of future forecasted
performance), while a 3% (2022: 3%) percent growth rate for income
and expenditure (a more conservative approach was taken for latter
years as these were not budgeted for in detail as per the three
year plan approved by the Board of Directors) was used for cash
flows after the approved 3 year plan.
Management considers the value in
use for the RAF CGU to be the discounted cash flows over 3 years
with a terminal value. The 3 year discounted cash flows with a
terminal value are considered to be appropriate as the goodwill
relates to an ongoing, well established, business and not
underlying assets with finite lives. The terminal value is
calculated by applying a discounted perpetual growth model to the
profit expected in 2024 as per the approved budget. A growth rate
of 3% (2022: 3%) was used (this rate was the best estimate of
future forecasted performance).
Cash flows were discounted at a
pre-tax rate of 14.7% (2022: 14.7%) to their net present value. The
discount rate of 14.7% is considered to be appropriate after
evaluating current market assessments of the time value of money
and the risks specific to the assets or CGUs.
Currently, the value in use and
fair value less costs to sell of both CGUs exceed the carrying
values of the associated goodwill and as a result no sensitivity
analysis was performed.
|
Computer
software
|
Company
|
£000
|
Cost
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
7
|
At 31 December 2022
|
7
|
At 31 December 2023
|
7
|
|
|
Accumulated
amortisation
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
(5)
|
Amortisation charge
|
(1)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
(6)
|
Amortisation charge
|
(1)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
(7)
|
|
|
Net book amount
|
|
At 31 December 2022
|
1
|
At 31 December 2023
|
-
|
|
|
29. Property, plant and equipment
Land and buildings comprise mainly
branches and offices and are stated at the latest valuation with
subsequent additions at cost less depreciation. Plant and equipment
is stated at historical cost less depreciation. Historical cost
includes expenditure that is directly attributable to the
acquisition of the items.
Land is not depreciated.
Depreciation on other assets is calculated using the straight-line
method to allocate their cost to their residual values over their
estimated useful lives, applying the following annual rates, which
are subject to regular review:
Leasehold improvements
|
3 to 20 years
|
Commercial vehicles
|
2 to 7 years
|
Plant and machinery
|
5 years
|
Computer and other
equipment
|
3 to 10 years
|
Motor vehicles
|
4 years
|
Leasehold improvements are
depreciated over the term of the lease (until the first break
clause). Gains and losses on disposals are determined by deducting
carrying amount from proceeds. These are included in the Statement
of Comprehensive Income.
Commercial vehicles are subject to
operating leases. The other assets are owned and used by the
Group.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Leasehold improvements
|
Commercial vehicles
|
Plant
and machinery
|
Computer
and other equipment
|
Motor
Vehicles
|
Total
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cost or valuation
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
7,656
|
124,317
|
13
|
5,739
|
323
|
138,048
|
Additions
|
92
|
115,170
|
-
|
507
|
467
|
116,236
|
Disposals
|
-
|
(28,918)
|
-
|
-
|
(167)
|
(29,085)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
7,748
|
210,569
|
13
|
6,246
|
623
|
225,199
|
Additions
|
3,979
|
161,235
|
4
|
627
|
235
|
166,080
|
Disposals
|
-
|
(62,181)
|
-
|
-
|
(10)
|
(62,191)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
11,727
|
309,623
|
17
|
6,873
|
848
|
329,088
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated
depreciation
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
(4,962)
|
(2,754)
|
(1)
|
(4,286)
|
(155)
|
(12,158)
|
Depreciation charge
|
(825)
|
(36,885)
|
(8)
|
(848)
|
(118)
|
(38,684)
|
Disposals
|
-
|
808
|
-
|
-
|
108
|
916
|
At 31 December 2022
|
(5,787)
|
(38,831)
|
(9)
|
(5,134)
|
(165)
|
(49,926)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Depreciation charge
|
(857)
|
(40,219)
|
(3)
|
(680)
|
(121)
|
(41,880)
|
Disposals
|
-
|
37,018
|
-
|
-
|
6
|
37,024
|
At 31 December 2023
|
(6,644)
|
(42,032)
|
(12)
|
(5,814)
|
(280)
|
(54,782)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net book amount
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At 31 December 2022
|
1,961
|
171,738
|
4
|
1,112
|
458
|
175,273
|
At 31 December 2023
|
5,083
|
267,591
|
5
|
1,059
|
568
|
274,306
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Computer
and other equipment
|
Motor
Vehicles
|
Total
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cost or valuation
|
|
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
217
|
91
|
308
|
Additions
|
1
|
-
|
1
|
At 31 December 2022
|
218
|
91
|
309
|
Additions
|
(1)
|
-
|
(1)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
217
|
91
|
308
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated
depreciation
|
|
|
|
At 1 January 2022
|
(88)
|
(82)
|
(170)
|
Depreciation charge
|
-
|
(9)
|
(9)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
(88)
|
(91)
|
(179)
|
Depreciation charge
|
-
|
1
|
1
|
At 31 December 2023
|
(88)
|
(90)
|
(178)
|
|
|
|
|
Net book amount
|
|
|
|
At 31 December 2022
|
130
|
-
|
130
|
At 31 December 2023
|
129
|
1
|
130
|
Minimum lease payments receivable
under operating and contract hire leases fall due as
follows:
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Maturity analysis for operating
lease receivables:
|
|
|
- No later than 1
year
|
55,763
|
35,848
|
- Later than 1 year and no
later than 5 years
|
70,225
|
46,583
|
- Later than 5
years
|
5,131
|
1,095
|
|
131,119
|
83,526
|
30. Right-of-use assets
At inception or on reassessment of
a contract, the Group assesses whether a contract is, or contains,
a lease. A contract is, or contains a lease if the contract conveys
the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of
time in exchange for consideration. To assess whether a contract
conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset, the
Group assesses whether:
· the
contract involves the use of an identified asset. This may be
specified explicitly or implicitly, and should be
physically distinct or represent substantially all of
the capacity of a physically distinct asset. If the supplier has a
substantive substitution right, then the asset is not
identified;
· the
Group has the right to obtain substantially all of the economic
benefits from use of the asset throughout the period of use;
and
· the
Group has the right to direct the use of the asset. The Group has
this right when it has the decision-making rights that are most
relevant to changing how and for what purpose the asset is
used.
At inception or on reassessment of
a contract that contains a lease component, the Group allocates the
consideration in the contract to each lease component on the basis
of their relative stand-alone prices.
(a) As a lessee
The Group recognises a
right-of-use asset and a lease liability at the lease commencement
date. The right-of-use asset is initially measured at cost, which
comprises the initial amount of the lease liability adjusted for
any lease payments made at or before the commencement date, plus
any initial direct costs incurred and an estimate of costs to
dismantle and remove the underlying asset or to restore it or its
site, less any lease incentives received.
The right-of-use asset is
subsequently depreciated using the straight-line method from the
commencement date to the earlier of the end of the useful life of
the right-of-use asset or the end of the lease term. The estimated
useful lives of right-of-use assets are determined on the same
basis as those of property and equipment. In addition, the
right-of-use asset is periodically reduced by impairment losses, if
any, and adjusted for certain remeasurements of the lease
liability.
Practical exemptions
The Group has elected not to
recognise right-of-use assets and lease liabilities for short-term
leases of machinery that have a lease term of 12 months or less and
leases of low value assets. The Group recognises the lease payments
associated with these leases as an expense on a straight-line basis
over the lease term.
(b) As a lessor
Assets leased to customers under
agreements which transfer substantially all the risks and rewards
of ownership, with or without ultimate legal title, are classified
as finance leases. When assets are held subject to finance leases,
the present value of the lease payments is recognised as a
receivable. The difference between the gross receivable and the
present value of the receivable is recognised as unearned finance
income. Lease income is recognised over the term of the lease using
the net investment method, which reflects a constant periodic rate
of return.
Assets leased to customers under
agreements which do not transfer substantially all the risks and
rewards of ownership are classified as operating leases. When
assets are held subject to operating leases, the underlying assets
are held at cost less accumulated depreciation. The assets are
depreciated down to their estimated residual values on a
straight-line basis over the lease term. Lease rental income is
recognised on a straight line basis over the lease term.
Breakdown of right-of-use
assets:
|
|
Properties
|
Equipment
|
Total
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January 2022
|
15,516
|
158
|
15,674
|
Additions
|
1,254
|
365
|
1,619
|
Amortisation
|
(2,565)
|
323
|
(2,242)
|
Derecognition
|
(6,796)
|
(543)
|
(7,337)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
7,409
|
303
|
7,714
|
Additions
|
49,228
|
23
|
49,251
|
Amortisation
|
(3,524)
|
(149)
|
(3,673)
|
Derecognition
|
(476)
|
-
|
(476)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
52,637
|
177
|
52,816
|
|
|
|
|
Additions for 2023 include £48.3m
in relation to the 15-year lease on the new Finsbury Circus office,
signed for in September 2023.
|
|
|
|
|
In the year, the Group received
£Nil (2022: £Nil) of rental income from subleasing right-of-use
assets through operating leases.
|
|
|
|
|
The Group recognised £1.3m (2022:
£0.7m) of interest expense related to lease liabilities. The Group
also recognised £0.6m (2022: £0.6m) of expense in relation to
leases with a duration of less than 12 months.
|
31. Investment property
Investment property is initially
measured at cost. Transaction costs are included in the initial
measurement. Subsequently, investment property is measured at fair
value, with any change therein recognised in profit and loss within
other income.
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Opening balance
|
6,550
|
6,550
|
Fair value adjustment
|
(600)
|
-
|
At 31 December 2023
|
5,950
|
6,550
|
Crescent
Office Park, Bath
The property represents a freehold office
building in Bath and comprises 25,528 square ft. over ground and
two upper floors with parking spaces. The property was acquired for
£6.35m. On the date of acquisition, the property was being
multi-let to tenants and was at full capacity.
The Group has elected to apply the fair value
model (see Note 4.2 (c)). The fair value of the investment property
was determined by an external, independent property valuer, having
appropriate recognised professional qualifications and recent
experience in the location and category of property being
valued.
The fair value measurements for the investment
property have been categorised as Level 3 fair value
measurement.
The Group recognised £0.7m (2022: £0.5m)
rental income during the year and incurred £0.7m (2022: £0.07m) of
direct operating expenses. The property remained tenanted during
2023.
|
|
|
32. Deposits from banks
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
193,410
|
236,027
|
|
|
|
Deposits from banks include £190m
(2022: £225m) obtained through the Bank of England Term Funding
Scheme with additional incentives for small and medium-sized
enterprises ("TFSME"). £177.6m of TFSME is maturing in 2025, with
the remaining £12.4m maturing in 2027.
|
33. Deposits from customers
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Current/demand accounts
|
2,161,285
|
1,924,035
|
Notice accounts
|
180,854
|
296,400
|
Term deposits
|
1,417,428
|
872,114
|
|
3,759,567
|
3,092,549
|
Included in customer accounts are
deposits of £32.6m (2022: £15.4m) held as collateral for loans and
advances. The fair value of these deposits approximates their
carrying value.
For a maturity profile of deposits
from customers, refer to Note 6.
34. Other liabilities
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Trade payables
|
18,542
|
4,954
|
Accruals and deferred
income
|
22,158
|
21,190
|
|
40,700
|
26,144
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Trade payables
|
1,796
|
470
|
Accruals and deferred
income
|
3,740
|
3,021
|
|
5,536
|
3,491
|
35. Lease liabilities
The lease liability is initially
measured at the present value of the lease payments that are not
paid at the commencement date, discounted using the interest rate
implicit in the lease or, if that rate cannot be readily
determined, the Group's incremental borrowing rate. Primarily, the
Group uses its incremental borrowing rate as the discount
rate.
Lease payments included in the
measurement of the lease liability comprise the
following:
· fixed payments, including in-substance payments;
· variable lease payments that depend on an index or a rate,
initially measured using the index or rates as at the commencement
date;
· amounts expected to be payable under a residual value
guarantee.
The lease liability is measured at
amortised cost using the effective interest method. It is
remeasured when there is a change in future lease payments arising
from a change in index or rate, if there is a change in the Group's
estimate of the amount expected to be payable under a residual
value guarantee.
When the lease liability is
remeasured in this way, a corresponding adjustment is made to the
carrying amount of the right-of-use asset, or is recorded in the
statement of comprehensive income if the carrying amount of the
right-of-use asset has been reduced to zero.
|
|
Properties
|
Equipment
|
Total
|
Group
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January 2022
|
|
16,099
|
5,177
|
21,276
|
Additions
|
|
848
|
186
|
1,034
|
Interest expense
|
|
709
|
9
|
718
|
Lease payments
|
|
(3,089)
|
(5,087)
|
(8,176)
|
Derecognition
|
|
(6,980)
|
-
|
(6,980)
|
At 31 December 2022
|
|
7,587
|
285
|
7,872
|
Additions
|
|
48,175
|
23
|
48,198
|
Interest expense
|
|
1,336
|
9
|
1,345
|
Lease payments
|
|
(3,496)
|
(158)
|
(3,654)
|
At 31 December 2023
|
|
53,602
|
159
|
53,761
|
|
|
|
|
|
Maturity analysis
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Less than one year
|
|
|
2,734
|
3,675
|
One to five years
|
|
|
20,239
|
3,502
|
More than five years
|
|
|
67,497
|
8,560
|
Total undiscounted lease
liabilities at 31 December
|
|
|
90,470
|
15,737
|
Lease liabilities included in the
statement of financial position at 31 December
|
|
|
53,761
|
7,872
|
Current
|
|
|
2,559
|
3,398
|
Non-current
|
|
|
51,202
|
4,474
|
36. Debt securities in issue
Issued financial instruments or
their components are classified as liabilities where the
contractual arrangement results in the Group having a present
obligation to either deliver cash or another financial asset to the
holder.
Financial liabilities, other than
trading liabilities at fair value, are carried at amortised cost
using the effective interest rate method as set out in the policy
in Note 8.
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group and Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Subordinated loan notes
|
37,726
|
37,594
|
Euro subordinated loan notes
The subordinated loan notes 2035
were issued on 7 November 2005 and are denominated in Euros. The
principal amount outstanding at 31 December 2023 was €15.0m /
£13.0m (2022: €15.0m / £13.3m). The notes carry interest at 3% over
the interbank rate for three month deposits in euros and are
repayable at par in August 2035 unless redeemed or repurchased
earlier by the Company.
The contractual amount that will be
required to be paid at maturity of the above debt securities is
€15.0m.
The fair value of these Euro
subordinated loan notes approximates their carrying
value.
Pounds Sterling subordinated loan notes
The subordinated loan notes were
issued on 3 June 2019 are denominated in Pounds Sterling. The
principal amount outstanding at 31 December 2023 was £25.0m (2022: £25.0m). The
notes carry interest at 7.75% over three month average GBP SONIA
and are repayable at par in June 2029 unless redeemed or
repurchases earlier by the Company.
The contractual amount that will be
required to be paid at maturity of the above debit securities is
£25.0m.
On 19 December 2023 Arbuthnot
Banking Group renewed its subordinated loan notes. The new facility
principal was increased to £26.0m and will be used to redeem the
existing facility, expected 3 June 2024 which is the fifth
anniversary of the initial loan. The facility currently remains
undrawn. The notes will carry interest at 7.25% over 3 month
average GBP SONIA.
The fair value of these
subordinated loan notes approximates their carrying
value.
37. Contingent liabilities and
commitments
Financial guarantees and loan
commitments policy
Financial guarantees represent
undertakings that the Group will meet a customer's obligation to
third parties if the customer fails to do so. Commitments to extend
credit represent unused portions of authorisations to extend credit
in the form of loans, guarantees or letters of credit. The Group is
theoretically exposed to loss in an amount equal to the total
guarantees or unused commitments. However, the likely amount of
loss is expected to be significantly less; most commitments to
extend credit are contingent upon customers maintaining specific
credit standards. Liabilities under financial guarantee contracts
are initially recorded at their fair value, and the initial fair
value is amortised over the life of the financial guarantee.
Subsequently, the financial guarantee liabilities are measured at
the higher of the initial fair value, less cumulative amortisation,
and the best estimate of the expenditure to settle
obligations.
Provisions and contingent
liabilities policy
Provisions are recognised when the
Group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of
a past event, it is probable that an outflow of economic resources
will be required from the Group and amounts can be reliably
measured.
Onerous contract provisions are
recognised for losses on contracts where the forecast costs of
fulfilling the contract throughout the contract period exceed the
forecast income receivable. In assessing the amount of the loss to
provide on any contract, account is taken of the Group's forecast
results which the contract is servicing. The provision is
calculated based on discounted cash flows to the end of the
contract.
Contingent liabilities are
disclosed when the Group has a present obligation as a result of a
past event, but the probability that it will be required to settle
that obligation is more than remote, but not probable.
Contingent liabilities
The Group is subject to extensive
regulation in the conduct of its business. A failure to comply with
applicable regulations could result in regulatory investigations,
fines and restrictions on some of the Group's business activities
or other sanctions. The Group seeks to minimise this risk through
the adoption and compliance with policies and procedures,
continuing to refine controls over business practices and
behaviour, employee training, the use of appropriate documentation,
and the involvement of outside legal counsel where
appropriate.
Capital commitments
At 31 December 2023, the Group had
capital commitments of £0.4m (2022: £0.5m) in respect of a
contribution in an equity investment.
Credit commitments
The contractual amounts of the
Group's off-balance sheet financial instruments that commit it to
extend credit to customers are as follows:
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Guarantees and other contingent
liabilities
|
2,051
|
3,253
|
Commitments to extend
credit:
|
|
|
- Original term to maturity
of one year or less
|
450,539
|
471,078
|
|
452,590
|
474,331
|
|
|
|
|
|
38. Share capital and share premium
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31
December 2023
|
31
December 2022
|
|
Group and Company
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
|
Share capital
|
|
167
|
154
|
|
Share premium
|
|
11,606
|
-
|
|
Share capital and share
premium
|
|
11,773
|
154
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ordinary share capital
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number
of
shares
|
Share
Capital
|
|
Group and Company
|
|
|
£000
|
|
At 1 January 2023
|
|
15,279,322
|
153
|
|
Issue of shares
|
|
1,297,297
|
13
|
|
At 31 December 2023
|
|
16,576,619
|
166
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ordinary non-voting share capital
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number
of
shares
|
Share
Capital
|
|
Group and Company
|
|
|
£000
|
|
At 1 January 2023
|
|
152,621
|
1
|
|
At 31 December 2023
|
|
152,621
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total share capital
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number
of
shares
|
Share
Capital
|
|
Group and Company
|
|
|
£000
|
|
At 1 January 2023
|
|
15,431,943
|
154
|
|
Issue of shares
|
|
1,297,297
|
13
|
|
At 31 December 2023
|
|
16,729,240
|
167
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| |
(a) Share issue costs
Incremental costs directly
attributable to the issue of new shares or options by Company are
shown in equity as a deduction, net of tax, from the
proceeds.
(b) Dividends on ordinary shares
Dividends on ordinary shares are
recognised in equity in the period in which they are
approved.
(c) Share buybacks
Where any Group company purchases
the Company's equity share capital (treasury shares), the
consideration paid, including any directly attributable incremental
costs (net of income taxes) is deducted from equity attributable to
the Company's equity holders until the shares are cancelled or
reissued.
The Ordinary shares have a par
value of 1p per share (2022: 1p per share). At 31 December 2023 the
Company held 409,314 shares (2022: 409,314) in treasury. This
includes 390,274 (2022: 390,274) Ordinary shares and 19,040 (2022:
19,040) Ordinary Non-Voting shares.
During the year the Company's
issued share capital increased by 1,297,297 ordinary shares through
the allotment and issue of ordinary shares through the placing of
and subscription for new voting Ordinary shares in the Company,
raising approximately £12.0 million in a fundraising. The shares
were allotted and issued on 5 May 2023 at the placing price on a
non-pre-emptive basis pursuant to authorities granted to the
directors of the Company at the general meeting held on 4 May
2023.
|
|
|
39. Reserves and retained earnings
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Capital redemption
reserve
|
19
|
19
|
Fair value reserve
|
1,341
|
1,067
|
Treasury shares
|
(1,299)
|
(1,299)
|
Retained earnings
|
240,606
|
212,037
|
Total reserves at 31
December
|
240,667
|
211,824
|
The capital redemption reserve
represents a reserve created after the Company purchased its own
shares which resulted in a reduction of share capital.
The fair value reserve relates to
gains or losses on assets which have been recognised through other
comprehensive income.
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Capital redemption
reserve
|
19
|
19
|
Treasury shares
|
(1,299)
|
(1,299)
|
Retained earnings
|
148,809
|
152,115
|
Total reserves as 31
December
|
147,529
|
150,835
|
40. Share-based payment options
Company - cash settled
Grants were made to Messrs Salmon
and Cobb on 14 June 2016 under Phantom Option Scheme introduced on
that date, to acquire ordinary 1p shares in the Company at 1591p
exercisable in respect of 50% on or after 15 June 2019 and in
respect of the remaining 50% on or after 15 June 2021 when a cash
payment would be made equal to any increase in market
value.
Under this Scheme, Mr. Salmon and
Mr. Cobb were granted a phantom option to acquire 200,000 and
100,000 ordinary 1p shares respectively in the Company. The fair
value of these options at the grant date was £1m. The first tranche
of the share options had vested but lapsed as not exercised at
1591p before 14 June 2023. The second tranche of the share options
had not vested as performance conditions had not been met, due to
the non-payment of dividends, which was not possible in 2020 due to
the regulatory response to the economic impact of COVID. The
valuation of the share options are considered as level 2 within the
fair value hierarchy, with the Group adopting a Black-Scholes
valuation model as adjusted for an attrition rate for members of
the scheme and a probability of pay-out reflecting the risk of not
meeting the terms of the scheme over the vesting period. The number
of share options that are expected to vest are reviewed at least
annually. The fair value of these options as at 31 December 2023
was £Nil (2022: £Nil).
On 23 July 2021 Mr. Salmon and Mr.
Cobb were granted further phantom options to subscribe for 200,000
and 100,000 ordinary 1p shares respectively in the Company at 990p.
50% of each director's individual holding of phantom options is
exercisable at any time after 23 July 2024 and the other 50% is
exercisable at any time after 23 July 2026. All share options
awarded on 23 July 2021, regardless of first exercise date, may not
be exercised later than 23 July 2028 being the day before the
seventh anniversary of the date of grant. The fair value of the
options as at 31 December 2023 was £0.36m (2022:
£0.13m).
The performance conditions of the
Scheme are that, from the grant date to the date the Option is
exercised, there must be no public criticism by any regulatory
authority on the operation of the Company or any of its
subsidiaries which has a material impact on the business of Group
and for the duration of the vesting period, there has been
satisfactory growth in the dividends paid by the
Company.
Options are forfeited if they
remain unexercised after a period of more than 7 years from the
date of grant. If the participant ceases to be employed by the
Group by reason of injury, disability, ill-health or redundancy; or
because his employing company ceases to be a shareholder of the
Group; or because his employing business is being transferred out
of the Group, his option may be exercised within 6 months after
such cessation. In the event of the death of a participant,
the personal representatives of a participant may exercise an
option, to the extent exercisable at the date of death, within 6
months after the death of the participant.
On cessation of employment for any
other reason (or when a participant serves, or has been served
with, notice of termination of such employment), the option will
lapse although the Remuneration Committee has discretion to allow
the exercise of the option for a period not exceeding 6 months from
the date of such cessation.
In such circumstances, the
performance conditions may be modified or waived as the
Remuneration Committee, acting fairly and reasonably and taking due
consideration of the circumstances, thinks fit. The number of
Ordinary Shares which can be acquired on exercise will be pro-rated
on a time elapsed basis, unless the Remuneration Committee, acting
fairly and reasonably and taking due consideration of the
circumstances, decides otherwise. In determining whether to
exercise its discretion in these respects, the Remuneration
Committee must satisfy itself that the early exercise of an option
does not constitute a reward for failure.
The probability of payout has been
assigned based on the likelihood of meeting the performance
criteria, which is 100%. The Directors consider that there is some
uncertainty surrounding whether the participants will all still be
in situ and eligible at the vesting date. Therefore the directors
have assumed a 15% attrition rate for the share options vesting in
June 2021, July 2024 and July 2026. The attrition rate will
increase by 3% per year until the vesting date. ABG had a cost
£0.22m in relation to share based payments during 2023 (2022:
£0.02m cost), as disclosed in Note 13.
Measurement inputs and assumptions
used in the Black-Scholes model are as follows:
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
|
|
Expected Stock Price
Volatility
|
31.8%
|
33.6%
|
Risk Free Interest Rate
|
4.2%
|
2.5%
|
Average Expected Life (in
years)
|
1.56
|
1.36
|
|
|
|
41. Dividends per share
The Directors recommend the
payment of a final dividend of 27p (2022: 25p) per share. This
represents total dividends for the year of 46p (2022: 42p). The
final dividend, if approved by members at the 2023 AGM, will be
paid on 31 May 2024 to shareholders on the register at close of
business on 19 April 2024.
42. Cash and cash equivalents
For the purposes of the Statement
of Cash Flows, cash and cash equivalents comprises cash on hand and
demand deposits, and cash equivalents are deemed highly liquid
investments that are convertible into cash with an insignificant
risk of changes in value with a maturity of three months or less at
the date of acquisition.
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group
|
£000
|
£000
|
Cash and balances at central banks
(Note 17)
|
826,559
|
732,729
|
Loans and advances to banks (Note
18)
|
79,381
|
115,787
|
|
905,940
|
848,516
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Loans and advances to
banks
|
623
|
8,434
|
43. Related party transactions
Related parties of the Company and
Group include subsidiaries, directors, Key Management Personnel,
close family members of Key Management Personnel and entities which
are controlled, jointly controlled or significantly influenced, or
for which significant voting power is held, by Key Management
Personnel or their close family members.
A number of banking transactions
are entered into with related parties in the normal course of
business on normal commercial terms. These include loans and
deposits. Directors and Key Management includes solely Executive
and Non-Executive Directors.
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group - Directors and close family
members
|
£000
|
£000
|
Loans
|
|
|
Loans outstanding at 1
January
|
1,409
|
502
|
Loans advanced during the
year
|
457
|
1,013
|
Loan repayments during the
year
|
(416)
|
(106)
|
Loans outstanding at 31
December
|
1,450
|
1,409
|
Interest income earned
|
38
|
2
|
The loans to directors are mainly
secured on property, shares or cash and bear interest at rates
linked to base rate. No provisions have been recognised in respect
of loans given to related parties (2022: £nil).
|
2023
|
2022
|
Group - Directors and close family
members
|
£000
|
£000
|
Deposits
|
|
|
Deposits at 1 January
|
4,422
|
4,018
|
Deposits placed during the
year
|
4,118
|
6,707
|
Deposits repaid during the
year
|
(5,350)
|
(6,303)
|
Deposits at 31 December
|
3,190
|
4,422
|
Interest expense on
deposits
|
72
|
2
|
Details of directors' remuneration
are given in the Remuneration Report on pages 55 and 57. The
Directors do not believe that there were any other transactions
with key management or their close family members that require
disclosure, other than the subscription of shares by Sir Henry
Angest at a cost of £6,751,047.75 as reported in the Directors
Report on page 43.
|
|
|
|
|
Details of principal subsidiaries
are given in Note 44. Transactions and balances with subsidiaries
are shown below:
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
Highest
balance during the year
|
Balance
at 31 December
|
Highest
balance during the year
|
Balance
at 31 December
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
Due from subsidiary undertakings -
Loans and advances to banks
|
12,843
|
616
|
8,429
|
8,427
|
Due from subsidiary undertakings -
Debt securities at amortised cost
|
38,129
|
38,129
|
24,885
|
24,437
|
Shares in subsidiary
undertakings
|
164,354
|
164,354
|
159,404
|
159,354
|
|
215,326
|
203,099
|
192,718
|
192,218
|
Interest income
|
|
4,198
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES
|
|
|
|
|
Due to subsidiary
undertakings
|
1,339
|
1,540
|
776
|
243
|
|
1,339
|
1,540
|
776
|
243
|
Interest expense
|
|
223
|
|
369
|
The disclosure of the year end
balance and the highest balance during the year is considered the
most meaningful information to represent the transactions during
the year. The above transactions arose during the normal course of
business and are on substantially the same terms as for comparable
transactions with third parties.
The Company undertook the
following transactions with other companies in the Group during the
year:
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Ltd -
Recharge of property and IT costs
|
896
|
896
|
Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Ltd -
Recharge for costs paid on the Company's behalf
|
3,543
|
1,127
|
Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Ltd -
Recharge of costs paid on behalf of Arbuthnot Latham & Co.,
Ltd
|
(2,100)
|
(675)
|
Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Ltd -
Group recharges for shared services
|
(9,764)
|
(6,993)
|
Arbuthnot Latham & Co., Ltd -
Group recharges for liquidity
|
(5,814)
|
(5,862)
|
Total
|
(13,239)
|
(11,507)
|
44. Interests in subsidiaries
|
|
|
|
|
Investment at cost
|
Impairment provisions
|
Net
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
At 1 January 2023
|
159,354
|
-
|
159,354
|
Capital Contribution
|
5,000
|
-
|
5,000
|
At 31 December 2023
|
164,354
|
-
|
164,354
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2023
|
2022
|
Company
|
£000
|
£000
|
Subsidiary
undertakings:
|
|
|
Bank
|
162,814
|
157,814
|
Other
|
1,540
|
1,540
|
Total
|
164,354
|
159,354
|
(a) List of
subsidiaries
Arbuthnot Latham & Co.,
Limited is the only significant subsidiary of Arbuthnot Banking
Group. Arbuthnot Latham is incorporated in the United Kingdom, has
a principal activity of Private and Commercial Banking and is 100%
owned by the Group.
The table below provides details
of other subsidiaries of Arbuthnot Banking Group PLC at 31 December
2023:
|
|
|
%
shareholding
|
Country
of incorporation
|
|
|
|
|
|
Principal activity
|
Direct shareholding
|
|
|
|
Arbuthnot Fund Managers
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Arbuthnot Investments
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Arbuthnot Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Arbuthnot Properties
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Arbuthnot Unit Trust Management
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Gilliat Financial Solutions
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Indirect shareholding via
intermediate holding companies
|
|
|
|
Arbuthnot Commercial Asset Based
Lending Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Asset
Finance
|
|
Arbuthnot Latham (Nominees)
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Arbuthnot Latham Real Estate
PropCo 1 Limited
|
100.0%
|
Jersey
|
Property
Investment
|
|
Arbuthnot Securities
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Arbuthnot Specialist Finance
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Specialist Finance
|
|
Asset Alliance Finance
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Commercial Vehicle Financing
|
|
Asset Alliance Group Finance No.2
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Commercial Vehicle Financing
|
|
Asset Alliance Group Holdings
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Commercial Vehicle Financing
|
|
Asset Alliance Leasing
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Commercial Vehicle Financing
|
|
Asset Alliance Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Commercial Vehicle Financing
|
|
ATE Truck & Trailer Sales
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Forest Asset Finance
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Commercial Vehicle Financing
|
|
Hanbury Riverside
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
John K Gilliat & Co.,
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
Pinnacle Universal
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Property
Development
|
|
Renaissance Asset Finance
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Asset
Finance
|
|
AAG Traffic Management
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
|
The Peacocks Management Company
Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
|
Property
Management
|
|
Valley Finance Limited
|
100.0%
|
UK
|
Dormant
|
All the subsidiaries above were
100% owned during the current and prior year and are unlisted and
none are banking institutions. All entities are included in the
consolidated financial statements and have an accounting reference
date of 31 December.
The Jersey entity's registered
office is 26 New Street, St Helier, Jersey, JE2 3RA. All other
entities listed above have their registered office as 7 Wilson
Street, London, EC2M 2SN.
Arbuthnot Specialist Finance
Limited is exempt from the requirement to prepare audited accounts
under section 479A of the Companies Act 2006.
(b) Non-controlling interests in
subsidiaries
There were no non-controlling
interests at the end of 2023 or 2022.
(c) Significant
restrictions
The Group does not have
significant restrictions on its ability to access or use its assets
and settle its liabilities other than those resulting from the
supervisory frameworks within which banking subsidiaries operate.
The supervisory frameworks require banking subsidiaries to keep
certain levels of regulatory capital and liquid assets, limit their
exposure to other parts of the Group and comply with other ratios.
The carrying amounts of the banking subsidiary's assets and
liabilities are £4.3bn and £4.1bn respectively (2022: £3.6bn and
£3.4bn respectively).
(d) Risks associated with
interests
During the year Arbuthnot Banking
Group PLC made £5.0m capital contributions to Arbuthnot Latham
& Co., Ltd. The contributions were made to assist the Bank
during a period of growth to ensure that all regulatory capital
requirements were met.
In 2022 Arbuthnot Banking Group
PLC did not make capital contributions to Arbuthnot Latham &
Co., Ltd.
45. Operating segments
The Group is organised into nine
operating segments as disclosed below:
1) Banking - Includes Private and
Commercial Banking. Private Banking - Provides traditional private
banking services. Commercial Banking - Provides bespoke commercial
banking services and tailored secured lending against property
investments and other assets.
2) Wealth Management - Offering
financial planning and investment management services.
3) Mortgage Portfolios - Acquired
mortgage portfolios.
4) RAF - Specialist asset finance
lender mainly in high value cars but also business
assets.
5) ACABL - Provides finance
secured on either invoices, assets or stock of the
borrower.
6) ASFL - Provides short term
secured lending solutions to professional and entrepreneurial
property investors.
7) AAG - Provides vehicle finance
and related services, predominantly in the truck & trailer and
bus & coach markets.
8) All Other Divisions - All other
smaller divisions and central costs in Arbuthnot Latham & Co.,
Ltd (Investment property and Central costs)
9) Group Centre - ABG Group
management.
Transactions between the operating
segments are on normal commercial terms. Centrally incurred
expenses are charged to operating segments on an appropriate
pro-rata basis. Segment assets and liabilities comprise loans and
advances to customers and customer deposits, being the majority of
the balance sheet.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Banking
|
Wealth
Management
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
AAG
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Group
Centre
|
Total
|
Year ended 31 December
2023
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Interest revenue
|
107,986
|
-
|
10,593
|
12,584
|
23,300
|
1,103
|
2,390
|
73,880
|
3
|
231,839
|
Inter-segment revenue
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3)
|
(3)
|
Interest revenue from external
customers
|
107,986
|
-
|
10,593
|
12,584
|
23,300
|
1,103
|
2,390
|
73,880
|
-
|
231,836
|
Fee and commission
income
|
3,168
|
11,417
|
-
|
45
|
6,911
|
13
|
-
|
1,616
|
-
|
23,170
|
Revenue
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
100,952
|
-
|
-
|
100,952
|
Revenue from external customers
|
111,154
|
11,417
|
10,593
|
12,629
|
30,211
|
1,116
|
103,342
|
75,496
|
-
|
355,958
|
Interest expense
|
6,145
|
-
|
(6,348)
|
(4,540)
|
(14,658)
|
(352)
|
(10,254)
|
(60,509)
|
(223)
|
(90,739)
|
Cost of goods sold
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(81,074)
|
-
|
-
|
(81,074)
|
Add back inter-segment
revenue
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3
|
3
|
Subordinated loan note
interest
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(4,481)
|
(4,481)
|
Fee and commission
expense
|
(551)
|
(89)
|
-
|
(11)
|
-
|
-
|
(12)
|
(105)
|
-
|
(768)
|
Segment operating
income
|
116,748
|
11,328
|
4,245
|
8,078
|
15,553
|
764
|
12,002
|
14,882
|
(4,701)
|
178,899
|
Impairment losses
|
(1,227)
|
-
|
(821)
|
(982)
|
(234)
|
46
|
(98)
|
125
|
-
|
(3,191)
|
Other income
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
170
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
3,191
|
(839)
|
2,522
|
Operating expenses
|
(52,073)
|
(15,584)
|
(833)
|
(5,634)
|
(6,777)
|
(1,507)
|
(15,093)
|
(23,575)
|
(10,037)
|
(131,113)
|
Segment profit / (loss) before
tax
|
63,448
|
(4,256)
|
2,591
|
1,632
|
8,542
|
(697)
|
(3,189)
|
(5,377)
|
(15,577)
|
47,117
|
Income tax (expense) /
income
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(391)
|
(2,017)
|
118
|
(488)
|
(5,655)
|
(3,305)
|
(11,738)
|
Segment profit / (loss) after tax
|
63,448
|
(4,256)
|
2,591
|
1,241
|
6,525
|
(579)
|
(3,677)
|
(11,032)
|
(18,882)
|
35,379
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
1,439,655
|
-
|
123,747
|
198,790
|
239,777
|
3,078
|
59,210
|
-
|
(40)
|
2,064,217
|
Assets available for
lease
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
267,591
|
-
|
-
|
267,591
|
Other assets
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
2,017,916
|
(5,884)
|
2,012,032
|
Segment total assets
|
1,439,655
|
-
|
123,747
|
198,790
|
239,777
|
3,078
|
326,801
|
2,017,916
|
(5,924)
|
4,343,840
|
Customer deposits
|
3,760,199
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(632)
|
3,759,567
|
Other liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
329,879
|
1,954
|
331,833
|
Segment total liabilities
|
3,760,199
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
329,879
|
1,322
|
4,091,400
|
Other segment items:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital expenditure
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(218,035)
|
1
|
(218,034)
|
Depreciation and
amortisation
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(46,363)
|
-
|
(46,363)
|
The "Group Centre" segment above
includes the parent entity and all intercompany
eliminations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Banking
|
Wealth
Management
|
Mortgage
Portfolios
|
RAF
|
ACABL
|
ASFL
|
AAG
|
All
Other Divisions
|
Group
Centre
|
Total
|
Year ended 31 December
2022
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Interest revenue
|
70,545
|
-
|
7,333
|
8,898
|
14,665
|
1,068
|
664
|
16,840
|
5
|
120,018
|
Inter-segment revenue
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(5)
|
(5)
|
Interest revenue from external
customers
|
70,545
|
-
|
7,333
|
8,898
|
14,665
|
1,068
|
664
|
16,840
|
-
|
120,013
|
Fee and commission
income
|
3,138
|
10,689
|
-
|
32
|
6,178
|
10
|
-
|
1,539
|
-
|
21,586
|
Revenue
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
99,367
|
-
|
-
|
99,367
|
Revenue from external customers
|
73,683
|
10,689
|
7,333
|
8,930
|
20,843
|
1,078
|
100,031
|
18,379
|
-
|
240,966
|
Interest expense
|
(5,980)
|
-
|
(2,223)
|
(3,353)
|
(7,903)
|
(355)
|
(5,120)
|
7,153
|
(368)
|
(18,149)
|
Cost of goods sold
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(82,109)
|
-
|
-
|
(82,109)
|
Add back inter-segment
revenue
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
5
|
5
|
Subordinated loan note
interest
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(2,788)
|
(2,788)
|
Fee and commission
expense
|
(335)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(202)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(537)
|
Segment operating
income
|
67,368
|
10,689
|
5,110
|
5,577
|
12,738
|
723
|
12,802
|
25,532
|
(3,151)
|
137,388
|
Impairment losses
|
(1,547)
|
-
|
(415)
|
(768)
|
(2,082)
|
(179)
|
(369)
|
(143)
|
-
|
(5,503)
|
Other income
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
82
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
2,385
|
(840)
|
1,627
|
Operating expenses
|
(46,683)
|
(14,790)
|
(935)
|
(4,697)
|
(5,463)
|
(1,489)
|
(14,507)
|
(16,074)
|
(8,865)
|
(113,503)
|
Segment profit / (loss) before
tax
|
19,138
|
(4,101)
|
3,760
|
194
|
5,193
|
(945)
|
(2,074)
|
11,700
|
(12,856)
|
20,009
|
Income tax (expense) /
income
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
23
|
(989)
|
236
|
(1,016)
|
(401)
|
(1,404)
|
(3,551)
|
Segment profit / (loss) after tax
|
19,138
|
(4,101)
|
3,760
|
217
|
4,204
|
(709)
|
(3,090)
|
11,299
|
(14,260)
|
16,458
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and advances to
customers
|
1,452,649
|
-
|
148,517
|
133,825
|
268,825
|
14,869
|
17,392
|
11,500
|
(11,500)
|
2,036,077
|
Assets available for
lease
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
171,738
|
-
|
-
|
171,738
|
Other assets
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
1,409,231
|
(2,999)
|
1,406,232
|
Segment total assets
|
1,452,649
|
-
|
148,517
|
133,825
|
268,825
|
14,869
|
189,130
|
1,420,731
|
(14,499)
|
3,614,047
|
Customer deposits
|
3,112,478
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(19,929)
|
3,092,549
|
Other liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
293,531
|
15,989
|
309,520
|
Segment total liabilities
|
3,112,478
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
293,531
|
(3,940)
|
3,402,069
|
Other segment items:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital expenditure
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(122,409)
|
(1)
|
(122,410)
|
Depreciation and
amortisation
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(41,826)
|
(10)
|
(41,836)
|
Segment profit is shown prior to
any intra-group eliminations.
All operations of the Group are
conducted wholly within the United Kingdom and geographical
information is therefore not presented.
46. Country by Country Reporting
Article 89 of the EU Directive
2013/36/EU otherwise known as the Capital Requirements Directive IV
('CRD IV') was implemented into UK domestic legislation through
statutory instrument 2013 No. 3118, the Capital Requirements
(Country-by-Country Reporting) Regulations 2013 (the Regulations),
which were laid before the UK Parliament on 10 December 2013 and
which came into force on 1 January 2014.
Article 89 requires credit
institutions and investment firms in the EU to disclose annually,
specifying, by Member State and by third country in which it has an
establishment, the following information on a consolidated basis
for the financial year: name, nature of activities, geographical
location, turnover, number of employees, profit or loss before tax,
tax on profit or loss and public subsidies received.
|
|
FTE
|
Profit/(loss)
|
|
31 December 2023
|
Turnover
|
employees
|
before
tax
|
Tax
paid
|
Location
|
£m
|
Number
|
£m
|
£m
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK
|
178.9
|
799
|
47.1
|
11.7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FTE
|
Profit/(loss)
|
|
31 December 2022
|
Turnover
|
employees
|
before
tax
|
Tax
paid
|
Location
|
£m
|
Number
|
£m
|
£m
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK
|
137.4
|
749
|
20.0
|
3.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
No public subsidies were received
during 2023 or 2022.
|
|
47. Ultimate controlling party
The Company regards Sir Henry
Angest, the Group Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, who has a
beneficial interest in 57.3% of the issued share capital of the
Company, as the ultimate controlling party. Details of his
remuneration are given in the Remuneration Report and Note 43 of
the consolidated financial statements includes related party
transactions with Sir Henry Angest.
48. Events after the balance sheet
date
There were no material post
balance sheet events to report.
Five Year Summary
|
|
2019
|
2020
|
2021
|
2022
|
2023
|
|
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
£000
|
Profit / (loss) for the year after
tax
|
6,176
|
(1,332)
|
6,786
|
16,458
|
35,379
|
Profit / (loss) before tax from
continuing operations
|
7,011
|
(1,090)
|
4,638
|
20,009
|
47,117
|
Total Earnings per
share
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic (p)
|
|
41.2
|
(8.9)
|
45.2
|
109.6
|
222.8
|
Earnings per share from continuing
operations
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic (p)
|
|
41.2
|
(8.9)
|
45.2
|
109.6
|
222.8
|
Dividends per share (p)
|
- ordinary
|
16.0
|
-
|
38.0
|
42.0
|
46.0
|
|
- special
|
-
|
-
|
21.0
|
-
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2019
|
2020
|
2021
|
2022
|
2023
|
Other KPI:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net asset value per share
(p)
|
|
1,363.5
|
1,291.5
|
1,337.2
|
1,411.1
|
1,546.8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|